Mathematics Class 11 Mathematics Volume 1 em From 2019
Mathematics Class 11 Mathematics Volume 1 em From 2019
Mathematics Class 11 Mathematics Volume 1 em From 2019
com
MATHEMATICS
VOLUME - I
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
Content Creation
The wise
possess all
II
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
• Additional facts related to the topics have been included to arouse interest
for searching of more information for deeper and wider learning.
Mathematics Learning
The correct way to learn is to understand the concepts throughly. Each chapter opens with an Introduction,
Learning Objectives, Various Definitions, Theorems, Results and Illustrations. These in turn are followed by
solved examples and exercise problems which have been classified into various types for quick and effective
revision. One can develop the skill of solving mathematical problems only by doing them. So the teacher's
role is to teach the basic concepts and problems related to it and to scaffold students to try the other problems
on their own. Since the first year of Higher Secondary is considered to be the foundation for learning higher
mathematics, the students must be given more attention to each and every concept mentioned in this book.
III
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
CONTENTS
MATHEMATICS
IV
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
Answers 290
Glossary 301
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com
ENGINEERING RELATED COURSES: B.Stat.(Hons.) Bachelor of Statistics
JEE (Main & Advanced) B.E. / B.Tech. / B.Arch in IITs and NITs B.Math (Hons.) Bachelor of Mathematics
B.Tech. Avionics / Aerospace B.S. - M.S Dual Degree 5 years programme
B.Tech. & M.Tech Dual degree programme in IIST Trivandram. B.Sc. Ed. 4 years programme
Agricultural Engineering (TamilNadu Agricultural University Entrance POST GRADUATE COURSES:
B.E
Exam)
CET Common Entrance Test for Maritime Courses (www.imu.edu.in) M.Sc Mathematics / Applied Mathematics / Statistics
VI
Birla Institute of Technology and science Admission Test (www.bits – M.Sc Astronomy
BITS
pilani.ac.in) M.Sc Operational Research
NATA National Aptitude Test in Architecture (www.nata.in)
M.Stat.(Hons.) Master of Statistics
IIIT Indian Institute of Information Technology (www.iiit.ac.in)
M.Math (Hons.) Master of Mathematics
BASIC SCIENCE COURSES:
M.Sc. Ed. 6 years programme
Tata Institute of Fundamental Research conductsGraduate School
TIFR
admission examination (Univ.tirf.res.in) M.Sc Mathematics - 5 years Integrated programme
NEST, NISER National Institute of Science Education and Research (www.niser.ac.in)
IISC Indian Institute of Science (www.iisc.ac.in)
RIE Regional Institute of Education
CEE Common Entrance Examination (www.rie ajmer.raj.nic.in)
CUCET Central Universities Common Entrance Test (http://Ucetexam.in)
GATE Graduate Aptitude Test in Engineering (gate.iitg.ac.in)
NET CSIR and UGC - National Eligibility Test (http://cbsenet.nic.in)
JAM Joint Admission Test for M.Sc (Jam.iitb.ac.in)
ISI Indian Statistical Institute Admission Test (www.isical.ac.in)
IISER - KVPY / IIT – Indian Institute of science Education and Research (www.iiser.ac.in &
JEE / NEET www.iiseradmission.in)
www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.books.kalvisolai.com
12-02-2019 16:31:54
Job and Scholarship Opportunities
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com
• NTSE at the end of X (from class XI to Ph.D)
• Scientist Jobs in ISRO, DRDO, CSIR labs
• International Olympiad: for getting stipend for Higher
• Union Public Service Commission Education in Science and Mathematics
VII
• DST – INSPIRE Fellowships (for Ph.D)
• Indian Defense Services
• UGC National Fellowships (for Ph.D)
• Public Sector Bank
• Indira Gandhi Fellowship for Single Girl Child (for UG and
PG)
• Tax Assistant
• Moulana Azad Fellowship for minorities (for Ph.D)
• Statistical Investigator
In addition various fellowships for SC / ST / PWD / OBC
•
etc are available. (Visit website of University Grants
• Combined Graduate Level Exam Commission (UGC) and Department of Science and
Technology (DST))
• Tamil Nadu Public Service Commission
• University Fellowships
www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.books.kalvisolai.com
12-02-2019 16:31:55
Institutes in india to pursue research in Mathematics
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com
Tata Institue of Fundamental Research (TIFR), Mumbai www.tifr.res.in
Indian Institute of Space Science and Technology (IIST), Trivandrum www.iist.ac.in
National Institute of Science Education and Research (NISER) www.niser.ac.in
Birla Institute of Technology and Science, Pilani www.bits-pilani.ac.in
Indian Institute of Science Education and Research www.iiseradmission.in
VIII
Anna University https://www.annauniv.edu/
Indian Institute of Technology in various places (IIT’s) www.iitm.ac.in
National Institute of Technology (NIT’s) www.nitt.edu
Central Universities www.cucet.ac.in
State Universities www.ugc.ac.in
Tamil Nadu agricultural University (tnau.ac.in) tnau.ac.in
International Institute of Information Technology www.iiit.ac.in
The Institute of Mathematical Sciences (IMSC), Chennai. www.imsc.res.in
Hyderabad Central university, Hyderabad. www.uohyd.ac.in
Delhi University, Delhi www.du.ac.in
Mumbai University, Mumbai www.mu.ac.in
Savithiri Bai Phule Pune University, Pune www.unipune.ac.in
Indian Statistical Institute www.iisical.ac.in
Regional Institute of Education www.rieajmer.raj.nic.in
www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.books.kalvisolai.com
12-02-2019 16:31:55
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Cantor
1.1 Introduction
The concepts of sets, relations and functions occupy a fundamental place in the mainstream of
mathematical thinking. As rightly stated by the Russian mathematician Luzin the concept of functions
did not arise suddenly. It underwent profound changes in time. Galileo (1564-1642) explicitly used
the dependency of one quantity on another in the study of planetary motions. Descartes (1596-
1650) clearly stated that an equation in two variables, geometrically represented by a curve, indicates
dependence between variable quantities. Leibnitz (1646-1716) used the word “function”, in a 1673
manuscript, to mean any quantity varying from point to point of a curve. Dirichlet (1805-1859),
a student of Gauss, was credited with the modern “formal” definition of function with notation
y = f (x). In the 20th century, this concept was extended to include all arbitrary correspondence
satisfying the uniqueness condition between sets and numerical or non-numerical values.
With the development of set theory, initiated by Cantor (1845-1918),
the notion of function continued to evolve. From the notion of correspon-
dence, mathematicians moved to the notion of relation. However even
now in the theory of computation, a function is not viewed as a relation
but as a computational rule. The modern definition of a function is given
in terms of relation so as to suit to develop artificial intelligence.
In the previous classes, we have studied and are well versed with the
real numbers and arithmetic operations on them. We also learnt about
sets of real numbers, Venn diagrams, Cartesian product of sets, basic
definitions of relations and functions. For better understanding, we recall
more about sets and Cartesian products of sets. In this chapter, we see a Cantor
new facelift to the mathematical notions of “Relations” and “Functions”. 1845 - 1918
Learning Objectives
On completion of this chapter, the students are expected to
• list and work with many properties of sets and Cartesian product;
• know the concepts of constants, variables, intervals and neighbourhoods;
• understand about various types of relations; create relations of any required type;
• represent functions in different ways;
• work with elementary functions, types of functions, operations on functions including inverse
of a bijective function;
• identify the graphs of some special functions;
• visualize and sketch the graphs of some relatively complicated functions.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1.2 Sets
In the earlier classes, we have seen that a set is a collection of well-defined objects. As the theory of
sets is the building blocks of modern mathematics, one has to learn the concepts of sets carefully and
deeply. Now we look at the term “well-defined” a little more deeply. Consider the two statements:
(i) The collection of all beautiful flowers in Ooty Rose Garden.
(ii) The collection of all old men in Tamilnadu.
The terms “beautiful flowers” and “old men” are not well-defined. We cannot define the term
“beautiful flower” in a sharp way as there is no concrete definition for beauty because the concept of
beauty varies from person to person, content to content and object to object. We should not consider
statements like “the collection of all beautiful flowers in Ooty Rose Garden” as a set. Now, can we
say “the collection of all red flowers in Ooty Rose Garden” a set? The answer is “yes”.
One may consider a person of age 60 as old and others may not agree. There is no specific and
concrete definition for “old men”. The second statement can be made more sharply as
“the collection of all men in Tamilnadu of age greater than 70”.
Now, the above collection becomes a set because of definiteness in the age. Thus, the description of
a set should enable us to concretely decide whether a given particular object (element) is available in
the collection or not. So set is a distinguishable collection of objects.
We have also seen and learnt to use symbols like ∈, ⊂, ⊆, ∪ and ∩. Let us start with the question:
“If A and B are two sets, is it meaningful to write A ∈ B?”.
At the first sight one may hurry to say that this is always meaningless by telling, “the symbol ∈
should be used between an element and a set and it should not be used between two sets”. The first
part of the statement is true whereas the second part is not true. For example, if A = {1, 2} and
B = {1, {1, 2}, 3, 4}, then A ∈ B. In this section we shall discuss the meaning of such symbols more
deeply.
As we learnt in the earlier classes the set containing no elements is called an empty set or a void
set. It is usually denoted by ∅ or { }. By A ⊆ B, we mean every element of the set A is an element of
the set B. In this case, we say A is a subset of B and B is a super set of A. For any two sets A and
B, if A ⊆ B and B ⊆ A, then the two sets are equal. For any set A, the empty set ∅ and the set A are
always subsets of A. These two subsets are called trivial subsets. Further, we say A is a proper subset
of B if A is a subset of B and A 6= B. That is, B contains all elements of A and at least one element
which is not in A. Note that, as every element of A is an element of A, we have A ⊆ A. Thus, any
set is a subset of itself. This subset is called an improper subset. In other words, for any set A, A is
the improper subset of A. It is known that, N ⊂ W ⊂ Z ⊂ Q ⊂ R, where N denotes the set of all
natural numbers or positive integers, W denotes the set of all non-negative integers, Z denotes the set
of all integers, Q denotes the set of all rational numbers and R denotes the set of all real numbers.
Note that, the set of all irrational numbers is a subset of R but not a subset of any other set mentioned
above.
We learnt that the union of two sets A and B is denoted by A ∪ B and is defined as
A ∪ B = {x : x ∈ A or x ∈ B}
Two sets A and B are disjoint if they do not have any common element. That is, A and B are
disjoint if A ∩ B = ∅.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
n
Let us see some more notations. We are familiar with notations like Σ ai . This in fact stands for
i=1
n n
a1 + a2 + · · · + an . Similarly we can use the notations ∪ Ai and ∩ Ai to denote A1 ∪ A2 ∪ · · · ∪ An
i=1 i=1
and A1 ∩ A2 ∩ · · · ∩ An respectively.
n n
Thus, ∪ Ai = {x : x ∈ Ai for some i} and ∩ Ai = {x : x ∈ Ai for each i}. These notations are
i=1 i=1
useful when we discuss more number of sets.
If A is a set, then the set of all subsets of A is called the power set of A and is usually denoted
as P(A). That is, P(A) = {B : B ⊆ A}. The number of elements in P(A) is 2n , where n is the
number of elements in A.
Now, to define the complement of a set, it is necessary to know about the concept of universal
set. Usually all sets under consideration in a mathematical process are assumed to be subsets of some
fixed set. This basic set is called the universal set. For example, depending on the situation, for the set
of prime numbers, the universal set can be any one of the sets containing the set of prime numbers.
Thus, one of the sets N, W, Z, Q, R may be taken as a universal set for the set of prime numbers,
depending on the requirement. Universal set is usually denoted by U .
To define the complement of a set, we have to fix the universal set. Let A be a subset of the
universal set U . The complement of A with respect to U is denoted as A0 or Ac and defined as
A0 = {x : x ∈ U and x ∈ / A}.
The set difference of the set A to the set B is denoted by either A − B or A/B and is defined as
A − B = {a : a ∈ A and a ∈
/ B}.
Note that,
(i) U − A = A0 (ii) A − A = ∅ (iii) ∅ − A = ∅ (iv) A − ∅ = A (v) A − U = ∅.
The symmetric difference between two sets A and B is denoted by A∆B and is defined as
A∆B = (A − B) ∪ (B − A). Actually the elements of A∆B are the elements of A ∪ B which
are not in A ∩ B. Thus A∆B = (A ∪ B) − (A ∩ B).
A set X is said to be a finite set if it has k elements for some k ∈ W. In this case, we say the
finite set X is of cardinality k and is denoted by n(X). A set is an infinite set if it is not finite. For
an infinite set A, the cardinality is infinity. If n(A) = 1, then it is called a singleton set. Note that
n(∅) = 0 and n({∅}) = 1.
3 1.2 Sets
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
De Morgan Laws
(i) (A ∪ B)0 = A0 ∩ B 0 (ii) (A ∩ B)0 = A0 ∪ B 0
(iii) A − (B ∪ C) = (A − B) ∩ (A − C) (iv) A − (B ∩ C) = (A − B) ∪ (A − C).
On Symmetric Difference
(i) A∆B = B∆A (ii) (A∆B)∆C = A∆(B∆C)
(iii) A ∩ (B∆C) = (A ∩ B)∆(A ∩ C).
On Empty Set and Universal Set
(i) ∅0 = U (ii) U 0 = ∅
(iii) A ∪ A0 = U (iv) A ∩ A0 = ∅
(v) A∪U =U (vi) A ∩ U = A.
On Cardinality
(i) For any two finite sets A and B, n(A ∪ B) = n(A) + n(B) − n(A ∩ B).
(ii) If A and B are disjoint finite sets, then n(A ∪ B) = n(A) + n(B).
(iii) For any three finite sets A, B and C,
n(A ∪ B ∪ C) = n(A) + n(B) + n(C) − n(A ∩ B) − n(A ∩ C) − n(B ∩ C) + n(A ∩ B ∩ C).
A × B = {(a, b) : a ∈ A, b ∈ B}.
A × B × C = {(a, b, c) : a ∈ A, b ∈ B, c ∈ C}.
It is important that the elements of the Cartesian product are ordered and hence, for non-empty sets,
A × B 6= B × A, unless A = B.
That is, for non-empty sets A × B = B × A if and only if A = B. We know that R denotes the set of
real numbers and
R × R = {(x, y) : x, y ∈ R}.
R × R × R = {(x, y, z) : x, y, z ∈ R}.
A × B = {(1, 2), (1, 4), (1, 6), (2, 2), (2, 4), (2, 6), (3, 2), (3, 4), (3, 6)}.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 1.2 In a survey of 5000 persons in a town, it was found that 45% of the persons know
Language A, 25% know Language B, 10% know Language C, 5% know Languages A and B, 4%
know Languages B and C, and 4% know Languages A and C. If 3% of the persons know all the
three Languages, find the number of persons who knows only Language A.
Solution:
This problem can be solved either by property of cardinality or by Venn diagram.
Cardinality: Given that n(A) = 45% of 5000 = 2250
Similarly, n(B) = 1250, n(C) = 500, n(A ∩ B) = 250, n(B ∩ C) = 200, n(C ∩ A) = 200 and
n(A ∩ B ∩ C) = 150.
The number of persons who knows only Language A is
B
A
2
45 39
3
1
Figure 1.1
From Figure 1.1, the percentage of persons who knows only Language A is 39. Therefore, the
39
required number of persons is 5000 × 100 = 1950.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
((A ∪ B 0 ∪ C) ∩ (A ∩ B 0 ∩ C 0 )) ∪ ((A ∪ B ∪ C 0 ) ∩ (B 0 ∩ C 0 )) = B 0 ∩ C 0 .
Solution:
We have A ∩ B 0 ∩ C 0 ⊆ A ⊆ A ∪ B 0 ∪ C and hence (A ∪ B 0 ∪ C) ∩ (A ∩ B 0 ∩ C 0 ) = A ∩ B 0 ∩ C 0 .
Also, B 0 ∩ C 0 ⊆ C 0 ⊆ A ∪ B ∪ C 0 and hence (A ∪ B ∪ C 0 ) ∩ (B 0 ∩ C 0 ) = B 0 ∩ C 0 .
Now as A ∩ B 0 ∩ C 0 ⊆ B 0 ∩ C 0 , we have
((A ∪ B 0 ∪ C) ∩ (A ∩ B 0 ∩ C 0 )) ∪ ((A ∪ B ∪ C 0 ) ∩ (B 0 ∩ C 0 )) = B 0 ∩ C 0 .
Example 1.4 If X = {1, 2, 3, . . . 10} and A = {1, 2, 3, 4, 5}, find the number of sets B ⊆ X such
that A − B = {4}
Solution:
For every subset C of {6, 7, 8, 9, 10}, let B = C ∪ {1, 2, 3, 5}. Then A − B = {4}. In other words,
for every subset C of {6, 7, 8, 9, 10}, we have a unique set B so that A − B = {4}. So number of
sets B ⊆ X such that A − B = {4} and the number of subsets of {6, 7, 8, 9, 10} are the same. So
the number of sets B ⊆ X such that A − B = {4} is 25 = 32.
Example 1.5 If A and B are two sets so that n(B − A) = 2n(A − B) = 4n(A ∩ B) and if
n(A ∪ B) = 14, then find n(P(A)).
Solution:
To find n(P(A)), we need n(A).
Let n(A ∩ B) = k. Then n(A − B) = 2k and n(B − A) = 4k.
Now n(A ∪ B) = n(A − B) + n(B − A) + n(A ∩ B) = 7k.
It is given that n(A ∪ B) = 14. Thus 7k = 14 and hence k = 2.
So n(A − B) = 4 and n(B − A) = 8. As n(A) = n(A − B) + n(A ∩ B), we get n(A) = 6 and
hence n(P(A)) = 26 = 64.
Example 1.6 Two sets have m and k elements. If the total number of subsets of the first set is 112
more than that of the second set, find the values of m and k.
Solution:
Let A and B be the two sets with n(A) = m and n(B) = k. Since A contains more elements
than B, we have m > k. From the given conditions we see that 2m − 2k = 112. Thus we get,
2k (2m−k − 1) = 24 × 7.
Then the only possibility is k = 4 and 2m−k − 1 = 7. So m − k = 3 and hence m = 7.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 1.9 If P(A) denotes the power set of A, then find n(P(P(P(∅)))).
Solution:
Since P(∅) contains 1 element, P(P(∅)) contains 21 elements and hence P(P(P(∅))) contains
22 elements. That is, 4 elements.
Exercise - 1.1
1. Write the following in roster form.
(i) {x ∈ N : x2 < 121 and x is a prime}.
(ii) the set of all positive roots of the equation (x − 1)(x + 1)(x2 − 1) = 0.
(iii) {x ∈ N : 4x + 9 < 52}.
x−4
(iv) {x : x+2 = 3, x ∈ R − {−2}}.
2. Write the set {−1, 1} in set builder form.
3. State whether the following sets are finite or infinite.
(i) {x ∈ N : x is an even prime number}.
(ii) {x ∈ N : x is an odd prime number}.
(iii) {x ∈ Z : x is even and less than 10}.
(iv) {x ∈ R : x is a rational number}.
(v) {x ∈ N : x is a rational number}.
4. By taking suitable sets A, B, C, verify the following results:
(i) A × (B ∩ C) = (A × B) ∩ (A × C).
(ii) A × (B ∪ C) = (A × B) ∪ (A × C).
(iii) (A × B) ∩ (B × A) = (A ∩ B) × (B ∩ A).
(iv) C − (B − A) = (C ∩ A) ∪ (C ∩ B 0 ).
(v) (B − A) ∩ C = (B ∩ C) − A = B ∩ (C − A).
(vi) (B − A) ∪ C = (B ∪ C) − (A − C).
5. Justify the trueness of the statement:
“An element of a set can never be a subset of itself.”
6. If n(P(A)) = 1024, n(A ∪ B) = 15 and n(P(B)) = 32, then find n(A ∩ B).
7. If n(A ∩ B) = 3 and n(A ∪ B) = 10, then find n(P(A∆B)).
8. For a set A, A × A contains 16 elements and two of its elements are (1, 3) and (0, 2). Find the
elements of A.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
9. Let A and B be two sets such that n(A) = 3 and n(B) = 2. If (x, 1), (y, 2), (z, 1) are in A × B,
find A and B, where x, y, z are distinct elements.
10. If A × A has 16 elements, S = {(a, b) ∈ A × A : a < b} ; (−1, 2) and (0, 1) are two elements of
S, then find the remaining elements of S.
Figure 1.2
The value increases as we go right and decreases as we go left. If x lies to the left of y on the real
line then x < y. As there is no gap in a line, we have infinitely many real numbers between any two
real numbers.
Definition 1.1
A subset I of R is said to be an interval if
(i) I contains at least two elements and
(ii) a, b ∈ I and a < c < b then c ∈ I.
Geometrically, intervals correspond to rays and line segments on the real line.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Note that the set of all natural numbers, the set of all non-negative integers, set of all odd integers,
set of all even integers, set of all prime numbers are not intervals. Further observe that, between any
two real numbers there are infinitely many real numbers and hence the above sets are not intervals.
Consider the following sets:
(i) The set of all real numbers greater than 0.
(ii) The set of all real numbers greater than 5 and less than 7.
(iii) The set of all real numbers x such that 1 ≤ x ≤ 3.
(iv) The set of all real numbers x such that 1 < x ≤ 2.
The above four sets are intervals. In particular (i) is an infinite interval and (ii), (iii) and (iv) are
finite intervals. The term “finite interval” does not mean that the interval contains only finitely many
real numbers, however both ends are finite numbers. Both finite and infinite intervals are infinite sets.
The intervals correspond to line segments are finite intervals whereas the intervals that correspond to
rays and the entire real line are infinite intervals.
A finite interval is said to be closed if it contains both of its end points and open if it
contains neither of its end points. Symbolically the above four intervals can be written as
(0, ∞), (5, 7), [1, 3], (1, 2]. Note that for symbolic form we used parentheses and square brackets
to denote intervals. ( ) parentheses indicate open interval and [ ] square brackets indicate closed
interval. The first two sets are open intervals, third one is a closed interval. Note that fourth set is
neither open nor closed, that is, one end open and other end closed.
In particular [1, 3] contains both 1 and 3 and in between real numbers. The interval (1, 3) does not
contain 1 and 3 but contains all in between the numbers. The interval (1, 2] does not contain 1 but
contains 2 and all in between numbers.
Note that ∞ is not a number. The symbols −∞ and ∞ are used to indicate the ends of real line.
Further, the intervals (a, b) and [a, b] are subsets of R.
Type of Intervals
There are many types of intervals. Let a, b ∈ R such that a < b. The following table describes various
types of intervals. It is not possible to draw a line if a point is removed. So we use an unfilled circle
“◦” to indicate that the point is removed and use a filled circle “•” to indicate that the point is included.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Neighbourhood
Neighbourhood of a point ‘a’ is any open interval containing ‘a’. In particular, if is a positive
number, usually very small, then the -neighbourhood of ‘a’ is the open interval (a − , a + ). The
set (a − , a + ) − {a} is called deleted neighbourhood of ‘a’ and it is denoted as 0 < |x − a| <
(See Figure 1.3).
( ( ( (
a– a a+ a– a a+
Figure 1.3
1.5 Relations
We approach the concept of relations in different aspects using real life sense, Cryptography and
Geometry through Cartesian product of sets.
In our day to day life very often we come across questions like, “How is he related to you?”. Some
probable answers are,
(i) He is my father.
(ii) He is my teacher.
(iii) He is not related to me.
From this we see that the word relation connects a person with another person. Extending this
idea, in mathematics we consider relations as one which connects mathematical objects. Examples,
(i) A number m is related to a number n if m divides n in N.
(ii) A real number x is related to a real number y if x ≤ y.
(iii) A point p is related to a line L if p lies on L.
(iv) A student X is related to a school S if X is a student of S.
Illustration 1.1 (Cryptography) For centuries, people have used ciphers or codes, to keep confi-
dential information secure. Effective ciphers are essential to the military, to financial institutions and
to computer programmers. The study of the techniques used in creating coding and decoding these
ciphers is called cryptography.
L O
E H
T W
U X
S V
W Z
I L
N Q
Figure 1.4
One of the earliest methods of coding a message was a simple substitution. For example, each
letter in a message might be replaced by the letter that appears three places later in the alphabet.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Using this coding scheme, “LET US WIN” becomes “OHW XVZ LQ”. This scheme was used
by Julius Caesar and is called the Caesars cipher. To decode, replace each letter by the letter three
places before it. This concept is used often in Mental Ability Tests. The above can be represented as
an arrow diagram as given in Figure 1.4.
This can be viewed as the set of ordered pairs
{(L, O), (E, H), (T, W ), (U, X), (S, V ), (W, Z), (I, L), (N, Q)}
which is a subset of the Cartesian product C × D where C = {L, E, T, U, S, W, I, N } and
D = {O, H, W, X, V, Z, L, Q}.
(i) 2x − y = 0
The equation 2x − y = 0 represents a straight line. Clearly the points, (1, 2), (3, 6) lie on
it whereas (1, 1), (3, 5), (4, 5) are not lying on the straight line. The analytical relation between
x and y is given by y = 2x. The set of all points that lie on the straight line is given as
{(x, 2x) : x ∈ R}. Clearly this is a subset of R × R. (See Figure 1.5.)
y y y
2x–y = 0
x2–y = 0 x–y2 = 0
x x x
(ii) x2 − y = 0.
As we discussed earlier, the relation between x and y is y = x2 . The set of all points on
the curve is {(x, x2 ) : x ∈ R} (See Figure 1.6). Again this is a subset of the Cartesian product
R × R.
(iii) x − y 2 = 0 √
2
As above, the relation between
√ x and y√ is y = x or y = ± x, x ≥ 0. The equation can
√ as y = + x√and y = − x. The set of all points on the curve is the union of
also be re-written
the sets {(x, x)} and {(x, − x)}, where x is a non-negative real number, are the subsets of
the Cartesian product R × R. (See Figure 1.7).
From the above examples we intuitively understand what a relation is. But in mathematics, we
have to give a rigorous definition for each and every technical term we are using. Now let us start
defining the term “relation” mathematically.
11 1.5 Relations
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Definition of Relation
Let A = {p, q, r, s, t, u} be a set of students and let B = {X, Y, Z, W } be a set of schools. Let us
consider the following “relation”.
A student a ∈ A is related to a school S ∈ B if “a” is studying or studied in the school S.
Let us assume that p studied in X and now studying in W , q studied in X and now studying in Y ,
r studied in X and W , and now studying in Z, s has been studying in X from the beginning, t studied
in Z and now studying in no school, and u never studied in any of these four schools.
Though the relations are given explicitly, it is not possible to give a relation always in this way. So
let us try some other representations for expressing the same relation:
p p q q r r r s t
(i)
X W X Y X Z W X Z
(ii)
p q r s t u
X Y Z W
(iii) { (p, X), (p, W ), (q, X), (q, Y ), (r, X), (r, Z), (r, W ), (s, X), (t, Z) }
(iv) pRX, pRW, qRX, qRY, rRX, rRZ, rRW, sRX, tRZ.
Among these four representations of the relation, the third one seems to be more convenient and
comfortable to deal with a relation in terms of sets.
The set given in the third representation is a subset of the Cartesian product A × B. In Illustrations
1.1 and 1.2 also, we arrived at subsets of a Cartesian product.
Definition 1.2
Let A and B be any two non-empty sets. A relation R from A to B is defined as a subset of the
Cartesian product of A and B. Symbolically R ⊆ A × B.
a 1
b 2
c 3
d 4
z 26
Figure 1.8
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
of ordered pairs {(a, 1), (b, 2), . . . , (z, 26)}. This set of ordered pairs is a relation. The domain of the
relation is {a, b, . . . z} and the range is {1, 2, . . . , 26}.
Now we recall that the relations discussed in Illustrations 1.1 and 1.2 also end up with subsets of
the cartesian product of two sets. So the term relation used in all discussions we had so far, fits with
the mathematical term relation defined in Definition 1.2.
The domain of the relation discussed in Illustration 1.1 is the set {L, E, T, U, S, W, I, N } and the
range is {O, H, W, X, V, Z, L, Q}. In Illustration 1.2, the domain and range of the relation discussed
for the equation 2x − y = 0 are R and R (See Figure 1.9); for the equation x2 − y = 0, the domain
is R and the range is [0, ∞) (See Figure 1.10); and in the case of the third equation x − y 2 = 0, the
domain is [0, ∞) and the range is R (See Figures 1.11 and 1.12).
y y
Range
y = 2x
Range
Domain
Domain x Domain Domain x
y = x2
Range
Range
Figure 1.9 Figure 1.10
Range
Range
y = –√x
y = √x Domain Domain
Domain Domain
Range
Range
Note that, the domain of a relation is a subset of the first set in the Cartesian product and the range
is a subset of second set. Usually we call the second set as co-domain of the relation. Thus, the range
of a relation is the collection of all elements in the co-domain which are related to some element in
the domain. Let us note that the range of a relation is a subset of the co-domain.
For any set A, ∅ and A × A are subsets of A × A. These two relations are called extreme relations.
The former relation is an empty relation and the later is an universal relation.
We will discuss more about domain, co-domain and the range in the next section namely,
“Functions”.
If R is a relation from A to B and if (x, y) ∈ R, then sometimes we write xRy (read this as “x is
related to y”) and if (x, y) ∈
/ R, then sometimes we write xRy (read this as “x is not related to y”).
Though the general definition of a relation is defined from one set to another set, relations defined
on a set are of more interest in mathematical point of view. So let us concentrate on relations defined
on a set.
13 1.5 Relations
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Definition 1.3
Let S be any non-empty set. Let R be a relation on S. Then
• R is said to be reflexive if a is related to a for all a ∈ S.
• R is said to be symmetric if a is related to b implies that b is related to a.
• R is said to be transitive if “a is related to b and b is related to c” implies that a is related to
c.
These three relations are called basic relations.
Definition 1.4
Let S be any set. A relation on S is said to be an equivalence relation if it is reflexive, symmetric
and transitive.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Illustration 1.4
1. Let X = {1, 2, 3, 4} and R = {(1, 1), (2, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3), (1, 3), (4, 4), (1, 2), (3, 1)}. As
(1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3) and (4, 4) are all in R, it is reflexive. Also for each pair (a, b) ∈ R the
pair (b, a) is also in R. So R is symmetric. As (2, 1), (1, 3) ∈ R and (2, 3) ∈ / R, we see that R is
not transitive. Thus R is not an equivalence relation.
2. Let P denote the set of all straight lines in a plane. Let R be the relation defined on P as `Rm if `
is parallel to m.
This relation is reflexive, symmetric and transitive. Thus it is an equivalence relation.
3. Let A be the set consist of parents with their children , two girls and a boy. Let R be the relation
defined by aRb if a is a sister of b.
This relation is to be looked into carefully. A woman is not a sister of herself. So it is not
reflexive. It is not symmetric also. Clearly it is not transitive. So it is not an equivalence relation.
(If we consider the same relation on the subset of females, then it becomes symmetric; even in this
case it is not transitive).
4. On the set of natural numbers let R be the relation defined by xRy if x + 2y = 21. It is better to
write the relation explicitly. The relation R is the set
{(1, 10), (3, 9), (5, 8), (7, 7), (9, 6), (11, 5), (13, 4), (15, 3), (17, 2), (19, 1)}.
Example 1.10 Check the relation R = {(1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3), . . . , (n, n)} defined on the set
S = {1, 2, 3, . . . , n} for the three basic relations.
Solution:
As (a, a) ∈ R for all a ∈ S, R is reflexive.
There is no pair (a, b) in R such that (b, a) ∈/ R. In other words, for every pair (a, b) ∈ R, (b, a) is
also in R. Thus R is symmetric.
We cannot find two pairs (a, b) and (b, c) in R, such that (a, c) ∈ / R. Thus the statement “R is not
transitive” is not true; therefore, the statement “R is transitive” is true; hence R is transitive.
Since R is reflexive, symmetric and transitive, this relation is an equivalence relation.
From the very beginning we have denoted all the relations by the same letter R. It is not necessary
to do so. We may use the Greek letter ρ (Read as rho) to denote relations. Equivalence relations are
mostly denoted by “∼”.
If a relation is not of required type, then by inserting or deleting some pairs we can make it of the
required type. We do this in the following problem.
Example 1.11 Let S = {1, 2, 3} and ρ = {(1, 1), (1, 2), (2, 2), (1, 3), (3, 1)}.
(i) Is ρ reflexive? If not, state the reason and write the minimum set of ordered pairs to be
included to ρ so as to make it reflexive.
15 1.5 Relations
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(ii) Is ρ symmetric? If not, state the reason, write minimum number of ordered pairs to be
included to ρ so as to make it symmetric and write minimum number of ordered pairs to
be deleted from ρ so as to make it symmetric.
(iii) Is ρ transitive? If not, state the reason, write minimum number of ordered pairs to be included
to ρ so as to make it transitive and write minimum number of ordered pairs to be deleted from
ρ so as to make it transitive.
(iv) Is ρ an equivalence relation? If not, write the minimum ordered pairs to be included to ρ so
as to make it an equivalence relation.
Solution:
(i) ρ is not reflexive because (3, 3) is not in ρ. As (1, 1) and (2, 2) are in ρ, it is enough to include
the pair (3, 3) to ρ so as to make it reflexive.
(ii) ρ is not symmetric because (1, 2) is in ρ, but (2, 1) is not in ρ. It is enough to include the pair
(2, 1) to ρ so as to make it symmetric.
It is enough to remove the pair (1, 2) from ρ so as to make it symmetric
(iii) ρ is not transitive because (3, 1) and (1, 3) are in ρ, but (3, 3) is not in ρ. To make it transitive
we have to include (3, 3) in ρ. Even after including (3, 3), the relation is not transitive because
(3, 1) and (1, 2) are in ρ, but (3, 2) is not in ρ. To make it transitive we have to include (3, 2)
also in ρ. Now it becomes transitive. So (3, 3) and (3, 2) are to be included so as to make ρ
transitive.
But if we remove (3, 1) from ρ, then it becomes transitive.
(iv) We have seen that
• to make ρ reflexive, we have to include (3, 3);
• to make ρ symmetric, we have to include (2, 1);
• and to make ρ transitive, we have to include (3, 3) and (3, 2).
To make ρ as an equivalence relation we have to include all these pairs. So after including the
pairs the relation becomes {(1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3), (1, 2), (2, 1), (1, 3), (3, 1), (3, 2)}
But this relation is not symmetric because (3, 2) is in the relation and (2, 3) is not in the relation.
So we have to include (2, 3) also. Now the new relation becomes
{(1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3), (1, 2), (2, 1), (1, 3), (3, 1), (3, 2), (2, 3)}
It can be seen that this relation is reflexive, symmetric and transitive, and hence it is an equivalence
relation. Thus we have to include (3, 3), (2, 1), (3, 2) and (2, 3) to ρ so as to make it an equivalence
relation.
Now let us learn how to create relations having certain properties through the following example.
Example 1.12 Let A = {0, 1, 2, 3}. Construct relations on A of the following types:
(i) not reflexive, not symmetric, not transitive.
(ii) not reflexive, not symmetric, transitive.
(iii) not reflexive, symmetric, not transitive.
(iv) not reflexive, symmetric, transitive.
(v) reflexive, not symmetric, not transitive.
(vi) reflexive, not symmetric, transitive.
(vii) reflexive, symmetric, not transitive.
(viii) reflexive, symmetric, transitive.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Solution:
(i) Let us use the pair (1, 2) to make the relation “not symmetric” and consider the relation
{(1, 2)}. It is transitive. If we include (2, 3) and not include (1, 3), then the relation is not
transitive. So the relation {(1, 2), (2, 3)} is not reflexive, not symmetric and not transitive.
Similarly we can construct more examples.
(ii) Just now we have seen that the relation {(1, 2)} is transitive, not reflexive and not symmetric.
(iii) Let us start with the pair (1, 2). Since we need symmetricity, we have to include the pair (2, 1).
At this stage as (1, 1), (2, 2) are not here, the relation is not transitive. Thus {(1, 2), (2, 1)} is
not reflexive; it is symmetric; and it is not transitive.
(iv) If we include the pairs (1, 1) and (2, 2) to the relation discussed in (iii), it will become
transitive. Thus {(1, 2), (2, 1), (1, 1), (2, 2)} is not reflexive; it is symmetric and it is transitive.
(v) For a relation on {0, 1, 2, 3} to be reflexive, it must have the pairs (0, 0), (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3).
Fortunately, it becomes symmetric and transitive. Therefore, as in (i) if we insert (1, 2) and
(2, 3) we get the required one. Thus {(0, 0), (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3), (1, 2), (2, 3)} is reflexive; it
is not symmetric and it is not transitive.
(vi) Proceeding like this we get the relation {(0, 0), (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3), (1, 2)} that is reflexive,
transitive and not symmetric.
(vii) As above we get the relation {(0, 0), (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3), (1, 2), (2, 3), (2, 1), (3, 2)} that is
reflexive, symmetric and not transitive.
(viii) We have the relation {(0, 0), (1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 3)} which is reflexive, symmetric and transitive.
Example 1.13 In the set Z of integers, define mRn if m − n is a multiple of 12. Prove that R is an
equivalence relation.
Solution:
As m − m = 0 and 0 = 0 × 12, hence mRm proving that R is reflexive.
Let mRn. Then m − n = 12k for some integer k; thus n − m = 12(−k) and hence nRm. This
shows that R is symmetric.
Let mRn and nRp; then m − n = 12k and n − p = 12` for some integers k and `.
So m − p = 12(k + `) and hence mRp. This shows that R is transitive.
Thus R is an equivalence relation.
Theorem 1.1: The number of relations from a set containing m elements to a set containing n
2
elements is 2mn . In particular the number of relations on a set containing n elements is 2n .
Proof. Let A and B be sets containing m and n elements respectively. Then A × B contains mn
elements and A × B has 2mn subsets. Since every subset of A × B is a relation from A to B, there
are 2mn relations from a set containing m elements to a set containing n elements.
2
Taking A = B, we see that the number of relations on a set containing n elements is 2n .
2
(i) The number of reflexive relations on a set containing n elements is 2n −n .
(n2 +n)
(ii) The number of symmetric relations on a set containing n elements is 2 2 .
Definition 1.5
If R is a relation from A to B, then the relation R−1 defined from B to A by
17 1.5 Relations
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
For example, if R = {(1, a), (2, b), (2, c), (3, a)}, then
R−1 = {(a, 1), (b, 2), (c, 2), (a, 3)}.
It is easy to see that the domain of R becomes the range of R−1 and the range of R becomes the
domain of R−1 .
Exercise - 1.2
1. Discuss the following relations for reflexivity, symmetricity and transitivity:
(i) The relation R defined on the set of all positive integers by “mRn if m divides n”.
(ii) Let P denote the set of all straight lines in a plane. The relation R defined by “`Rm if ` is
perpendicular to m”.
(iii) Let A be the set consisting of all the members of a family. The relation R defined by “aRb
if a is not a sister of b”.
(iv) Let A be the set consisting of all the female members of a family. The relation R defined by
“aRb if a is not a sister of b”.
(v) On the set of natural numbers the relation R defined by “xRy if x + 2y = 1”.
2. Let X = {a, b, c, d} and R = {(a, a), (b, b), (a, c)}. Write down the minimum number of ordered
pairs to be included to R to make it
(i) reflexive (ii) symmetric (iii) transitive (iv) equivalence
3. Let A = {a, b, c} and R = {(a, a), (b, b), (a, c)}. Write down the minimum number of ordered
pairs to be included to R to make it
(i) reflexive (ii) symmetric (iii) transitive (iv) equivalence
4. Let P be the set of all triangles in a plane and R be the relation defined on P as aRb if a is similar
to b. Prove that R is an equivalence relation.
5. On the set of natural numbers let R be the relation defined by aRb if 2a + 3b = 30. Write down
the relation by listing all the pairs. Check whether it is
(i) reflexive (ii) symmetric (iii) transitive (iv) equivalence
6. Prove that the relation “friendship” is not an equivalence relation on the set of all people in
Chennai.
7. On the set of natural numbers let R be the relation defined by aRb if a + b ≤ 6. Write down the
relation by listing all the pairs. Check whether it is
(i) reflexive (ii) symmetric (iii) transitive (iv) equivalence
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
8. Let A = {a, b, c}. What is the equivalence relation of smallest cardinality on A? What is the
equivalence relation of largest cardinality on A?
9. In the set Z of integers, define mRn if m − n is divisible by 7. Prove that R is an equivalence
relation.
1.6 Functions
Suppose that a particle is moving in the space. We assume the physical particle as a point. As time
varies, the particle changes its position. Mathematically at any time the point occupies a position in
the three dimensional space R3 . Let us assume that the time varies from 0 to 1. So the movement or
functioning of the particle decides the position of the particle at any given time t between 0 and 1. In
other words, for each t ∈ [0, 1], the functioning of the particle gives a point in R3 . Let us denote the
position of the particle at time t as f (t).
Let us see another simple example. We know that the equation 2x−y = 0 describes a straight line.
Here whenever x assumes a value, y assumes some value accordingly. The movement or functioning
of y is decided by that of x. Let us denote y by f (x). We may see many situation like this in nature. In
the study of natural phenomena, we find that it is necessary to consider the variation of one quantity
depending on the variation of another.
The relation of the time and the position of the particle, the relation of a point in the x-axis to
a point in the y-axis and many more such relations are studied for a very long period in the name
function. Before Cantor, the term function is defined as a rule which associates a variable with another
variable. After the development of the concept of sets, a function is defined as a rule that associates
for every element in a set A, a unique element in a set B. However the terms rule and associate are
not properly defined mathematical terminologies. In modern mathematics every term we use has to
be defined properly. So a definition for function is given using relations.
Suppose that we want to discuss a test written by a set of students. We shall see this as a relation.
Let A be the set of students appeared for an examination and let B = {0, 1, 2, 3, . . . 100} be the
set of possible marks. We define a relation R as follows:
A student a is related to a mark b if a got b marks in the test.
We observe the following from this example:
• Every student got a mark. In other words, for every a ∈ A, there is an element b ∈ B such that
(a, b) ∈ R.
• A student cannot get two different marks in any test. In other words, for every a ∈ A, there
is definitely only one b ∈ B such that (a, b) ∈ R. This can be restated in a different way: If
(a, b), (a, c) ∈ R then b = c.
Relations having the above two properties form a very important class of relations, called functions.
Let us now have a rigorous definition of a function through relations.
Definition 1.6
Let A and B be two sets. A relation f from A to B, a subset of A × B, is called a function from
A to B if it satisfies the following:
(i) for all a ∈ A, there is an element b ∈ B such that (a, b) ∈ f .
(ii) if (a, b) ∈ f and (a, c) ∈ f then b = c.
That is, a function is a relation in which each element in the domain is mapped to exactly one
element in the range.
A is called the domain of f and B is called the co-domain of f . If (a, b) is in f , then we write
f (a) = b; the element b is called the image of a and the element a is called a pre-image of b and f (a)
is known as the value of f at a. The set {b : (a, b) ∈ f for some a ∈ A} is called the range of the
function. If B is a subset of R, then we say that the function is a real-valued function.
19 1.6 Functions
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Two functions f and g are said to be equal functions if their domains are same and f (a) = g(a)
for all a in the domain.
If f is a function with domain A and co-domain B, we write f : A → B (Read this asf is from A
to B or f be a function from A to B). We also say that f maps A into B. If f (a) = b, then we say f
maps a to b or a is mapped onto b by f , and so on.
The range of a function is the collection of all elements in the co-domain which have pre-images.
Clearly the range of a function is a subset of the co-domain. Further the first condition says that every
element in the domain must have an image; this is the reason for defining the domain of a relation
R from a set A to a set B as the set of all elements of A having images and not as A. The second
condition says that an element in the domain cannot have two or more images.
Naturally one may have the following doubts:
• In the definition, why we use the definite article “the” for image of a and the indefinite article “a”
for pre-image of b?
• We have a condition stating that every element in the domain must have an image; is there any
condition like “every element in the co-domain must have a pre-image”? If not, why?
• We have a condition stating that an element in the domain cannot have two or more images; is
there any condition like “an element in the co-domain cannot have two or more pre-images”? If
not, why?
As an element in the domain has exactly one image and an element in the co-domain can have more
than one pre-image according to the definition, we use the definite article “the” for image of a and the
indefinite article “a” for pre-image of b. There are no conditions as asked in the other two questions;
the reason behind it can be understood from the problem of students’ mark we considered above.
We observe that every function is a relation but a relation need not be a function.
Let f = {(a, 1), (b, 2), (c, 2), (d, 4)}.
Is f a function? This is a function from the set {a, b, c, d} to {1, 2, 4}. This is not a function
from {a, b, c, d, e} to {1, 2, 3, 4} because e has no image. This is not a function from {a, b, c, d} to
{1, 2, 3, 5} because the image of d is not in the co-domain; f is not a subset of {a, b, c, d}×{1, 2, 3, 5}.
So whenever we consider a function the domain and the co-domain must be stated explicitly.
The relation discussed in Illustration 1.1 is a function with domain {L, E, T, U, S, W, I, N } and
co-domain {O, H, W, X, V, Z, L, Q}. The relation discussed in Illustration 1.3 is again a function
with domain {a, b, . . . , z} and the co-domain {1, 2, 3, . . . , 26}.
In Illustration 1.2, we discussed three relations, namely
(i) y = 2x (ii) y = x2 (iii) y 2 = x.
Clearly (i) and (ii) are functions whereas (iii) is not a function, if the domain and the co-domain are
R. In (iii) for the same x, we have two y values
√ which contradict
√ the definition of the function. But
if we split into two relations, that is, y = x and y = − x then both become functions with same
domain non-negative real numbers and the co-domains [0, ∞) and (−∞, 0] respectively.
x x1 x2 . . . xn
y y1 y2 . . . yn
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
We note that the first and second figures in Illustration 1.2 represent the functions f (x) = 2x and
f (x) = x2 respectively. Usually the variable x is treated as independent variable and y as a dependent
variable. The variable x is called the argument and f (x) is called the value.
Depending upon the value of x, we have to select the formula to be used to find the value of f at
any point x. To find the value off at any real number, first we have to find to which interval x belongs
to; then using the corresponding formula we can find the value of f at that point. To find f (6) we
know 3 ≤ 6 < ∞ (or 6 ∈ [3, ∞)); so we use the formula f (x) = x2 and find f (6) = 36. Similarly
f (−1) = −2, f (−5) = 0 and so on.
If the function is defined from R or a subset of R then we can draw the graph of the function. For
example, if f : [0, 4] → R is defined by f (x) = x2 + 1, then we can plot the points (x, x2 + 1) for all
x ∈ [0, 4]. Then we will get a straight line segment joining (0, 1) and (4, 3). (See Figure 1.13)
y y
20
3
16 f (x)
12 P(x, f (x))
2
x
y= +1 8
2 y = x2 + 4
1 4
–4 –2 2 x 4 6 x
–1 1 2 3 4 x
21 1.6 Functions
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Consider another function f (x) = x2 + 4, x ≥ 0. The function will be given by its graph.
(See Figure 1.14)
Let x be a point in the domain. Let us draw a vertical line through the point x. Let it meet the curve
at P . The point at which the horizontal line drawn through P meets the y-axis is f (x). Similarly using
horizontal lines through a point y in the co-domain, we can find the pre-images of y.
Can we say that any curve drawn on the plane be considered as a function from a subset of R to
R? No, we cannot. There is a simple test to find this.
y y y
4 4 4
3 3 3
2 2 2
1 1 1
1 2 3 4 x 1 2 3 4 x 1 2 3 4 x
The curve indicated in Figure 1.15 does not represent a function from [0, 4] to R because a vertical
line meets the curve at more than one point (See Figure 1.17). The curve indicated in Figure 1.16 does
not represent a function from [0, 4] to R because a vertical line drawn through x = 2.5 in [0, 4] does
not meet the curve (See Figure 1.18).
Testing whether a given curve represents a function or not by drawing vertical lines is called
vertical line test or simply vertical test.
The third curve y 2 = x in Illustration 1.2 fails in the vertical line test and hence it is not a function
from R to R.
X X X Y
a a a x
b b b y
c c c z
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(ii) Let X and Y be two sets. Let c be a fixed element of Y . The function f : X → Y defined by
f (x) = c for all x ∈ X is called a constant function (See Figure 1.20).
The value of a constant function is same for all values of x throughout the domain.
If X and Y are R, then the graph of the identity function and a constant function are as in
Figures 1.21 and 1.22. If X is any set, then the constant function defined by f (x) = 0 for all x
is called the zero function. So zero function is a particular case of constant function.
y y
c y=c
y=x
x x
(iii) The function f : R → R defined by f (x) = |x|, where |x| is the modulus or absolute value of
x, is called the modulus function or absolute value function. (See Figure 1.23.)
Let us recall that |x| is defined as
−x if x < 0
−x if x ≤ 0 −x if x < 0
|x| = 0 if x = 0 or |x| = or |x| =
x if x > 0 x if x > 0 x if x ≥ 0
y = –x y y=x y
3
2
1
x=0 x –3 –2 –1 1 2 3 x
–1
–2
–3
23 1.6 Functions
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
y y
x x
One may note that the relations among the names of these functions, the symbols denoting the
functions are the commonly used words ceiling and floor of a room. Their graphs are given in Figures
1.25 and 1.26.
X Y X Y X Y
a x a x a x
b y b y b y
c z z c
Let us look at the two simple functions given in Figure 1.27 and Figure 1.28. In the first
function two elements of the domain, b and c, are mapped into the same element y, whereas
it is not the case in the Figure 1.28. Functions like the second one are examples of one-to-one
functions.
Let us look at the two functions given in Figures 1.28 and 1.29. In Figure 1.28 the element z in the
co-domain has no pre-image, whereas it is not the case in Figure 1.29. Functions like in Figure 1.29
are examples of onto functions. Now we define one-to-one and onto functions.
Definition 1.7
A function f : A → B is said to be one-to-one if x, y ∈ A, x 6= y ⇒ f (x) 6= f (y) [or
equivalently f (x) = f (y) ⇒ x = y]. A function f : A → B is said to be onto, if for each b ∈ B
there exists at least one element a ∈ A such that f (a) = b. That is, the range of f is B.
Another name for one-to-one function is injective function; onto function is surjective function. A
function f : A → B is said to be bijective if it is both one-to-one and onto.
To prove a function f : A → B to be one-to-one, it is enough to prove any one of the following:
if x 6= y, then f (x) 6= f (y), or equivalently if f (x) = f (y), then x = y.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
It is easy to observe that every identity function is one-to-one function as well as onto. A constant
function is not onto unless the co-domain contains only one element. The following statements are
some important simple results.
Let A and B be two sets with m and n elements.
(i) There is no one-to-one function from A to B if m > n.
(ii) If there is an one-to-one function from A to B, then m ≤ n.
(iii) There is no onto function from A to B if m < n.
(iv) If there is an onto function from A to B, then m ≥ n.
(v) There is a bijection from A to B, if and only if, m = n.
(vi) There is no bijection from A to B if and only if, m 6= n.
A function which is not onto is called an into function. That is, the range of the function
is a proper subset of its co-domain. Let us see some illustrations.
(1) X = {1, 2, 3, 4}, Y = {a, b, c, d, e}and f = {(1, a), (2, c), (3, e), (4, b)}.
This function is one-to-one but not onto.
(2) X = {1, 2, 3, 4}, Y = {a, b} and f = {(1, a), (2, a), (3, a), (4, a)}.
This function is not one-to-one; it is not onto.
(3) X = {1, 2, 3, 4}, Y = {a} and f = {(1, a), (2, a), (3, a), (4, a)}.
This function is not one-to-one but it is onto. It seems that this function is same
as the previous one. The co-domain of the function is very important when deciding
whether the function is onto or not.
(4) X = {1, 2, 3, 4}, Y = {a, b, c, d, e} and f = {(1, a), (2, c), (3, b), (4, b)}.
This function is neither one-to-one nor onto.
(5) X = {1, 2, 3, 4}, Y = {a, b, c, d} and f = {(1, a), (2, c), (3, d), (4, b)}.
This function is both one-to-one and onto.
(6) X = {1, 2, 3, 4}, Y = {a, b, c, d, e} and f = {(1, a), (2, c), (3, e)}.
This is not at all a function, only a relation.
(7) Let X be a finite set with k elements. Then, we have a bijection from X to
{1, 2, . . . k}.
Let us consider functions defined on some known sets through a formula rule.
Example 1.14 Check whether the following functions are one-to-one and onto.
(i) f : N → N defined by f (n) = n + 2.
(ii) f : N ∪ {−1, 0} → N defined by f (n) = n + 2.
Solution:
(i) If f (n) = f (m), then n + 2 = m + 2 and hence m = n. Thus f is one-to-one. As 1 has no
pre-image, this function is not onto. (See Figure 1.30)
(ii) As above, this function is one-to-one. If m is in the co-domain, then m − 2 is in the domain
and f (m − 2) = (m − 2) + 2 = m; thus m has a pre-image and hence this function is onto.
(See Figure 1.31)
25 1.6 Functions
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
N N NÈ {–1,0} N
f f
1 1 –1 1
2 2 0 2
3 3 1 3
4 4 2 4
It seems that the second function (ii) is same as the first function (i). But the domains are
different. From this we see that the domain of the function is also important in deciding
whether the function is onto or not. The co-domain has no role in deciding whether the
function is one-to-one or not. But it is important to decide whether the function is onto
or not.
Example 1.15 Check the following functions for one-to-oneness and ontoness.
Example 1.16 Check whether the following for one-to-oneness and ontoness.
1
(i) f : R → R defined by f (x) = .
x
1
(ii) f : R − {0} → R defined by f (x) = .
x
Solution:
(i) This is not at all a function because f (x) is not defined for x = 0.
(ii) This function is one-to-one (verify) but not onto because 0 has no pre-image.
If we consider R − {0} as the co-domain for the second, then f will become a bijection.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
x
Example 1.17 If f : R − {−1, 1} → R is defined by f (x) = x2 −1
, verify whether f is one-to-one
or not.
Solution:
We start with the assumption f (x) = f (y). Then,
= y2y−1
x
x2 −1
⇒ x(y 2 − 1) = y(x2 − 1)
⇒ xy 2 − x − yx2 + y = 0
⇒ (y − x)(xy + 1) = 0
This implies that x = y or xy = −1. So if we select two numbers x and y so that xy = −1, then
f (x) = f (y). (2, − 21 ), (7, − 17 ), (−2, 21 ) are some among the infinitely many possible pairs. Thus
f (2) = f ( −1
2
) = 23 . That is, f (x) = f (y) does not imply x = y. Hence it is not one-to-one.
Example 1.18 If f : R → R is defined as f (x) = 2x2 − 1, find the pre-images of 17, 4 and −2.
Solution:
To find the pre-image of 17, we solve the equation 2x2 − 1 = 17. The two solutions
q of thisq equation,
3 and −3 are the pre-images of 17 under f . The equation 2x − 1 = 4 yields 2 and − 52 as the
2 5
two pre-images of 4. To find the pre-image of −2, we solve the equation 2x2 − 1 = −2. This shows
that x2 = − 12 which has no solution in R because square of a number cannot be negative and hence
−2 has no pre-image under f .
Example 1.19 If f : [−2, 2] → B is given by f (x) = 2x3 , then find B so that f is onto.
Solution:
The minimum value is f (−2) and its maximum value is f (2) which are equal to −16 and 16
respectively. So B is [−16, 16].
As f (x) = 2x3 is an increasing function on [−2, 2], the minimum value is attained at the
left end and the maximum value is attained at the right end. (For more about increasing
/ decreasing functions one may refer later chapters.)
Example 1.20 Check whether the function f (x) = x|x| defined on [−2, 2] is one-to-one or not. If
it is one-to-one, find a suitable co-domain so that the function becomes a bijection.
Solution:
Let x, y ∈ [−2, 2] such that f (x) = f (y). If y = 0, then x = 0. So let y 6= 0 and hence x 6= 0. Now
|y| |y|
x|x| = y|y| since f (x) = f (y). This implies that xy = |x| . Since |x| > 0, xy > 0; thus x and y are
either both positive or both negative and hence x2 = y 2 .
So if f (x) = f (y), we must have x2 = y 2 . Also x and y are either both negative or both
positive. This is possible only if x = y. Thus f is one-to-one. When x < 0, f (x) = −x2 and when
x ≥ 0, f (x) = x2 . So the range is [−4, 4]. So f becomes a bijection from [−2, 2] to [−4, 4].
27 1.6 Functions
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Horizontal Test
Similar to the vertical line test we have a test called horizontal test to check whether a function is
one-to-one, onto or not. Let a function be given as a curve in the plane. If the horizontal line through
a point y in the co-domain meets the curve at some points, then the x-coordinate of all the points give
pre-images for y.
y y y
3 3
3
2 2
2
1 1 1
1 2 3 4 x 1 2 3 4 x 1 2 3 3 x
(i) If the horizontal line through a point y in the co-domain does not meet the curve, then there will
be no pre-image for y and hence the function is not onto.
(ii) If the horizontal line through atleast one point of the codomain meets the curve at more than
one point, then the function is not one-to-one.
(iii) If for all y in the range the horizontal line through y meets the curve at only one point, then the
function is one-to-one.
So we may say, the function represented by a curve is one-to-one if and only if for all y in the
range, the horizontal line through the point y meets the curve at exactly one point.
The function represented by a curve is onto if and only if for all y in the co-domain, the horizontal
line through the point y meets the curve atleast one point.
The curve given in Figure 1.32 represents a function from [0, 4] which is not onto if the co-domain
contains [1, 3]. The curve given in Figure 1.33 represents a one-to-one function from [0, 4] to R and
the curve given in Figure 1.34 represents a function from [0, 4] to R which is not one-to-one.
Testing whether a given curve represents a one-to-one function, onto function or not by drawing
horizontal lines is called horizontal line test or simply horizontal test.
Further by seeing the diagrams in Illustration 1.2 and Figures 1.5 to Figure 1.7, the function
(i) f : R → R defined by f (x) = 2x is an one-to-one and onto function.
(ii) f : R → R defined by f (x) = x2 is neither
√ one-to-one nor onto.
(iii) f : [0, ∞) → R defined by f (x) = + x is√an one-to-one but not onto function.
(iv) f : [0, ∞) → [0, ∞) defined by f (x) √
= + x is an one-to-one and onto function.
(v) f : [0, ∞) → R defined by f (x) = − x is one-to-one
√ but not onto function.
(vi) f : [0, ∞) → (−∞, 0] defined by f (x) = − x is one-to-one and onto function.
Example√ 1.21 Find the largest possible domain for the real valued function f defined by
f (x) = x2 − 5x + 6.
Solution:
As we are finding the square root of x2 − 5x + 6, we must
have x2 −5x+6 ≥ 0 for all x in the domain. For this, follow
–É 2 3 É
the given procedure.
Solving x2 − 5x + 6 = 0, we get x = 2 and 3. Now draw Figure 1.35
the number line as in Figure 1.35.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1
Example 1.22 Find the domain of f (x) = 1−2 cos x
.
Solution:
The function is defined for all x ∈ R except 1 − 2 cos x = 0. That is, except cos x = 12 . That is
except x = 2nπ ± π3 , n ∈ Z. Hence the domain is R − {2nπ ± π3 }, n ∈ Z
1
Example 1.23 Find the range of the function f (x) = 1−3 cos x
.
Solution:
Clearly,
−1 ≤ cos x ≤ 1
⇒ 3 ≥ −3 cos x ≥ −3
⇒ −3 ≤ −3 cos x ≤ 3
⇒ 1−3 ≤ 1 − 3 cos x ≤ 1+3
√
2
Example 1.24 Find the largest possible domain for the real valued function given by f (x) = √9−x .
x2 −1
Solution:
If x < −3 or x > 3, then x2 will be greater than 9 and hence 9 − x2 will become negative which
has no square root in R. So x must lie on the interval [−3, 3].
Also if x ≥ −1 and x ≤ 1, then x2 − 1 will become negative or zero. If it is negative, x2 − 1
has no square root in R. If it is zero, f is not defined. So x must lie outside [−1, 1]. That is, x must
lie on (−∞, −1) ∪ (1, ∞). Combining these two conditions, the largest possible domain forf is
[−3, 3] ∩ ((−∞, −1) ∪ (1, ∞)). That is, [−3, −1) ∪ (1, 3].
Draw the number line and plot the intervals to get the required domain interval.
29 1.6 Functions
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
X Y Y Z
f
a x x g p
b y y q
c z z r
gf
X Y Z
f g
a p
x
b q
y
c r
z
Figure 1.38
Now we can define a function h : X → Z in a natural way. To find the image of a under h, we
first see the image of a under f ; it is x; then we see the image of this x under g; this is r. That is,
h(a) = r. Similarly, we declare h(b) = q and h(c) = q. In this way we can define a new function h.
This h is called the composition of f with g.
Definition 1.8
Let f : X → Y and g : Y → Z be two functions. Then the function h : X → Z defined as
h(x) = g(f (x)) for every x ∈ X is called the composition of f with g. It is denoted by g ◦ f
(Read this as f composite with g). (See Figures 1.38 and 1.39.)
g g(f(x))
f(x)
x f
Figure 1.39
Example 1.25 Let f = {(1, 2), (3, 4), (2, 2)} and g = {(2, 1), (3, 1), (4, 2)}. Find g ◦ f and f ◦ g.
Solution:
To check whether compositions can be defined, let us find the domain and range of these functions.
Domain of f = {1, 2, 3}, Range of f = {2, 4}, Domain of g = {2, 3, 4} and Range of g =
{1, 2}. Since the range of f is contained in the domain of g we can define g ◦ f ; so as to find the
image of 1 under g ◦ f , we first find the image of 1 under f and then its image under g. The image
of 1 under f is 2 and its image under g is 1. So (g ◦ f )(1) = g(f (1)) = g(2) = 1.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Similarly we find that (g ◦ f )(2) = 1 and (g ◦ f )(3) = 2. So g ◦ f = {(1, 1), (2, 1), (3, 2)}.
Similarly f ◦ g = {(2, 2), (3, 2), (4, 2)}.
Example 1.26 Let f = {(1, 4), (2, 5), (3, 5)} and g = {(4, 1), (5, 2), (6, 4)}. Find g ◦ f . Can you
find f ◦ g?
Solution:
Clearly, g ◦ f = {(1, 1), (2, 2), (3, 2)}. But f ◦ g is not defined because the range of g = {1, 2, 4} is
not contained in the domain of f = {1, 2, 3}.
Example 1.27 Let f and g be the two functions from R to R defined by f (x) = 3x − 4 and
g(x) = x2 + 3. Find g ◦ f and f ◦ g.
Solution:
We have,
(g ◦ f )(x) = g(f (x)) = g(3x − 4) = (3x − 4)2 + 3 = 9x2 − 24x + 19.
(f ◦ g)(x) = f (g(x)) = f (x2 + 3) = 3(x2 + 3) − 4 = 3x2 + 5.
Theorem 1.2: Let f : A → B and g : B → C be two functions. If f and g are one-to-one, then g ◦ f
is one-to-one.
Proof. Let x 6= y in A. Since f is one-to-one, f (x) 6= f (y). Since g is one-to-one, g(f (x)) 6= g(f (y)).
That is, x 6= y ⇒ (g ◦ f )(x) 6= (f ◦ g)(y). Hence g ◦ f is one-to-one.
gf
X Y Z
f g
a p
x
b q
y
z
Figure 1.40
Clearly f and g ◦ f are one-to-one. But g is not one-to-one. Thus from the above diagram it
shows that the statement is not true.
31 1.6 Functions
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 1.29 Let f, g : R → R be defined as f (x) = 2x − |x| and g(x) = 2x + |x|. Find f ◦ g.
Solution:
We know
−x if x≤0
|x| =
x if x>0
So
2x − (−x) if x≤0
f (x) =
2x − x if x>0
Thus
3x if x≤0
f (x) =
x if x>0
Also
2x + (−x) if x≤0
g(x) =
2x + x if x>0
Thus
x if x≤0
g(x) =
3x if x>0
Let x ≤ 0. Then
(f ◦ g)(x) = f (g(x)) = f (x) = 3x.
X Y
a f x
b y
c z
Figure 1.41
If we look this function in a mirror, we get a function from Y to X. Let us call that function as g.
Then g is a function from Y to X defined by g(x) = b, g(y) = c, g(z) = a.
This function g is an example for the inverse of f . Now we define the inverse of a function.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Definition 1.9
Let f : X → Y be a bijection. The function g : Y → X defined by g(y) = x if f (x) = y, is
called the inverse of f and is denoted by f −1 .
If a function f has an inverse, then we say that f is invertible. There is a nice relationship between
composition of functions and inverse.
Let f : X → Y be a bijection and g : Y → X be its inverse. Then g ◦f = IX and f ◦g = IY where
IX and IY are identity functions on X and Y respectively. Moreover, if f : X → Y and g : Y → X
are functions such that g ◦ f = IX and f ◦ g = IY , then both f and g are bijections and they are
inverses to each other; that is f −1 = g and g −1 = f .
Using the discussions above, the terms invertible and inverse can be defined in some other way as
follows:
Definition 1.10
A function f : X → Y is said to be invertible if there exists a function g : Y → X such that
g ◦ f = IX and f ◦ g = IY where IX and IY are identity functions on X and Y respectively. In
this case, g is called the inverse of f and g is denoted by f −1 .
Example 1.30 If f : R → R is defined by f (x) = 2x − 3 prove that f is a bijection and find its
inverse.
Solution:
Method 1:
One-to-one : Let f (x) = f (y). Then 2x−3 = 2y −3; this implies that x = y. That is, f (x) = f (y)
implies that x = y. Thus f is one-to-one.
Onto : Let y ∈ R. Let x = y+3 2
. Then f (x) = 2( y+3
2
) − 3 = y. Thus f is onto. This also can
be proved by saying the following statement. The range of f is R (how?) which is equal to the
co-domain and hence f is onto.
y+3 y+3
Inverse Let y = 2x − 3. Then y + 3 = 2x and hence x = . Thus f −1 (y) = . By
2 2
x+3
replacing y as x, we get f −1 (x) = .
2
33 1.6 Functions
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Method 2:
y+3 y+3
Let y = 2x − 3. Then x = . Let g(y) = .
2 2
Now
(2x − 3) + 3
(g ◦ f )(x) = g(f (x)) = g(2x − 3) = = x.
2
y+3 y+3
(f ◦ g)(y) = f (g(y)) = f =2 − 3 = y.
2 2
Thus, g ◦ f = IX andf ◦ g = IY
This implies that f and g are bijections and inverses to each other. Hence f is a bijection and
y+3 x+3
f −1 (y) = . Replacing y by x we get, f −1 (x) = .
2 2
Definition 1.11
Let X be any set. Let f and g be real valued functions defined on X. Define, for all x ∈ X
• (f + g)(x) = f (x) + g(x).
• (f − g)(x) = f (x) − g(x).
• (f
g)(x)
= f (x)g(x).
• g (x) = fg(x)
f (x)
, where g(x) 6= 0.
• (cf )(x) = cf (x), where c is a real constant.
• (−f )(x) = −f (x).
Note that the domain may be any set, not necessarily a set of numbers. For example if X is a set of
students of a class, f and g functions representing the marks obtained by the students in two tests,
then the function f + g represent the total marks of the students in the two tests. It is easy to see that
the operations addition, subtraction, multiplication and division defined above satisfy the following
properties.
• (f + g) + h = f + (g + h)
• f +g =g+f
• 0 + f = f + 0, where 0 is the zero function defined by 0(x) = 0 for all x.
• f + (−f ) = (−f ) + f = 0
• f (g + h) = f g + f h
• (c1 + c2 )f = c1 f + c2 f where c1 and c2 are real constants.
We can list many more properties of these operations. The proofs are simple; however let us prove
only one to show a way in which these properties can be proved.
Let us prove f (g + h) = f g + f h. To prove f (g + h) = f g + f h we have to prove that
(f (g + h))(x) = (f g + f h)(x) for all x in the domain.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
where ai are constants, is called a polynomial function. Since the right hand side of the equality
defining the function is a polynomial, this function is called a polynomial function.
(ii) The function f : R → R defined by f (x) = ax + b where a 6= 0 and b are constants, is called a
linear function. A function which is not linear is called a non-linear function.
Clearly a linear function is a polynomial function. The graph of this function is a straight
line; a straight line is called a linear curve; so this function is called a linear function. (one may
come across different definitions for linear functions in higher study of mathematics.)
(iii) Let a be a non-negative constant. Consider the function f : R → R defined by f (x) = ax .
If a = 0, x 6= 0 then the function becomes the zero function and if a = 1, then function
f : R → R defined by f (x) = ax is the constant function f (x) = 1. [See, Figures 1.42 and
1.43].
y y
3x
y= x
e
2x
4 4
y=
ex
y=
y=
y=
3e 3
e–
x
2 2
1 1
–3 –2 –1 1 2 3 x –3 –2 –1 1 2 3 x
–1 –1
When a > 1, the function f (x) = ax is called an exponential function. Moreover, any
function having x in the “power” is called as an exponential function.
e is a special irrational number lies between 2 and 3. We will study more about e
in the subsequent chapters.
(iv) Let a > 1 be a constant. The function f : (0, ∞) → R defined by f (x) = loga x is called a
logarithmic function. In fact, the inverse of an exponential function f (x) = ax on a suitable
domain is called a logarithmic function. [See, Figure 1.44].
(v) The real valued function f defined by f (x) = p(x)
q(x)
on a suitable domain, where p(x) and q(x)
are polynomials, q(x) 6= 0, is called a rational function. In fact, the domain of this function is
the set obtained from R by removing the real numbers at which q(x) = 0.
35 1.6 Functions
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
2
log2x
logex
1 log3x
1 2 e 3 x
–1
Figure 1.44
(vi) If f is a real valued function such that f (x) 6= 0, then the real valued function g defined by
1
g(x) = f (x) on a suitable domain is called the reciprocal function of f . The domain of g is the
set obtained from R by removing the real numbers at which f (x) = 0. For example, the largest
1
possible domain of f (x) = x−1 is R − {1}.
Let us see two more categories of functions.
Definition 1.12
A function f : R → R is said to be an odd function if f (−x) = −f (x) for all x ∈ R. It is said
to be an even function if f (−x) = f (x) for all x ∈ R. [See, Figures 1.45 and 1.46].
y y
f (x)
f (x)
–x x x –x x x
f (–x)
The function defined by f (x) = x, f (x) = 2x and f (x) = x3 + 2x are some examples for odd
functions. The functions defined by f (x) = x2 , f (x) = 3, f (x) = x4 + x2 and f (x) = |x| are some
examples for even functions. Note that the function f (x) = x + x2 is neither even nor odd.
We can prove the following results.
(i) The sum of two odd functions is an odd function.
(ii) The sum of two even functions is an even function
(iii) The product of two odd functions is an even function.
(iv) The product of two even functions is an even function.
(v) The product of an odd function and an even function is an odd function.
(vi) The only function which is both odd and even function is the zero function.
(vii) The product of a positive constant and an even function is an even function.
(viii) The product of a negative constant and an even function is also an even function.
(ix) The product of a constant and an odd function is an odd function.
(x) There are functions which are neither odd nor even.
Let us prove one of the above properties. The other properties can be proved similarly.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Theorem 1.4: The product of an odd function and an even function is an odd function.
Proof. Let f be an odd function and g be an even function. Let h = f g. Now
h(−x) = (f g)(−x) = f (−x)g(−x) = −f (x)g(x) (as f is odd and g is even)
= −h(x)
Thus h is an odd function. This shows that f g is an odd function.
If one function is not odd then don’t think that the function is an even function. There
are plenty of functions which are neither even nor odd.
Exercise - 1.3
1. Suppose that 120 students are studying in 4 sections of eleventh standard in a school. Let A denote
the set of students and B denote the set of the sections. Define a relation from A to B as “x related
to y if the student x belongs to the section y”. Is this relation a function? What can you say about
the inverse relation? Explain your answer.
2. Write the values of f at −4, 1, −2, 7, 0 if
−x + 4 if − ∞ < x ≤ −3
x+4 if − 3 < x < −2
2
f (x) = x − x if − 2 ≤ x < 1
x − x2 if 1 ≤ x < 7
0 otherwise
4. State whether the following relations are functions or not. If it is a function check for one-to-
oneness and ontoness. If it is not a function, state why?
(i) If A = {a, b, c} and f = {(a, c), (b, c), (c, b)}; (f : A → A).
(ii) If X = {x, y, z} and f = {(x, y), (x, z), (z, x)}; (f : X → X).
5. Let A = {1, 2, 3, 4} and B = {a, b, c, d}. Give a function from A → B for each of the following:
(i) neither one-to-one nor onto. (ii) not one-to-one but onto.
(iii) one-to-one but not onto. (iv) one-to-one and onto.
1
6. Find the domain of .
1 − 2 sin x √
4 − x2
7. Find the largest possible domain of the real valued function f (x) = √ .
x2 − 9
1
8. Find the range of the function .
2 cos x − 1
9. Show that the relation xy = −2 is a function for a suitable domain. Find the domain and the range
of the function.
10. If f, g : R → R are defined by f (x) = |x| + x and g(x) = |x| − x, find g ◦ f and f ◦ g.
37 1.6 Functions
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
11. If f, g, h are real valued functions defined on R, then prove that (f + g) ◦ h = f ◦ h + g ◦ h. What
can you say about f ◦ (g + h)? Justify your answer.
12. Iff : R → R is defined by f (x) = 3x − 5, prove that f is a bijection and find its inverse.
13. The weight of the muscles of a man is a function of his body weight x and can be expressed as
W (x) = 0.35x. Determine the domain of this function.
14. The distance of an object falling is a function of time t and can be expressed as s(t) = −16t2 .
Graph the function and determine if it is one-to-one.
15. The total cost of airfare on a given route is comprised of the base cost C and the fuel surcharge S
in rupee. Both C and S are functions of the mileage m; C(m) = 0.4m + 50 and S(m) = 0.03m.
Determine a function for the total cost of a ticket in terms of the mileage and find the airfare for
flying 1600 miles.
16. A salesperson whose annual earnings can be represented by the function A(x) = 30, 000 + 0.04x,
where x is the rupee value of the merchandise he sells. His son is also in sales and his earnings
are represented by the function S(x) = 25, 000 + 0.05x. Find (A + S)(x) and determine the total
family income if they each sell Rupees 1, 50, 00, 000 worth of merchandise.
17. The function for exchanging American dollars for Singapore Dollar on a given day is f (x) =
1.23x, where x represents the number of American dollars. On the same day the function for
exchanging Singapore Dollar to Indian Rupee is g(y) = 50.50y, where y represents the number
of Singapore dollars. Write a function which will give the exchange rate of American dollars in
terms of Indian rupee.
18. The owner of a small restaurant can prepare a particular meal at a cost of Rupees 100. He estimates
that if the menu price of the meal is x rupees, then the number of customers who will order that
meal at that price in an evening is given by the function D(x) = 200 − x. Express his day revenue,
total cost and profit on this meal as functions of x.
5x 160
19. The formula for converting from Fahrenheit to Celsius temperatures is y = − . Find the
9 9
inverse of this function and determine whether the inverse is also a function.
20. A simple cipher takes a number and codes it, using the function f (x) = 3x−4. Find the inverse of
this function, determine whether the inverse is also a function and verify the symmetrical property
about the line y = x (by drawing the lines).
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
In the case of reflections and translations, they produce graphs congruent to the original graph; that
is, the size and the shape of the graph does not change, but in dilation, it produce graphs with shapes
related to those of the original graph.
Reflection
The reflection of the graph of a function with respect to a line ` is the graph that is symmetric to
it with respect to `. A reflection is the mirror image of the graph where line ` is the mirror of the
reflection. (See Figure 1.47.)
f ℓ
f¢
Figure 1.47
Here f 0 is the mirror image of f with respect to `. Every point of f has a corresponding image in
0
f . Some useful reflections of y = f (x) are
(i) The graph y = −f (x) is the reflection of the graph of f about the x-axis.
(ii) The graph y = f (−x) is the reflection of the graph of f about the y-axis.
(iii) The graph of y = f −1 (x) is the reflection of the graph of f in y = x.
y = x2
x
y = –x 2
Figure 1.48
For the curve f (x) = x2 , −f (x) = −x2 . Hence, y = −x2 is the reflection of y = x2 about x-axis.
(See Figure 1.48.)
y 2 = x and y 2 = −x.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
y = Ö(–x) y = Öx
Figure 1.49
√ √ √
For the curve f (x)√= x, we have f (−x) = −x and hence f (−x) = −x where x < 0, is the
reflection of f (x) = x about y-axis. (See Figure 1.49.)
Illustration 1.7 Consider the functions:
y = ex y=x
y = log x
Figure 1.50
We know that, y = ex is the inverse function of y = loge x and hence y = ex is the reflection of
y = loge x about y = x. (See Figure 1.50.)
Translation
A translation of a graph is a vertical or horizontal shift of the graph that produces congruent graphs.
y = f (x + c), c > 0 causes the shift to the left.
y = f (x − c), c > 0 causes the shift to the right.
The graph of
y = f (x) + d, d > 0 causes the shift to the upward.
y = f (x) − d, d > 0 causes the shift to the downward.
Illustration 1.8 Consider the functions:
(i) f (x) = |x| (ii) f (x) = |x − 1| (iii) f (x) = |x + 1|
y
y = |x+1|
y = |x|
y = |x–1|
–1 0 1 x
Figure 1.51
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
f (x) = |x − 1| causes the graph of the function f (x) = |x| shifts to the right for one unit.
f (x) = |x + 1| causes the graph of the function f (x) = |x| shifts to the left for one unit.
(See Figure 1.51.)
Illustration 1.9 Consider the functions:
(i) f (x) = |x| (ii) f (x) = |x| − 1 (iii) f (x) = |x| + 1
y
y = |x|+1
y = |x|
y = |x|–1
0 x
–1
Figure 1.52
f (x) = |x| − 1 causes the graph of the functionf (x) = |x| shifts to the downward for one unit.
f (x) = |x| + 1 causes the graph of the function f (x) = |x| shifts to the upward for one unit.
(See Figure 1.52.)
Dilation
Dilation is also a transformation which causes the curve stretches (expands) or compresses (con-
tracts). Multiplying a function by a positive constant vertically stretches or compresses its graph; that
is, the graph moves away from x-axis or towards x-axis.
If the positive constant is greater than one, the graph moves away from the x-axis. If the positive
constant is less than one, the graph moves towards the x-axis.
Illustration 1.10 Consider the functions:
(i) f (x) = x2 (ii) f (x) = 21 x2 (iii) f (x) = 2x2
y
2
2
y = 2x
y=x
2
x 2/
y=
Figure 1.53
f (x) = 21 x2 causes the graph of the function f (x) = x2 stretches towards the x-axis since the
multiplying factor is 12 which is less than one.
f (x) = 2x2 causes the graph of the function f (x) = x2 compresses towards the y− axis
that is, moves away from the x−axis since the multiplying factor is 2 which is greater than one.
(See Figure 1.53.)
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
2
x+1)
y = x2 + 1
y=(
y = x2
1
–1 0 x
Figure 1.54
f (x) = x2 + 1 causes the graph of the function f (x) = x2 shifts to the upward for one unit.
f (x) = (x + 1)2 causes the graph of the function f (x) = x2 shifts to the left for one unit.
(See Figure 1.54.)
Illustration 1.12 Compare and contrast the graphs y = x2 − 1, y = 4(x2 − 1) and y = (4x)2 − 1
y
y y 10
) 1
5 20 8
(x 2 –
–1
) 1
4 16 6
y=4
y = x2
(x 2 –
–1
3 12 4
y=4
y = x2
2 8 2
1 4
–3 –2 –1 1 2 3 x
–2
–4 –3 –2 –1 1 2 3 4 x –4 –3 –2 –1 1 2 3 4 x
–1 –4 –4
The graphs Figures 1.55 and 1.56 look identical until we compare the scales on the y-axis. The
scale in Figure 1.56 is four times as large, reflecting the multiplication of the original function by
4 (Figure 1.55). The effect looks different when the functions are plotted on the same scale as in
Figure 1.57.
The graph of y = (4x)2 − 1 is shown in Figure 1.58. Can you spot the difference between Figure
1.55 and Figure 1.58? In this case, x-scale has now changed, by the same factor of 4 as in the function
(Figure 1.58). To see this, note that substituting x = 14 into (4x)2 − 1 produces 12 − 1, exactly the
same as substituting x = 1 into the original function (Figure 1.55). When plotted on the same set of
axes (as in Figure 1.59) the parabola y = (4x)2 − 1 looks thinner. Here, the x-intercepts are different,
but y-intercepts are the same.
y y
5
–1
y = (4x)2 – 1
4 4
y = x2
–1
3
4 x) 2
2 2
y=(
–1 –1/4 1/4 1 x –2 2 x
–1 –1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Illustration 1.13 By using the same concept applied in Illustration 1.12, graphs of y = sin x and
y = sin 2x, and also their combined graphs are given Figures 1.60, 1.61 and 1.62. The minimum
and maximum values of sin x and sin 2x are the same. But they have different x-intercepts. The x-
intercepts for y = sin x are ±nπ and for y = sin 2x are ± 12 nπ, n ∈ Z.
y y y
5 5 5
4 4 4
3 3 3
2 2 2
y = sinx y = sin2x y = sin2x y = sinx
1 1 1
–2π –3π/2 –π –π/2 π/2 π 3π/2 2π x –2π –3π/2 –π –π/2 π/2 π 3π/2 2π x –2π –3π/2 –π –π/2 π/2 π 3π/2 2π x
–1 –1 –1
–2 –2 –2
In the beginning of the section we talked about drawing the graph of y = 2 sin(x − 1) + 3. Now
we are well equipped to draw the curve and even we can draw more complicated curve.
Illustration 1.14 Let us now draw the graph of y = 2 sin(x − 1) + 3.
It is clear that the curve can be obtained from that of y = sin x using translation and dilation.
So first we draw y = sin x. From that it is easy to draw the curve y = sin(x − 1); then draw
y = 2 sin(x − 1) and finally y = 2 sin(x − 1) + 3. (See Figures 1.63 to 1.66.)
y y
5 5
4 4
3 3
2 2
y = sinx y = sin (x–1)
1 1
–2π –3π/2 –π –π/2 π/2 π 3π/2 2π x –2π –3π/2 –π –π/2 π/2 π 3π/2 2π x
–1 –1
–2 –2
y y
5 5
4 4
3 3
y = 2 sin (x–1)
2 2
1 1
y = 2 sin (x–1) + 3
–2π –3π/2 –π –π/2 π/2 π 3π/2 2π x –2π –3π/2 –π –π/2 π/2 π 3π/2 2π x
–1 –1
–1
–2 –2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 1.4
1. For the curve y = x3 given in Figure 1.67, draw
(i) y = −x3 (ii) y = x3 + 1 (iii) y = x3 − 1 (iv) y = (x + 1)3 with the same scale.
y
3
y = x3
2
1
–3 –2 –1 1 2 3 x
–1
–2
–3
Figure 1.67
1
2. For the curve y = x( 3 ) given in Figure 1.68, draw
1 1 1 1
(i) y = −x( 3 ) (ii) y = x( 3 ) + 1 (iii) y = x( 3 ) − 1 (iv) y = (x + 1)( 3 )
y
3
y = x1/3
2
1
–3 –2 –1 1 2 3 x
–1
–2
–3
Figure 1.68
√
3. Graph the functions f (x) = x3 and g(x) = 3 x on the same coordinate plane. Find f ◦ g and
graph it on the plane as well. Explain your results.
4. Write the steps to obtain the graph of the function y = 3(x − 1)2 + 5 from the graph y = x2 .
5. From the curve y = sin x, graph the functions π
(i) y = sin(−x) (ii) y = − sin(−x) (iii) y = sin + x which is cos x
π 2
(iv) y = sin − x which is also cos x (refer trigonometry)
2
6. From the curve y = x, draw
1
(i) y = −x (ii) y = 2x (iii) y = x + 1 (iv) y = x + 1 (v) 2x + y + 3 = 0.
2
7. From the curve y = |x|, draw (i) y = |x − 1| + 1 (ii) y = |x + 1| − 1 (iii) y = |x + 2| − 3.
8. From the curve y = sin x, draw y = sin |x| (Hint: sin(−x) = − sin x.)
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Activities
Balls and Runs
What a Celebration! What a Relation!! What a Function!!!
–5 –4 –3 –2 –1 1 2 3 4 5 x
–1
–2
–3
Figure 1.69
45 Activities
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 1.5
Choose the correct or the most suitable answer.
1. If A = {(x, y) : y = ex , x ∈ R} and B = {(x, y) : y = e−x , x ∈ R} then n(A ∩ B) is
(1) Infinity (2) 0 (3) 1 (4) 2
3. The relation R defined on a set A = {0, −1, 1, 2} by xRy if |x2 + y 2 | ≤ 2, then which one of the
following is true?
(1) R = {(0, 0), (0, −1), (0, 1), (−1, 0), (−1, 1), (1, 2), (1, 0)}
(2) R−1 = {(0, 0), (0, −1), (0, 1), (−1, 0), (1, 0)}
(3) Domain of R is {0, −1, 1, 2}
(4) Range of R is {0, −1, 1}
4. If f (x) = |x − 2| + |x + 2|, x ∈ R, then
−2x if x ∈ (−∞, −2]
(1) f (x) = 4 if x ∈ (−2, 2]
2x if x ∈ (2, ∞)
2x if x ∈ (−∞, −2]
(2) f (x) = 4x if x ∈ (−2, 2]
−2x if x ∈ (2, ∞)
−2x if x ∈ (−∞, −2]
(3) f (x) = −4x if x ∈ (−2, 2]
2x if x ∈ (2, ∞)
−2x if x ∈ (−∞, −2]
(4) f (x) = 2x if x ∈ (−2, 2]
2x if x ∈ (2, ∞)
5. Let R be the set of all real numbers. Consider the following subsets of the plane R × R:
S = {(x, y) : y = x + 1 and 0 < x < 2} and T = {(x, y) : x − y is an integer }
Then which of the following is true?
(1) T is an equivalence relation but S is not an equivalence relation.
(2) Neither S nor T is an equivalence relation
(3) Both S and T are equivalence relation
(4) S is an equivalence relation but T is not an equivalence relation.
6. Let A and B be subsets of the universal set N, the set of natural numbers. Then A0 ∪[(A∩B)∪B 0 ] is
(1) A (2) A0 (3) B (4) N
7. The number of students who take both the subjects Mathematics and Chemistry is 70. This
represents 10% of the enrollment in Mathematics and 14% of the enrollment in Chemistry. The
number of students take at least one of these two subjects, is
(1) 1120 (2) 1130 (3) 1100 (4) insufficient data
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
10. If two sets A and B have 17 elements in common, then the number of elements common to the
set A × B and B × A is
(1) 217 (2) 172 (3) 34 (4) insufficient data
13. Let R be the universal relation on a set X with more than one element. Then R is
(1) not reflexive (2) not symmetric (3) transitive (4) none of the above
14. Let X = {1, 2, 3, 4} and R = {(1, 1), (1, 2), (1, 3), (2, 2), (3, 3), (2, 1), (3, 1), (1, 4), (4, 1)}. Then
R is
(1) reflexive (2) symmetric (3) transitive (4) equivalence
1
15. The range of the function 1−2 sin x
is
(1) (−∞, −1) ∪ ( 31 , ∞) (2) (−1, 13 ) (3) [−1, 13 ] (4) (−∞, −1] ∪ [ 13 , ∞).
17. The rule f (x) = x2 is a bijection if the domain and the co-domain are given by
(1) R, R (2) R, (0, ∞) (3) (0, ∞), R (4) [0, ∞), [0, ∞)
18. The number of constant functions from a set containing m elements to a set containing n elements
is
(1) mn (2) m (3) n (4) m + n
21. Let X = {1, 2, 3, 4}, Y = {a, b, c, d} and f = {(1, a), (4, b), (2, c), (3, d), (2, d)}. Then f is
(1) an one-to-one function (2) an onto function
(3) a function which is not one-to-one (4) not a function
47 Exercise
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
x if x < 1
2
22. The inverse of f (x) = x√ if 1 ≤ x ≤ 4 is
8 x if x > 4
x√ if x < 1
−1 x if 1 ≤ x ≤ 16
(1) f (x) =
x2
if x > 16
64
−x
√ if x < 1
−1 x if 1 ≤ x ≤ 16
(2) f (x) =
x2
if x > 16
642
x√ if x < 1
−1 x if 1 ≤ x ≤ 16
(3) f (x) =
x2
if x > 16
64
2x
√ if x < 1
−1 x if 1 ≤ x ≤ 16
(4) f (x) =
x2
8
if x > 16
23. Let f : R → R be defined by f (x) = 1 − |x|. Then the range of f is
(1) R (2) (1, ∞) (3) (−1, ∞) (4) (−∞, 1]
is (1) an odd function (2) neither an odd function nor an even function
(3) an even function (4) both odd function and even function.
Summary
In this chapter we have acquired the knowledge of
• Set
– Subset, super set, trivial subset, proper subset, improper subset
– Empty set, power set, universal set, singleton set, finite set, infinite set
– Cardinality of a set
– Union, Intersection, Complement, Set Difference, Symmetric Difference
– Properties and De Morgan Laws
– Cartesian Product
• Intervals
– Constants, dependent and independent variables
– Open, Closed, finite and infinite intervals and neighbourhoods;
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
• Relations
– Domain and range of relation
– Extreme relations (empty and universal)
– Inverse of a relation
– Reflexive, Symmetric, Transitive, Equivalence Relations
• Functions
– Definition, domain, co-domain, range, image, pre-image,
– Tabular, graphical, analytical and piecewise representations,
– Identity function, constant function, zero function, modulus function, signum function,
greatest integer function, smallest integer function,
– Injective, surjective and bijective functions,
– Vertical test and Horizontal test,
– Composition of functions, inverse of a function,
– Addition and multiplication of real valued functions,
– Polynomial function, linear function, exponential function, logarithmic function, rational
function, reciprocal function,
– Odd and Even functions.
• Graphing functions
– Reflection, translation, dilation
– Drawing graph of some seems to be complicated functions.
ICT CORNER-1(a)
Expected Outcome ⇒
Step–1
Open the Browser and type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code.
Step–2
A workbook named “Graph of Special Functions” will open. 7 worksheets are given in this workbook
related to Functions and Graph. Select a worksheet named “More Modulus Functions”
Step–3
Right side of the work sheet There are check boxes for many modulus functions
Step–4
You can click on any check box to view the Graph. Now Move the Slider a to change the function and
observe.
49 ICT CORNER-1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Browse in the link Graph of Special Functions: https://ggbm.at/ucz465auor Scan the QR Code.
ICT CORNER-1(b)
Expected Outcome ⇒
Step–1
Open the Browser and type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code.
Step–2
GeoGebra Workbook called “TRANSFORMATION OF FUNCTIONS” will appear. In that there
are 10 worksheets related to your lesson.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Step–3
Select the work sheets one-one by one and analyse the transformations 1. Translation, 2. Reflection
and 3. Dilation.
Also, there is a worksheet for comparison of Sine functions. All you have to do is move the sliders in
the worksheets and compare.
51 ICT CORNER-1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Basic Algebra
Chapter 2
I see it but I don’t believe it.
Richard Dedekind
2.1 Introduction
Algebra is a branch of mathematics in which one expresses relations among quantities by using
symbols to represent these quantities. The symbols are called the variables. In this class we shall allow
the variables to represent real numbers only. One can carry out manipulations and computations using
variables just as one does with numbers. That is, one may substitute real numbers for the variables in
the expression and the resulting value will also be a real number. Once a quantity or a mathematical
statement is expressed in terms of variables, it is possible to substitute specific numerical values for
those variables. This makes algebra a very powerful tool. For this reason the subject of algebra has
very wide application, not only within mathematics, but also in other disciplines and in real life. The
notion of real numbers is fundamental to the whole of mathematics. The real number system was well
understood only in the nineteenth century. The need for extending
√ the rational numbers arose quite
early in the history of mathematics. Pythagoreans knew that 2 was not a rational number. Certain
constructions involving irrational numbers can be found in Shulbha Sutras, which date back to
around 800 BC(BCE). Aryabhata (476-550) had found approximations to π.
Indian mathematicians like Brahmagupta (598-670) and Bhaskaracharya
(1114-1185) had made contributions to the understanding of the real
numbers system and algebra. In his work Brahmagupta had solved
the general quadratic equation for both positive and negative roots.
Bhaskaracharya solved quadratic equations with more than one unknown
and found negative and irrational solutions. The most important real
number zero was the contribution by Indians.
Rene Descartes (1596-1650) introduced the term “real” to describe
roots of a polynomial distinguishing them from imaginary ones. A rig-
orous construction of real number system was due to Richard Dedekind
(1831-1916). Richard Dedekind
(1831-1916)
Learning Objectives
On completion of this chapter, the students are expected to know
• the concept of real numbers and their properties.
• the absolute value, polynomials, exponents, radicals, logarithms and functions of one
variables involving these concepts.
• how to solve equations, inequalities involving above mentioned functions.
• how to solve linear inequalities involving two variables and representing the solutions
graphically in the cartesian plane.
52
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
We have seen in earlier classes that rational numbers are precisely the set of terminating or infinite
periodic decimals. For example,
25 2
−5.0, −2.333 · · · , = 0.252525 · · · , = 0.66666 · · · , 7.14527836231231231 · · ·
99 3
Question:
Have we filled the whole line with rational numbers?
The answer to the above question is “No” as the following consideration demonstrates.√Consider
a square whose side has length 1 unit. Then by Pythagoras theorem its diagonal has length 2 units.
Ö2
1
Figure 2.1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
m is even.
Let m = 2k. Then, we have 2n2 = 4k 2 which gives n2 = 2k 2 .
Thus, n is also even.
It follows, that m and n are even numbers having a common factor 2.
Thus, we√arrived at a contradiction.
Hence, 2 is an irrational number.
Remark:
(i) Note that in the above proof we have assumed the contrary of what we wanted to prove and
arrived at a contradiction. This method of proof is called ‘proof by contradiction’.
(ii) There are points on the number line that are not represented by rational numbers.
(iii) We call those numbers on the number line that do not correspond to rational numbers as
irrational numbers. The set of all irrational numbers is denoted by Q0 (For number line see
Figure 1.2.)
Every real number is either a rational number or an irrational number, but not both. Thus,
R = Q ∪ Q0 and Q ∩ Q0 = ∅.
As we already knew that every terminating or infinite periodic decimal is a rational number, we
see that the decimal representation of an irrational number will neither be terminating nor infinite
periodic. The set R of real numbers can be visualized as the set of points on the number line such that
if x < y, then x lies to left of y.
Figure 2.2 demonstrates how the square roots of 2 and 3 can be identified on a number line.
√3 D 1
√2
O A
0 √2 1 B C 2
√3
Figure 2.2
We notice that N ⊂ W ⊂ Z ⊂ Q ⊂ R.
As we have already observed, irrational numbers occur in real life situations. Over 2000 years ago
people in the Orient and Egypt observed that the ratio of the circumference to the diameter is the same
for any circle. This constant was proved to be an irrational number by Johann Heinrich Lambert in
1767. The value of π rounded off to nine decimal places is equal to 3.141592654. The values 22 7
and
3.14, used in calculations (such as area of a circle or volume of a sphere) are only approximate values
for π.
The number π, which is the ratio of the circumference of a circle to its diameter, is an
irrational number.
Basic Algebra 54
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Now let us recall the properties of the real number system which is the foundation for mathematics.
Exercise - 2.1
√
1. Classify each element of { 7, −1 4
, 0, 3.14, 4, 22
7
} as a member of
N, Q, R − Q or Z.
√
2. Prove that 3 is an irrational number. √
(Hint: Follow the method that we have used to prove 2 6∈ Q.)
3. Are there two distinct irrational numbers such that their difference is a rational number? Justify.
4. Find two irrational numbers such that their sum is a rational number. Can you find two irrational
numbers whose product is a rational number.
1
5. Find a positive number smaller than 1000 . Justify.
2
and hence | · | defines a function known as absolute value function, from R onto [0, ∞) and the graph
of this function is discussed in Chapter 1.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) For any x ∈ R, we have |x| = | − x| and thus, |x| = |y| if and only if x = y or
x = −y.
(ii) |x − a| = r if and only if r ≥ 0 and x − a = r or x − a = −r.
Basic Algebra 56
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(ii) Let us prove that |x| > r if and only if x < −r or x > r.
Consider |x| > r. If r < 0, then every x ∈ R satisfies the inequality.
For r ≥ 0, there are two possibilities to consider.
Case (1). If x ≥ 0, then |x| = x > r.
Case (2). If x < 0, then |x| = −x > r, that is, x < −r.
So we have |x| > r, if and only if x < −r or x > r, that is, x ∈ (−∞, −r) ∪ (r, ∞).
Remark:
(i) For any a ∈ R, |x − a| ≤ r if and only if −r ≤ x − a ≤ r if and only if x ∈ [a − r, a + r].
(ii) For any a ∈ R, |x − a| ≥ r is equivalent to x − a ≤ −r or x − a ≥ r if and only if
x ∈ (−∞, a − r] ∪ [a + r, ∞).
2
Example 2.5 Solve
> 1, x 6= 4.
x − 4
Solution:
From the given inequality, we have that 2 > |x − 4|.
That is, −2 < x − 4 < 2 and x 6= 4.
Adding 4 throughout the inequality, we obtain 2 < x < 6 and x 6= 4.
So the solution set is (2, 4) ∪ (4, 6).
Exercise - 2.2
1. Solve for x:
(i) |3 − x| < 7. (ii) |4x − 5| ≥ −2. (iii) 3 − 43 x ≤ 14 .
(iv) |x| − 10 < −3.
1
2. Solve |2x−1| < 6 and express the solution using the interval notation.
3. Solve −3|x| + 5 ≤ −2 and graph the solution set in a number line.
4. Solve 2|x + 1| − 6 ≤ 7 and graph the solution set in a number line.
5. Solve 51 |10x − 2| < 1.
6. Solve |5x − 12| < −2.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 2.6 Our monthly electricity bill contains a basic charge, that is independent of units
consumed and a charge that depends on the units consumed. Let us say Electricity Board charges
Rs.110 as basic charge and charges Rs. 4 for each unit we use. If a person wants to keep his
electricity bill below Rs.250, then what should be his electricity usage?
Solution:
Let x denote the number of units used. Note that x ≥ 0. Then, his electricity bill is Rs. 110 + 4x.
The person wants his bill to be below Rs.250. Let us solve the inequality 110 + 4x < 250. Thus,
4x < 140; which gives 0 ≤ x < 35.
The person should keep his usage below 35 units in order to keep his bill below Rs.250.
y
7 f(x) = 3x–5
6
g(x) = x+1
5
4
3
2
1
–4 –3 –2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
–1
–2
–3
–4
–5
Figure 2.3
Basic Algebra 58
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 2.9 A girl A is reading a book having 446 pages and she has already finished reading 271
pages. She wants to finish reading this book within a week. What is the minimum number of pages
she should read per day to complete reading the book within a week?
Solution:
Let x denote the number of pages the girl should read per day. Then we need our x to satisfy
7x + 271 ≥ 446. Hence x ≥ 25; which implies that she should read at least 25 pages per day.
In all the above examples observe that each inequality has more than one solution. Inequalities in
general give rise to a range of solutions.
Exercise - 2.3
1. Represent the following inequalities in the interval notation:
(i) x ≥ −1 and x < 4 (ii) x ≤ 5 and x ≥ −3
(iii) x < −1 or x < 3 (iv) −2x > 0 or 3x − 4 < 11.
2. Solve 23x < 100 when (i) x is a natural number, (ii) x is an integer.
3. Solve −2x ≥ 9 when (i) x is a real number, (ii) x is an integer, (iii) x is a natural number.
3(x − 2) 5(2 − x) 5−x x
4. Solve: (i) ≤ . (ii) < − 4.
5 3 3 2
5. To secure A grade one must obtain an average of 90 marks or more in 5 subjects each of maximum
100 marks. If one scored 84, 87, 95, 91 in first four subjects, what is the minimum mark one scored
in the fifth subject to get A grade in the course?
6. A manufacturer has 600 litres of a 12 percent solution of acid. How many litres of a 30 percent
acid solution must be added to it so that the acid content in the resulting mixture will be more than
15 percent but less than 18 percent?
7. Find all pairs of consecutive odd natural numbers both of which are larger than 10 and their sum
is less than 40.
8. A model rocket is launched from the ground. The height h reached by the rocket after t seconds
from lift off is given by h(t) = −5t2 + 100t, 0 ≤ t ≤ 20. At what time the rocket is 495 feet above
the ground?
9. A plumber can be paid according to the following schemes: In the first scheme he will be paid
rupees 500 plus rupees 70 per hour, and in the second scheme he will be paid rupees 120 per hour.
If he works x hours, then for what value of x does the first scheme give better wages?
10. A and B are working on similar jobs but their monthly salaries differ by more than Rs 6000. If B
earns rupees 27000 per month, then what are the possibilities of A’s salary per month?
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
√ √ b
b2 −4ac b b2 −4ac
So x = 2a
− 2a
or x = − 2a
− .
√ 2a
−b± b2 −4ac
Hence, x = 2a
; which is called the quadratic formula.
Remark:
√
(i) Note that u is√defined as a real number only for u ≥ 0.
(ii) when we write u, we mean only the nonnegative root.
Note that P (x) = 0 has two distinct real solutions if b2 − 4ac > 0, the roots are real and equal if
b2 − 4ac = 0, and no real root if b2 − 4ac < 0.
Thus the curve intersects x-axis in two places if b2 − 4ac > 0, touches x-axis at only one point if
b2 − 4ac = 0, and does not intersect x-axis at any point if b2 − 4ac < 0.
That is why D = b2 − 4ac is called the discriminant of the quadratic function P (x) = ax2 + bx + c.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
y = x2 – 4x + 5
x
Figure 2.4
1 1
Example 2.10 If a and b are the roots of the equation x2 − px + q = 0, find the value of + .
a b
Solution:
Given that a and b are the roots of x2 − px + q = 0. Then, a + b = p and ab = q. Thus,
1 1 a+b p
+ = = .
a b ab q
Example 2.11 Find the complete set of values of a for which the quadratic x2 − ax + a + 2 = 0
has equal roots.
Solution:
The quadratic equation x2 − ax + a + 2 = 0 has equal roots.
So, its discriminant
√ = b2 − 4ac =
is zero. Thus, D √ 2
√ a − 4a − 8 = 0.
4± 48
So, a = 2 which gives a = 2 + 12, 2 − 12.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 2.4
1. Construct a quadratic equation with roots 7 and −3.√
2. A quadratic polynomial has one of its zeros 1 + 5 and it satisfies p(1) = 2. Find the quadratic
polynomial. √
3. If α and β are the roots of the quadratic equation x2 + 2x + 3 = 0, form a quadratic polynomial
with zeroes α1 , β1 .
4. If one root of k(x − 1)2 = 5x − 7 is double the other root, show that k = 2 or −25.
5. If the difference of the roots of the equation 2x2 − (a + 1)x + a − 1 = 0 is equal to their product,
then prove that a = 2.
6. Find the condition that one of the roots of ax2 + bx + c may be (i) negative of the other, (ii)
thrice the other, (iii) reciprocal of the other.
7. If the equations x2 − ax + b = 0 and x2 − ex + f = 0 have one root in common and if the second
equation has equal roots, then prove that ae = 2(b + f ).
8. Discuss the nature of roots of (i) −x2 + 3x + 1 = 0, (ii) 4x2 − x − 2 = 0, (iii) 9x2 + 5x = 0.
9. Without sketching the graphs, find whether the graphs of the following functions will intersect the
x-axis and if so in how many points.
(i) y = x2 + x + 2, (ii) y = x2 − 3x − 7, (iii) y = x2 + 6x + 9.
10. Write f (x) = x2 + 5x + 4 in completed square form.
Basic Algebra 62
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
y
4
(–2,0) (1/3,0)
–4 –2 2 4 x
–2
–4
y = 3x2 + 5x – 2
Figure 2.5
√
Example 2.15 Solve the equation 6 − 4x − x2 = x + 4.
Solution:
The given equation is equivalent to the system
(x + 4) ≥ 0 and 6 − 4x − x2 = (x + 4)2 .
This implies x ≥ −4 and x2 + 6x + 5 = 0. Thus, x = −1, −5.
But only x = −1 satisfies both the conditions. Hence, x = −1.
Exercise - 2.5
1. Solve 2x2 + x − 15 ≤ 0.
2. Solve −x2 + 3x − 2 ≥ 0.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
y
10
–5 –4 –3 –2 –1 0 1 2 3 4 5 x
–2
–4
–6
–8
–10
Figure 2.6
Suppose that f (x) and g(x) are polynomials where g(x) is not zero. The quotient fg(x)(x)
is called a
rational function, which is defined for all x ∈ R such that g(x) 6= 0. In general, a rational function
need not be a polynomial.
Basic Algebra 64
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Remainder Theorem
If a polynomial f (x) is divided by x−a, then the remainder is f (a). Thus the remainder c = f (a) = 0
if and only if x − a is a factor for f (x).
Definition 2.1
A real number a is said to be a zero of the polynomial f (x) if f (a) = 0. If x = a is a zero of
f (x), then x − a is a factor for f (x).
In general, if we can express f (x) as f (x) = (x − a)k .g(x) where g(a) 6= 0, then the value of k,
which depends on a, cannot exceed the degree of f (x). The value k is called the multiplicity of the
zero a.
(i) A polynomial function of degree n can have at most n distinct real zeros. It is
also possible that a polynomial function like P (x) = x2 + 1 has no real zeros at
all.
(ii) Suppose that P (x) is a polynomial function having rational coefficients. If a +
√ √
b p where a, b ∈ Q, p a prime, is a zero of P (x), then its conjugate a − b p is
also a zero.
(ii) Constructing polynomials with the given zeros and/or satisfying some additional conditions.
To address the problem of finding zeros of a polynomial function, some well known algebraic
identities are useful. What is an identity?
An equation is said to be an identity if that equation remains valid for all values in its domain. An
equation is called conditional equation if it is true only for some (not all) of values in its domain. Let
us recall the following identities.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 2.6
1. Find the zeros of the polynomial function f (x) = 4x2 − 25.
2. If x = −2 is one root of x3 − x2 − 17x = 22, then find the other roots of equation.
3. Find the real roots of x4 = 16.
4. Solve (2x + 1)2 − (3x + 2)2 = 0.
Example 2.16 Find a quadratic polynomial f (x) such that, f (0) = 1, f (−2) = 0 and f (1) = 0.
Solution:
Let f (x) = ax2 + bx + c be the polynomial satisfying the given conditions.
f (0) = a(0)2 +b(0)+c = 1, implies that c = 1. Now the other two conditions f (−2) = 0, f (1) = 0
give 4a − 2b + c = 0 and a + b + c = 0.
1
Using c = 1, we get 4a−2b = −1 and a+b = −1. Solving these two equations we get a = b = −
2
1 2 1
and thus, we have f (x) = − x − x + 1.
2 2
The above problem can also be solved in another way. x = −2, x = 1 are zeros of
f (x). Thus, f (x) = d(x + 2)(x − 1) for some constant d.
Now using f (0) = 1 gives −2d = 1, hence d = − 12 . So, f (x) = − 12 (x+2)(x−1) =
− 21 x2 − 21 x + 1.
Basic Algebra 66
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 2.19 Use the method of undetermined coefficients to find the sum of
1 + 2 + 3 + · · · + (n − 1) + n, n ∈ N
Solution:
Let S(n) = n + (n − 1) + (n − 2) + · · · + 2 + 1
= n + (n − 1) + (n − 2) + · · · + [n − (n − 2)] + [n − (n − 1)]
n−1 n−2 n − (n − 2) n − (n − 1)
= n 1+ + + ··· + +
n n n n
n−1 n−2
≤ n[1 + 1 + · · · + 1] since < 1, < 1, · · ·
n n
Thus, S(n) ≤ n2 .
Example 2.20 Find the roots of the polynomial equation (x − 1)3 (x + 1)2 (x + 5) = 0 and state
their multiplicity.
Solution:
Let f (x) = (x − 1)3 (x + 1)2 (x + 5) = 0. Clearly, we have x = 1, −1, −5.
Hence, the roots are 1 with multiplicity 3, −1 with multiplicity 2 and −5 with multiplicity 1.
√
Example 2.21 Solve x = x + 20 for x ∈ R.
Solution: √
Observe that x + 20 is defined only if x + 20 ≥ 0.
By definition, (x + 20) ≥ 0. So x is positive.
Now squaring we get x2 = x + 20. x2 − x − 20 = 0
(x − 5)(x + 4) = 0, which gives x = 5, x = −4
Since, x is positive, the required solution is x = 5.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 2.22 The equations x2 − 6x + a = 0 and x2 − bx + 6 = 0 have one root in common. The
other root of the first and the second equations are integers in the ratio 4 : 3. Find the common root.
Solution:
Let α be the common root.
Let α, 4β be the roots of x2 − 6x + a = 0.
Let α, 3β be the roots of x2 − bx + 6 = 0.
Then, 4αβ = a and 3αβ = 6 which give αβ = 2 and a = 8.
The roots of x2 − 6x + 8 = 0 are 2, 4.
If α = 2, then β = 1
If α = 4, then β = 21 which is not an integer.
Hence, the common root is 2.
Example 2.23 Find the values of p for which the difference between the roots of the equation
x2 + px + 8 = 0 is 2.
Solution:
Let α and β be the roots of the equation x2 + px + 8 = 0.
Then, α + β = −p, αβ = 8 and |α − β| = 2.
Now, (α + β)2 − 4αβ = (α − β)2 , which gives p2 − 32 = 4. Thus, p = ±6.
Exercise - 2.7
1. Factorize: x4 + 1. (Hint: Try completing the square.)
2. If x2 + x + 1 is a factor of the polynomial 3x3 + 8x2 + 8x + a, then find the value of a.
x+1
Example 2.24 Solve < 3.
x+3
Solution:
x+1
Subtracting 3 from both sides we get − 3 < 0.
x+3
Basic Algebra 68
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
x + 1 − 3(x + 3)
< 0
x+3
−2x − 8
< 0
x+3
x+4
> 0
x+3
Thus, x + 4 and x + 3 are both positive or both negative.
So let us find out the signs of x + 3 and x + 4 as follows
x+4
x x+3 x+4
x+3
x < −4 − − +
−4 < x < −3 − + −
x > −3 + + +
x = −4 − 0 0
The above type of rational inequality problem can also be solved by plotting the signs
of various factors on the intervals of the number line.
Exercise - 2.8
x3 (x − 1)
1. Find all values of x for which > 0.
(x − 2)
2x − 3
2. Find all values of x that satisfies the inequality < 0.
(x − 2)(x − 4)
x2 − 4
3. Solve ≤ 0.
x2 − 2x − 15
2.7.2 Partial Fractions
f (x)
A rational expression is called a proper fraction if the degree of f (x) is less than degree of g(x),
g(x)
where g(x) can be factored into linear factors and quadratic factors without real zeros. Now fg(x) (x)
can
be expressed in simpler terms, namely, as a sum of expressions of the form
A1 A2 Ak
(i) + 2
+ ··· + if x − a divides g(x) and
(x − a) (x − a) (x − a)k
(B1 x + C1 ) (B2 x + C2 ) (Bk x + Ck )
(ii) 2
+ 2 2
+ ··· + 2 if x2 + ax + b has no real zeros and
(x + ax + b) (x + ax + b) (x + ax + b)k
(x2 + ax + b) divides g(x).
f (x)
The resulting expression of is called the partial fraction decomposition. Such a decomposition
g(x)
is unique for a given rational function.
This method is useful in doing Integral calculus. So let us discuss some examples.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
x
Example 2.25 Resolve into partial fractions: .
(x + 3)(x − 4)
Solution:
x A B
Let = + where A and B are constants.
(x + 3)(x − 4) x + 3 x − 4
x A(x − 4) + B(x + 3)
Then, = , which gives x = A(x − 4) + B(x + 3).
(x + 3)(x − 4) (x + 3)(x − 4)
4
When x = 4, we have B = .
7
3
When x = −3, we have A =
7
x 3 4
Hence, = + .
(x + 3)(x − 4) 7(x + 3) 7(x − 4)
The above procedure can be carried out if the denominator has all its zeros in R which
are all distinct.
2x
Example 2.26 Resolve into partial fractions: .
(x2 + 1)(x − 1)
Solution:
In this case, note that the denominator has a factor x2 + 1 which does not have real zeros.
2x A Bx + C
Let 2 = + 2
(x + 1)(x − 1) (x − 1) x +1
where A, B, C are constants.
We have, 2x = A(x2 + 1) + (Bx + C)(x − 1).
When x = 1, we get A = 1.
When x = 0, we have A − C = 0 and hence A = C = 1.
When x = −1, we have 2A − 2(C − B) = −2, which gives B = −1.
2x 1 1−x
Thus, 2 = + 2
(x + 1)(x − 1) (x − 1) x + 1
We now illustrate the situation when denominator has a real zeros with multiplicity more than one.
x+1
Example 2.27 Resolve into partial fractions: .
x2 (x
− 1)
Solution:
x+1 A B C
Let 2 = + 2+ .
x (x − 1) x x x−1
Then, x + 1 = Ax(x − 1) + B(x − 1) + Cx2 .
When x = 0, we have B = −1 and when x = 1, we get C = 2.
When x = −1, we have 2A − 2B + C = 0 which gives A = −2.
x+1 −2 1 2
Thus, 2 = − 2+ .
x (x − 1) x x x−1
Basic Algebra 70
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 2.9
Resolve the following rational expressions into partial fractions.
1 3x + 1 x x
1. 2 2
2. 3. 2
4.
x −a (x − 2)(x + 1) (x + 1)(x − 1)(x + 2) (x − 1)3
2
1 (x − 1) x2 + x + 1 x3 + 2x + 1
5. 6. 7. 8.
x4 − 1 x3 + x x2 − 5x + 6 x2 + 5x + 6
x + 12 6x2 − x + 1 2x2 + 5x − 11 7+x
9. 10. 11. 12.
(x + 1)2 (x − 2) x3 + x2 + x + 1 x2 + 2x − 3 (1 + x)(1 + x2 )
Solution: y
–3
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 2.29 Shade the region given by the linear inequality x + 2y > 3.
y
Proof. The line x + 2y = 3 divides the 4
cartesian plane into two half planes. To
find the half plane represented by x +
3
2y > 3 substitute a point in one of the
half planes in the inequality and check
whether it is satisfied. Let us substitute 2
–1
–2
–3
Example 2.30 Solve the linear inequalities and exhibit the solution set graphically:
x + y ≥ 3, 2x − y ≤ 5, −x + 2y ≤ 3.
Solution:
Observe that a straight line can be drawn if we identify any two points on it. For example, (3, 0)
and (0, 3) can be easily identified as two points on the straight line x + y = 3.
Draw the three straight lines x + y = 3, 2x − y = 5 and −x + 2y = 3.
Now (0, 0) does not satisfy x + y ≥ 3. Thus, the half plane bounded by x + y = 3, not containing
the origin, is the solution set of x + y ≥ 3.
y
Similarly, the half-plane bounded by 4
1
x+
–1
–2
–3
Basic Algebra 72
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 2.10
Determine the region in the plane determined by the inequalities:
(1) x ≤ 3y, x ≥ y.
(2) y ≥ 2x, −2x + 3y ≤ 6.
(3) 3x + 5y ≥ 45, x ≥ 0, y ≥ 0.
(4) 2x + 3y ≤ 35, y ≥ 2, x ≥ 5.
(5) 2x + 3y ≤ 6, x + 4y ≤ 4, x ≥ 0, y ≥ 0.
(6) x − 2y ≥ 0, 2x − y ≤ −2, x ≥ 0, y ≥ 0.
(7) 2x + y ≥ 8, x + 2y ≥ 8, x + y ≤ 6.
Properties of Exponents
(i) For m, n ∈ Z and a 6= 0, we have am an = am+n .
am
(ii) For m, n ∈ Z and a 6= 0, we have n = am−n .
a
2.8.2 Radicals
Question:
For a 6= 0 and r ∈ Q, is it possible to define ar ?
1
First let us consider the case when r = , n ∈ N. Suppose there is a real number y ∈ R such that
1
n
y = a n . Then we must have y n = a.
This problem is basically to finding inverse function of y = xn . In order to understand better let
us consider the graphs of the following functions:
(i) f (x) = x2n , n ∈ N (ii) g(x) = x2n+1 , n ∈ N
y g(x) = x5
y g(x) = x3
4 g(x) = x7
f(x) = x6 2
3
g(x) = x4 1
2
h(x) = x2
1 –2 –1 1 2 x
–1
–3 –2 –1 0 1 2 3 x
–2
–1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
From these two figures it is clear that the function g : R → R given by g(x) = x2n+1 , n ∈ N is
one-to-one and onto and hence its inverse function from R onto R exists. But f : R → [0, ∞) given
by f (x) = x2n , n ∈ N is onto but not one-to-one. However, f is one-to-one and onto if we restrict
its domain to [0, ∞). This is helpful in understanding nth root of a real number. So we have two cases;
Case 1 When n is even.
In this case y n = a is not meaningful when a < 0. So no such y exists when a < 0.
Assume that a > 0. If y is a solution to xn = a, then −y is also solution to xn = a.
Definition 2.2
(i) For n ∈ N, n even, and b > 0, there is a unique a > 0 such that an = b.
(ii) For n ∈ N, n odd, b ∈ R, there is a unique a ∈ R such that √ an = b. In both cases a is
n
called the nth root of b or radical and is denoted by b1/n or b
(i) If n = 2, then nth root is called the square root; if n = 3, then it is called cube
root.
Observe that the equation x2 = a2 , has two solutions x = a, x = −a; but
(ii) √
a2 = |a|.
(iii) Properties of exponents given above are still valid for radicals provided each of
the individual terms are defined.
(iv) Note that for n ∈ N and a 6= 0 we have
n 1/n |a| if n is even ,
(a ) =
a if n is odd .
p 1
For example, 4 (−2)4 = 161/4 = 2, 3431/3 = 7 and (−1000) 3 = −10.
m m
For any rational r = , m ∈ Z, n ∈ N, with gcd(m, n) = 1 and for a > 0 we define ar = a n =
n
(a1/n )m .
For example, 493/2 = (491/2 )3 = 73 = 343. But (−49)3/2 has no meaning in real number system
because there is no real number x such that x2 = (−49)3 .
Basic Algebra 74
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
y y
3.5 3.5
3 3
2.5 2.5
2 2
1.5 1.5
1 1
0.5 0.5
–1
–1
Illustration
2.8.3.1 Compound Interest
interest rate
Recall that if P is the principal, r = , n is the number of compounding periods in a year
100 nt
and t is the number of years, then A = P 1 + nr gives the total amount after t years. If n = 4, then
it is compounded quarterly (the interest is added to the existing principal for three months in a year).
If n = 12, then compounded monthly, n = 365 means compounded daily. We can compound every
hour, every minute etc. We know that if P and r are fixed and the number of compounding periods in
n also increases. Let us consider the case with P = 1, r = 1 and
a year increases, then the total amount
t = 1. Then, we have An = 1 + n1 . We want to understand how big it gets as n gets really large.
Let us make a table with different values of n = 10, 100, 10000, 100000, 100000000.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
We notice that as n gets really large, An values seem to be getting closer to 2.718281815..... Actually
An values approach a real number e, an irrational number. 2.718281815 is an approximation to e. So
the compound interest formula becomes A = P ert , where r is the interest rate and P is the principal
and t is the number of years. This is called Continuous Compounding.
√
5
Example 2.32 Rationalize the denominator of √ √ .
( 6 + 2)
Solution: √ √
Multiplying both numerator and denominator by ( 6 − 2),we get
√ √ √ √ √ √
5 5( 6 − 2) ( 30 − 10)
√ √ = √ √ √ √ = .
( 6 + 2) ( 6 + 2)( 6 − 2) 4
√
Example 2.33 Find the square root of 7 − 4 3.
Solution:
p √ √
Let 7 − 4 3 = a + b 3 where a, √ b are rationals. √
Squaring on both sides, we get 7 − 4 3 = a2 + 3b2 + 2ab 3. So, a2 + 3b2 = 7 and 2ab = −4.
Basic Algebra 76
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Therefore a = −2/b.
From a2 + 3b2 = 7, we get (−2/b)
√
2
+ 3b2 = 7, which gives 4/b2 + 3b2 = 7 or 3b4 − 7b2 + 4 = 0.
(7± 49−48)
Solving for b2 we get b2 = 6
, which gives b2 = 1 or b2 = 43 .
2
Thus, b = ±1 or b = ± √3 .
Since bpis rational,
√ we have b = p ±1 and √ hence the corresponding
√ values of a are ∓2.
Since 7 − 4 3 > 0, we have 7 − 4 3 = 2 − 3.
√
possible to express square roots of u + v b where u, v are √
It is not always√ rationals, in
the form x + y√ b with x, y rationals. For example, the square root of 1 + 2 is not of
the form a + b 2 with a, b rationals.
Exercise - 2.11
1. Simplify:
−2
2 −3 −2
−6 1 27 3
(i) (125) , (ii) 16 , (iii) (−1000)
3 4 3 , (iv) (3 ) ,
3 (v) −1 .
27 3
−1 3
2. Evaluate (256)−1/2 4 .
3. If (x1/2 + x−1/2 )2 = 9/2, then find the value of (x1/2 − x−1/2 ) for x > 1.
4. Simplify and hence find the value of n: 32n 92 3−n /33n = 27.
5. Find the radius of the spherical tank whose volume √ is 32π/3 units.
7+ 6
6. Simplify by rationalising the denominator. √ .
3− 2
1 1 1 1 1
7. Simplify √ −√ √ +√ √ −√ √ +√ .
3− 8 8− 7 7− 6 6− 5 5−2
√ √ x2 + 1
8. If x = 2 + 3 find 2 .
x −2
2.9 Logarithm
We have seen that, with a base 0 < a 6= 1, the exponential function f (x) = ax is defined on R having
range (0, ∞). We also observed that f (x) is a bijection, hence it has an inverse. We call this inverse
function as logarithmic function and is denoted by loga (.). Let us discuss this function further. Note
that if f (x) takes x to y = ax , then loga (.) takes y to x. That is, for 0 < a 6= 1, we have
y = ax is equivalent to loga y = x.
For example, since 34 = 81 we have log3 (81) = 4. In other words, with fixed a, given a real
number y, logarithm finds the exponent x satisfying ax = y. This is useful in addressing practical
problems like, “how long will it take for certain investment to reach a fixed amount?” Logarithm is
also very useful in multiplying very small or big numbers.
(i) Note that exponential function ax is defined for all x ∈ R and ax > 0 and so
loga (·) defined only for positive real numbers.
(ii) Also, a0 = 1 for any base a and hence loga (1) = 0 for any base a.
77 2.9 Logarithm
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) aloga x = x for all x ∈ (0, ∞) and loga (ay ) = y for all y ∈ R.
(ii) For any x, y > 0, loga (xy) = loga x + loga y. (Product Rule)
x
(iii) For any x, y > 0, loga = loga x − loga y. (Quotient Rule)
y
(iv) For any x > 0 and r ∈ R, loga xr = r loga x. (Power Rule)
loga x
(v) For any x > 0, with a and b as bases, logb x = . (Change of base formula.)
loga b
Proof. Since exponential function with base a and logarithm function with base a are inverse of each
other,
(i) follows by using the definitions.
(ii) For x, y > 0 let loga x = u, loga y = v, and loga (xy) = w. Rewriting these in the exponential
form we obtain au = x, av = y, and, aw = xy. So, aw = xy = au av = au+v ; thus w = u + v.
Thus, we obtain loga (xy) = loga x + loga y.
x x
(iii) Let loga x = u, loga y = v, and loga = w. Then au = x, av = y and aw = . Hence,
y y
w x au u−v
a = = v = a ; which implies w = u − v.
y a
x
Thus, we obtain loga = loga x − loga y.
y
(iv) Let loga x = u. Then au = x and therefore, xr = (au )r = aru . Thus, loga xr = ru = r loga x.
(v) Let logb x = v. We have bv = x. Taking logarithm with base a on both sides we get
loga bv = loga x.
On the other hand loga bv = v loga b by the Power rule. Therefore, v loga b = loga x.
loga x
Hence logb x = , b > 0. This completes the proof.
loga b
Remark:
(i) If a = 10, then the corresponding logarithmic function log10 x is called the common logarithm.
(ii) If a = e,(an irrational number, approximately equal to 2.718), then the corresponding
logarithmic function loge x is called the natural logarithm. It is denoted by ln x. These
above particular cases of logarithmic functions are used very much in other sciences and
engineering. Particularly, the natural logarithm occurs very naturally. When we write log x we
mean loge x.
(iii) If a = 2, then the corresponding logarithmic function log2 x called the binary logarithm, which
is used in computer science.
50
(iv) Observe that loga 35 = loga (7 ∗ 5) = loga 7 + loga 5; loga = loga 50 −
3
loga 3.
log10 50
loga 22x = x loga 22; log5 50 = .
log10 5
(v) Observe the graph of the logarithmic and exponential functions.
Basic Algebra 78
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
y
8
y = 2x
7
6
5
4
y = log2 x
3
2
1
–2 –1 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 x
–1
–2
–3
Figure 2.9
√
Example 2.34 Find the logarithm of 1728 to the base 2 3.
Solution:
Let log2√3 1728 =
√ x.x √
Then we have
√ x (2 3)√= 1728 = 26 33 = 26 ( 3)6 .
Hence, (2 3) = (2 3)6 .
Therefore x = 6. That is, log2√3 1728 = 6.
75 5 32
Example 2.36 Prove log − 2 log + log = log 2.
16 9 243
Solution:
Using the properties of logarithm, we have
75 5 32
log − 2 log + log = log 75 − log 16 − 2 log 5 + 2 log 9 + log 32 − log 243. (By Quotient
16 9 243
rule)
= log 3 + log 25 − log 16 − log 25 + log 81 + log 16 + log 2 − log 81 − log 3
= log 2.
7
Example 2.37 If log2 x + log4 x + log16 x = , find the value of x.
2
Solution:
Note that x > 0.
7 1 1 1 7
log2 x + log4 x + log16 x = becomes + + = . (change of base rule)
2 logx 2 logx 4 logx 16 2
1 1 1 7 7 7
Thus + + = where a = logx 2. That is = .
a 2a 4a 2 4a 2
79 2.9 Logarithm
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1 1 1
Thus, a = and so, logx 2 = which gives x 2 = 2.
2 2
Thus, x = 22 = 4.
Example 2.40 Given that log10 2 = 0.30103, log10 3 = 0.47712 (approximately), find the number
of digits in 28 .312 .
Solution:
Suppose that N = 28 312 has n + 1 digits. Then N can be written as 10n × b where 1 ≤ b < 10.
Taking logarithm to the base 10, we get
log N = log(10n b) = n log 10 + log b = n + log b.
On the other hand,
log N = log 28 312 = 8 log 2 + 12 log 3 = 8 × 0.30103 + 12 × 0.47712 = 8.13368.
Thus, we get n + log b = 8.13368. Since 1 ≤ b < 10 the number of digits is 9.
Exercise - 2.12
1. Let b > 0 and b 6= 1. Express y = bx in logarithmic form. Also state the domain and range of the
logarithmic function.
2. Compute log9 27 − log27 9 .
3. Solve log8 x + log4 x + log2 x = 11.
4. Solve log4 28x = 2log2 8.
a+b 1
5. If a2 + b2 = 7ab, show that log = (log a + log b).
3 2
a2 b2 c2
6. Prove log + log + log = 0.
bc ca ab
16 25 81
7. Prove that log 2 + 16 log + 12 log + 7 log = 1.
15 1
24 80
8. Prove loga2 a logb2 b logc2 c = 8 .
n(n + 1)
9. Prove log a + log a2 + log a3 + · · · + log an = log a.
2
Basic Algebra 80
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 2.13
Choose the correct or the most suitable answer.
1. If |x + 2| ≤ 9, then x belongs to
(1) (−∞, −7) (2) [−11, 7] (3) (−∞, −7) ∪ [11, ∞) (4) (−11, 7)
|x − 2|
3. If ≥ 0, then x belongs to
x−2
(1) [2, ∞) (2) (2, ∞) (3) (−∞, 2) (4) (−2, ∞)
81 Exercise
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1
7. The value of log3 81
is
(1) −2 (2) −8 (3) −4 (4) −9
11. Find a so that the sum and product of the roots of the equation
2x2 + (a − 3)x + 3a − 5 = 0 are equal is
(1) 1 (2) 2 (3) 0 (4) 4
12. If a and b are the roots of the equation x2 − kx + 16 = 0 and satisfy a2 + b2 = 32, then the value
of k is
(1) 10 (2) −8 (3) −8, 8 (4) 6
14. The equation whose roots are numerically equal but opposite in sign to the roots of
3x2 − 5x − 7 = 0 is
(1) 3x2 − 5x − 7 = 0 (2) 3x2 + 5x − 7 = 0 (3) 3x2 − 5x + 7 = 0 (4) 3x2 + x − 7
15. If 8 and 2 are the roots of x2 + ax + c = 0 and 3, 3 are the roots of x2 + dx + b = 0, then the roots
of the equation x2 + ax + b = 0 are
(1) 1, 2 (2) −1, 1 (3) 9, 1 (4) −1, 2
16. If a and b are the real roots of the equation x2 − kx + c = 0, then the distance between the points
(a, 0) and (b, 0) is
√ √ √ √
(1) k 2 − 4c (2) 4k 2 − c (3) 4c − k 2 (4) k − 8c
Basic Algebra 82
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
kx 2 1
17. If = + , then the value of k is
(x + 2)(x − 1) x+2 x−1
(1) 1 (2) 2 (3) 3 (4) 4
1−2x A B
18. If 3+2x−x2
= 3−x
+ x+1
, then the value of A + B is
(1) −12
(2) −2
3
(3) 1
2
(4) 2
3
Summary
√
• π and p, where p is a prime number, are some irrational numbers.
• |x − a| ≤ r if and only if −r ≤ x − a ≤ r or a − r ≤ x ≤ a + r.
• In general exponential functions and logarithmic functions are inverse functions to each other.
83 Exercise
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
ICT CORNER-2(a)
Expected Outcome ⇒
Step–1
Open the Browser and type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code.
Step–2
GeoGebra Work Sheet called “Hill and Flower Puzzle” will appear. Puzzle Detail
(a)You have some flowers in your hand. If you climb up the hill the flowers will be doubled
and also, when you climb down the hill it will be doubled. (b)At the top of each hill there
is a idol of god where you have to put some flowers. (c)you have to climb and put flowers
in all the three idols in each hill top.
finally, when you reach the top of the third hill you have to put all the flowers in hand
such a way that all the three Idols get equal flowers. How many flowers you should take
and how many flowers you should put on each Idol?
Step–3
You can think of the no. of flowers taken by you as X value and no. of flowers offered
to the god as Y value. And adjust the sliders in the page. Simply by thinking you cannot
solve the puzzle.
Step–4
Now is the time for you to recognise the need of algebra. Think of the way to use Algebra.
Otherwise Click on the box Show Calculation. Algebra calculation at each level is seen.
Now you have to Identify the equation to solve the puzzle. Note: The result will be a ratio.
.Step-1
Basic Algebra 84
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
ICT CORNER-2(b)
Expected Outcome ⇒
Step–1
Open the Browser and type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. GeoGebra
work book named High School Algebra will open. In that several work sheets are given,
choose any worksheet you want, for example open the work sheet “Quadratic Equation”
solving by formula.
In the work sheet you can enter any value between −20 and 20 for a, b and c. You yourself
work out the answer using the formula given.(? mark indicates Undefined answer
Step–2
Now click on the answer to check. You can click the check box one by one to see the steps.
Finally, on right hand side click Show Graph to view the graph. Compare the graph with your
answer.)
85 ICT CORNER-2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Basic Algebra 86
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Trigonometry
Chapter 3
“When I trace at my pleasure the windings to and fro of the heavenly bodies,
I no longer touch the earth with my feet”
Ptolemy
3.1 Introduction
Trigonometry is primarily a branch of Mathematics that studies relationship
involving sides and angles of triangles. The word trigonometry stems from
the Greek word trigonon which means triangle and metron which means to
measure. So, literally trigonometry is the study of measuring triangles. Greek
mathematicians used trigonometric ratios to determine unknown distances. The
Egyptians on the other hand used a primitive form of trigonometry for building
Pyramids in second millinium BC(BCE). Aristarchus (310-250 BC(BCE)) used
trigonometry to determine the distances of Moon and Sun.
Eratosthenes (276-195 BC(BCE)) was t he f irst p erson to c alculate th
e ea rth’s circumference, whichhedidbyapplyingameasuringsystemusing stadia, a Ptolemy of Alexandaria (AD 90-168)
Ptolemy of Alexandaria (AD(CE) 90-168) standard unit of measurement during that
period. The general principles of Trigonometry were formulated by the Greek astronomer Hipparchus
(190-120 BC(BCE)) and he is credited as the founder of trigonometry. His ideas were used by Ptolemy of
Alexandria (AD 90-168) leading to the development of Ptolemy theory of Astronomy. The most significant
development of Trigonometry in ancient times was in India. Indian Mathematician and Astronomer
Aryabhata (AD(CE) 476-550) defined sine, cosine, inverse cosine, inverse sine and he gave mathematical
results in the form of 108 verses which included a formula for the area of a triangle.Mathematicians
Brahmagupta (598 AD(CE)), Bhaskara I (600 AD(CE)) and Bhaskara II (1114 AD(CE)) are other
Ancient Indians who contributed significantly to develop Trigonometry. Trigonometry was developed as a
separate branch of Mathematics through the works of Johann Bernoulli (1667-1748) and Leonhard Euler
(1707-1783). Euler established the fundamental results connecting trigonometric functions and complex
exponential. Joseph Fourier (1768-1830) made important contribution to the study of trigonometric series.
His invention of Fourier series has a wide range of applications especially in vibration analysis, electrical
engineering, acoustics, optics, signal processing, image processing and quantum mechanics. In modern
times, trigonometric functions are developed as mathematical functions of angular magnitudes, through the
medium of which many kinds of geometrical and algebraic investigations are carried out in every branch
of Mathematics and applications. Our GPS system in cars and mobile phones is based on trigonometric
calculations. Advanced medical scanning procedures such as CT and MRI, used in detecting tumors,
involve sine and cosine functions.
87
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Learning Objectives
At the end of this chapter, students are expected to know
• the limitations of right triangle trigonometric ratios as they involve acute angles.
• the necessity for the study of radian measure of an angle and its advantage over degree
measure.
• how unit circle is used to define trigonometric functions of real numbers.
• various trigonometric identities, their relationships and applications.
• the principal solution and general solution of a trigonometric equation.
• how to solve trigonometric equations.
• law of sines, law of cosines in triangles and their applications in real life situations.
• how to solve an oblique triangle using law of sines and law of cosines.
• application of Heron’s formula and how to compute area of a triangle without finding its
altitude.
• the existence of inverse trigonometric functions and their domains and ranges.
Let us recall the basics of trigonometric ratios using acute angles and their properties, which were
discussed in earlier classes.
the initial side and the terminal side of the angle produced.
An anticlockwise rotation generates a positive angle (angle Angle
with positive sign), while a clockwise rotation generates a O Initial Side A
Vertex
negative angle (angle with negative sign).
Figure 3.1
One full anticlockwise (or clockwise) rotation of OA back
to itself is called one complete rotation or revolution.
Trigonometry 88
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
The symbols 1◦ , 10 and 100 are used to denote a degree, a minute and a second respectively.
(ii) Centesimal system
In the Centesimal system , the right angle is divided into 100 equal parts, called Grades;
each grade is subdivided into 100 Minutes, and each minute is subdivided into 100 Seconds.
The symbol 1g is used to denote a grade.
(iii) Circular system
In the circular system , the radian measure of an angle is introduced using arc lengths
in a circle of radius r. Circular system is used in all branches of Mathematics and in other
applications in Science. The symbol 1c is used to denote 1 radian measure.
3.2.3 Degree Measure
The degree is a unit of measurement of angles and is represented by the symbol ◦ . In degrees, we
split up one complete rotation into 360 equal parts and each part is one degree, denoted by 1◦ . Thus,
1◦ is 1/360 of one complete rotation. To measure a fraction of an angle and also for accuracy of
measurement of angles, minutes and seconds are introduced. One minute (10 ) corresponds to 1/60
of a degree and in turn a second (100 ) corresponds to 1/60 of a minute (or) 1/3600 of a degree.
We shall classify a pair of angles in the following way for better understanding and usages.
(i) Two angles that have the exact same measure are called congruent angles.
(ii) Two angles that have their measures adding to 90◦ are called complementary angles.
(iii) Two angles that have their measures adding to 180◦ are called supplementary angles.
(iv) Two angles between 0◦ and 360◦ are conjugate if their sum equals 360◦ .
(i) The concept of degrees, minutes and seconds, is analogous to the system of time
measurement where we think of a degree representing one hour.
(ii) Observe that
59.0854◦ = 59◦ + 0.0854◦
600
0.0854◦ = .0854◦ × ◦ = 5.1240
1
5.124 = 5 + 0.1240
0 0
6000
0.1240 = 0.1240 × 0 = 7.4400
1
Thus, 59.0854◦ = 59◦ 50 7.4400
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) Observe that 45◦ , −315◦ and 405◦ lie in the first quadrant.
(ii) The following pairs of angles are coterminal angles (30◦ , 390◦ ); (280◦ , 1000◦ ) and
(−85◦ , 275◦ ).
opposite side
of sides of a right triangle ABC. Interestingly, these ratios lead to the hy
pote
definitions of six basic trigonometric functions. nu
First, let us recall the trigonometric ratios which are defined with c b se
reference to a right triangle.
a θ
opposite side adjacent side B C
sin θ = ; cos θ = adjacent side
hypotenuse hypotenuse
With the help of sin θ and cos θ, the remaining trigonometric Figure 3.4
ratios tan θ, cot θ, cosec θ and sec θ are determined by using the relations
sin θ 1 1 cos θ
tan θ = , cosec θ = , sec θ = , cot θ = .
cos θ sin θ cos θ sin θ
3.2.7 Exact values of trigonometric functions of widely used angles
Let us list out the values of trigonometric functions at known angles.
Trigonometry 90
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(iii) The value of reciprocal ratios namely cosecant, secant and cotangent can be obtained
using the above table.
(iv) The result cos 90◦ = 0 does not allow us to define tan 90◦ and sec 90◦ .
(v) Similarly sin 0◦ = 0 does not permit us to define cosec 0◦ and cot 0◦ .
3.2.8 Basic Trigonometric Identities
A trigonometric identity represents a relationship that is always true for all admissible values in the
1
domain. For example sec θ = is true for all admissible values of θ. Hence, this is an identity.
cos θ
However, sin θ = 12 is not an identity, since the relation fails when θ = 60◦ . Identities enable us to
simplify complicated expressions. They are the basic tools of trigonometry which are being used in
solving trigonometric equations. The most important part of working with identities, is to manipulate
them with the help of a variety of techniques from algebra.
Let us recall the fundamental identities (Pythagorean identities ) of trigonometry, namely,
cos2 θ + sin2 θ = 1
sec2 θ − tan2 θ = 1
cosec2 θ − cot2 θ = 1
(i) sin2 θ is the commonly used notation for (sin θ)2 , likewise for other trigonometric
ratios.
(ii) sec2 θ − tan2 θ = 1 is meaningless when θ = 90◦ . But still it is an identity and true for
all values of θ for which sec θ and tan θ are defined. Thus, an identity is an equation that
is true for all values of its domain values.
(iii) When we write sin θ , we understand that the expression is valid for all values of θ
1 + cos θ
for which 1 + cos θ 6= 0.
Example 3.2 Prove that (sec A − cosecA) (1 + tan A + cot A) = tan A sec A − cot A cosecA.
Solution:
1 1 sin A cos A
L.H.S. = − 1+ +
cos A sin A cos A sin A
sin3 A − cos3 A
= ...(i)
sin2 A cos2 A
sin A cos A sin3 A − cos3 A
R.H.S. = − = ...(ii)
cos2 A sin2 A sin2 A cos2 A
From (i) and (ii), we get the required result.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 3.3 Eliminate θ from a cos θ = b and c sin θ = d, where a, b, c, d are constants.
Solution:
Squaring and adding ac cos θ = bc and ac sin θ = ad, we get
a2 c2 = b2 c2 + a2 d 2 .
Exercise - 3.1
1. Identify the quadrant in which an angle of each given measure lies
(i) 25◦ (ii) 825◦ (iii) −55◦ (iv) 328◦ (v) −230◦
2. For each given angle, find a coterminal angle with measure of θ such that 0◦ ≤ θ < 360◦
(i) 395◦ (ii) 525◦ (iii) 1150◦ (iv) −270◦(v) −450◦
√
3. If a cos θ − b sin θ = c, show that a sin θ + b cos θ = ± a2 + b2 − c2 .
2
6 6 4 − 3 (m2 − 1)
4. If sin θ + cos θ = m, show that cos θ + sin θ = , where m2 ≤ 2.
4
cos4 α sin4 α
5. If + = 1, prove that
cos2 β sin2 β
cos4 β sin4 β
(i) sin4 α + sin4 β = 2 sin2 α sin2 β (ii) + = 1.
cos2 α sin2 α
2 sin α 1 − cos α + sin α
6. If y = , then prove that = y.
1 + cos α + sin α 1 + sin α
π
If x = ∞
P 2n
P∞ 2n
P∞ 2n 2n
7. n=0 cos θ, y = n=0 sin θ and z = n=0 cos θ sin θ, 0 < θ < , then show that
2
xyz = x + y + z.
1
[Hint: Use the formula 1 + x + x2 + x3 + . . . = , where |x| < 1].
1−x 3/2
8. If tan2 θ = 1 − k 2 , show that sec θ + tan3 θ cosec θ = 2 − k 2 . Also, find the values of k for
which this result holds.
9. If sec θ + tan θ = p, obtain the values of sec θ, tan θ and sin θ in terms of p.
2 2
10. If cot θ (1 + sin θ) = 4m and cot θ (1 − sin θ) = 4n, then prove that m2 − n = mn.
3 3 2 2 2 2
11. If cosec θ − sin θ = a and sec θ − cos θ = b , then prove that a b a + b = 1.
12. Eliminate θ from the equations a sec θ − c tan θ = b and b sec θ + d tan θ = c.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Definition 3.1
y
The radian measure of an angle is the ratio of the arc length it
subtends, to the radius of the circle in which it is the central s
angle. θ= rs
x
Consider a circle of radius r. Let s be the arc length O r
subtending an angle θ at the centre.
arc length s
Then, θ= = radians. Hence, s = rθ.
radius r Figure 3.5
(i) All circles are similar. Thus, for a given central angle in any circle, the ratio of the
intercepted arc length to the radius is always constant.
(ii) When s = r, we have an angle of 1 radian. Thus, one radian is the angle made at the
centre of a circle by an arc with length equal to the radius of the circle.
(iii) Since the lengths s and r have same unit, θ is unitless and thus, we do not use any
notation to denote radians.
(iv) θ = 1 radian measure, if s = r
θ = 2 radian measure, if s = 2r
Thus, in general θ = k radian measure, if s = kr.
Hence, radian measure of an angle tells us how many radius lengths, we need to sweep
out along the circle to subtend the angle θ.
(v) Radian angle measurement can be related to the edge of the unit circle. In radian system,
we measure an angle by measuring the distance travelled along the edge of the unit circle
to where the terminal side of the angle intersect the unit circle .
(i) The ratio of the circumference of any circle to its diameter is always a constant. This
constant is denoted by the irrational number π.
(ii) Mark a point P on a unit circle and put the unit circle on the number line so that P
touches the number 0. Allow the circle to roll along the number line. The point P will
93 3.3 Radian Measure
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
touch the number 2π on the number line when the circle rolls to one complete revolution
to the right.
(iii) If the unit of angle measure is not specified, then the angle is understood to be in radians.
(iv) Consider a sector of a circle with radius r. If θ is the central angle of the sector, then
2
πr
360◦ θ in degree measure
Area of the sector =
2 r2 θ
πr θ =
2π in radian measure
2
Clearly, the calculation in radian measure is much easier to work with.
22
(v) The values of π and correct to four decimal places are 3.1416 and 3.1429
7
22
respectively. Thus, π and are approximately equal correct upto two decimal places.
7
22
Hence, π ≈ .
(vi) 7
◦ 0 00 ◦
1 radian ≈ 57
17 45 and 1 ≈ 0.017453 radian
π
10 = radian ≈ 0.000291 radian.
180 × 60
00 π
1 = radian ≈ 0.000005 radian.
180 × 60 × 60
(vii) The radian measures and the corresponding degree measures for some known angles
are given in the following table
π π π π 3π
Radians 0 1 0.017453 π 2π
6 4 3 2 2
Degrees 0◦ 57◦ 170 4500 1◦ 30◦ 45◦ 60◦ 90◦ 180◦ 270◦ 360◦
π
Example 3.5 Convert (i) radians to degrees (ii) 6 radians to degrees.
5
Solution:
We know that π radians = 180◦ and thus,
π 180◦
(i) radians = = 36◦
5 5 ◦ ◦ ◦
180 7 × 180 7
(ii) 6 radians = ×6 ≈ × 6 = 343 .
π 22 11
Trigonometry 94
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 3.6 Find the length of an arc of a circle of radius 5 cm subtending a central angle
measuring 15◦ .
Solution:
Let s be the length of the arc of a circle of radius r subtending a central angle θ.
Then s = rθ.
π π
We have, θ = 15◦ = 15 × = radians
180 12
π 5π
So that, s = rθ gives s = 5 × = cm
12 12
Example 3.7 If the arcs of same lengths in two circles subtend central angles 30◦ and 80◦ , find the
ratio of their radii.
Solution:
Let r1 and r2 be the radii of the two given circles and l be the length of the arc.
π
θ1 = 30◦ = radians
6
4π
θ2 = 80◦ = radians
9
Given that l = r1 θ = r2 θ
π 4π
Thus, r1 = r2
6 9
r1 8
= which implies r1 : r2 = 8 : 3.
r2 3
Exercise - 3.2
1. Express each of the following angles in radian measure:
(i) 30◦ (ii) 135◦ (iii) −205◦ (iv) 150◦ (v) 330◦ .
2. Find the degree measure corresponding to the following radian measures
π π 2π 7π 10π
(i) (ii) (iii) (iv) (v) .
3 9 5 3 9
3. What must be the radius of a circular running path, around which an athlete must run 5 times in
order to describe 1 km?
4. In a circle of diameter 40 cm, a chord is of length 20 cm. Find the length of the minor arc of the
chord.
5. Find the degree measure of the angle subtended at the centre of circle of radius 100 cm by an arc
of length 22 cm.
6. What is the length of the arc intercepted by a central angle of measure 41◦ in a circle of radius
10 f t?
7. If in two circles, arcs of the same length subtend angles 60◦ and 75◦ at the centre, find the ratio of
their radii.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
8. The perimeter of a certain sector of a circle is equal to the length of the arc of a semi-circle having
the same radius. Express the angle of the sector in degrees, minutes and seconds.
9. An airplane propeller rotates 1000 times per minute. Find the number of degrees that a point on
the edge of the propeller will rotate in 1 second.
10. A train is moving on a circular track of 1500 m radius at the rate of 66 km/hr. What angle will it
turn in 20 seconds?
11. A circular metallic plate of radius 8 cm and thickness 6 mm is melted and molded into a pie (a
sector of the circle with thickness) of radius 16 cm and thickness 4 mm. Find the angle of the
sector.
Trigonometry 96
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Quadrantal Corresponding point on the Unit circle cosine value sine value
angle P (x, y) = P (cos θ, sin θ) cos θ sin θ
θ = 0◦ (1, 0) = (cos 0◦ , sin 0◦ ) cos 0◦ = 1 sin 0◦ = 0
θ = 90◦ (0, 1) = (cos 90◦ , sin 90◦ ) cos 90◦ = 0 sin 90◦ = 1
θ = 180◦ (−1, 0) = (cos 180◦ , sin 180◦ ) cos 180◦ = −1 sin 180◦ = 0
θ = 270◦ (0, −1) = (cos 270◦ , sin 270◦ ) cos 270◦ = 0 sin 270◦ = −1
θ = 360◦ (1, 0) = (cos 360◦ , sin 360◦ ) cos 360◦ = 1 sin 360◦ = 0
(i) Observe that x and y coordinates of all points on the unit circle lie between −1 and 1.
Hence, −1 ≤ cos θ ≤ 1, −1 ≤ sin θ ≤ 1, no matter whatever be the value of θ.
(ii) When θ = 360◦ , we have completed one full rotation. Thus, the terminal side coincides
with positive x- axis. Hence, sine has equal values at 0◦ and at 360◦ . Cosine and other
trigonometric functions also follow it.
(iii) If two angles differ by an integral multiple of 360◦ or 2π, then each trigonometric
function will have equal values at both angles.
(iv) Using the values of sine and cosine at quadrantal angles, we have the following
generalization geometrically.
cos 3π cos 3π
2
=0 2
+ 2nπ = 0; n ∈ Z
tan 0 = 0 tan (0 + 2nπ) = 0; n ∈ Z tan θ = 0 ⇒ θ = nπ; n ∈ Z
tan π = 0 tan (π + 2nπ) = 0; n ∈ Z
π
(v) tan θ is not defined when cos θ = 0 and so, tan θ is not defined when θ = (2n + 1) ,
2
n ∈ Z.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
For each real number t, identify a point B(x, y) on the unit circle such that the arc length AB is
equal to t. If t is positive, choose the point B(x, y) in the anticlockwise direction, otherwise choose it
in the clockwise direction. Let θ be the angle subtended by the arc AB at the centre. In this way, we
have a function w(t) associating a real number t to a point on the unit circle. Such a function is called
a wrapping function . Then s = rθ gives arc length t = θ.
Now, define sin t = sin θ and cos t = cos θ.
Clearly, sin t = sin θ = y and cos t = cos θ = x.
Using sin t and cos t, other trigonometric functions can be defined as functions of real
numbers.
Example 3.8 The terminal side of an angle θ in standard position passes through the point (3, −4).
Find the six trigonometric function values at an angle θ.
Solution:
Let B(x, y) = B(3, −4), OA be the initial side and OB be the terminal side of the angle θ in the
standard position.
Then ∠AOB is the angle θ and θ lies in the IV quadrant. Also,
θ
q
p O A
OB = r, r = x2 + y 2 = 32 + (−4)2 = 5 r
y 4 x 3 y 4 Figure 3.9
sin θ = = − ; cos θ = = ; tan θ = = − ;
r 5 r 5 x 3
r 5 r 5 x 3
cosec θ = = − ; sec θ = = ; cot θ = = − .
y 4 x 3 y 4
Trigonometry 98
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Thus, sin θ and cosec θ are positive and others are negative.
Similarly, we can find the sign of trigonometric functions in other two quadrants.
Let us illustrate the above discussions in Figure 3.10.
Signs of trigonometric functions in various quadrants can be remembered with the slogan
3
Example 3.9 If sin θ = and the angle θ is in the second quadrant, then find the values of other
5
five trigonometric functions.
Solution: r
p 9 4
We know that sin2 θ + cos2 θ = 1 ⇒ cos θ = ± 1 − sin2 θ = ± 1− =±
25 5
4
Thus, cos θ = − as cos θ is negative in the second quadrant.
5
3 5 4 5
sin θ = ⇒ cosec θ = ; cos θ = − ⇒ sec θ = −
5 3 5 4
sin θ 3 4
tan θ = = − ; cot θ = −
cos θ 4 3
If sin θ and cos θ are known, then the reciprocal identities and quotient identities can be
used to find the other four trigonometric values. The Pythagorean identities can be used to
find trigonometric values when one trigonometric value and the quadrant are known.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) sin(−θ) = − sin θ, and cos(−θ) = cos θ. These facts follow from the symmetry of the
unit circle about the x-axis. The angle −θ is the same as angle θ except it is on the other
side of the x- axis. Flipping a point (x, y) to the other side of the x- axis makes the
point into (x, −y), so the y-coordinate is negated and hence the sine is negated, but the
x-coordinate remains the same and therefore the cosine is unchanged.
(ii) The negative-angle identities can be used to determine if a trigonometric function is an
odd function or an even function .
Example 3.10 Find the values of (i) sin(−45◦ ) (ii) cos(−45◦ ) (iii) cot(−45◦ )
Solution:
1
(i) sin(−45◦ ) = − sin(45◦ ) = − √ .
2
1
◦
(ii) cos(−45 ) = √ and (iii) cot(−45◦ ) = −1
2
π
We have already learnt the trigonometric ratios of the angle (90◦ − θ), 0 < θ < in the lower
◦
2
class. Let us recall the trigonometric ratios of angle (90 − θ) ;
sin(90◦ − θ) = cos θ, cos(90◦ − θ) = sin θ, tan(90◦ − θ) = cot θ
cosec(90◦ − θ) = sec θ, sec(90◦ − θ) = cosec θ, cot(90◦ − θ) = tan θ.
Now, we will establish the corresponding trigonometric ratios for an angle of the form (90◦ + θ).
◦
π
Trigonometric ratios of an angle of the form (90 + θ), 0 < θ < in terms of θ .
2
Let ∠AOL = θ and ∠AOR = (90◦ + θ). Let P (a, b) be a
y
point on OL and choose a point P 0 on OR such that
OP = OP 0 . R L
90°+θ
0 0
Draw perpendiculars P M and P N from P and P on Ox
and Ox0 respectively. Pʹ(-b,a) P(a,b)
0 ◦
Now, ∠AOP = 90 + θ.
Clearly, 4OP M and 4P 0 ON are congruent. θ
xʹ N O M A x
ON = M P and N P 0 = OM
Hence, the coordinates of P and P 0 are P (a, b) and
P 0 (−b, a), respectively. Now
y-coordinate of P 0 a
sin(90◦ + θ) = 0
= = cos θ, yʹ
OP OP
0
x-coordinate of P −b
cos(90◦ + θ) = 0
= = − sin θ, Figure 3.12
OP OP
Thus, tan(90◦ +θ) = − cot θ, cosec(90◦ +θ) = sec θ, sec(90◦ +θ) = −cosecθ, cot(90◦ +θ) = − tan θ.
3π
The trigonometric function of other allied angles π ± θ, ± θ, 2π ± θ can be obtained in a similar
way. 2
π
The above results can be summarized in the following table: Here 0 < θ <
2
Trigonometry 100
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
π π 3π 3π
−θ −θ +θ π−θ π+θ −θ +θ 2π − θ 2π + θ
2 2 2 2
sine − sin θ cos θ cos θ sin θ − sin θ − cos θ − cos θ − sin θ sin θ
cosine cos θ sin θ − sin θ − cos θ − cos θ − sin θ sin θ cos θ cos θ
tangent − tan θ cot θ − cot θ − tan θ tan θ cot θ − cot θ − tan θ tan θ
(i) The corresponding reciprocal ratios can be written using the above table.
π
(ii) If the allied angles are ±θ, π ± θ, 2π ± θ, that is, angles of the form 2n ± θ, n ∈ Z,
2
then, the form of trigonometric ratio is unaltered (i.e., sine remains sine, cosine remains
cosine etc.,)
π 3π π
(iii) If the allied angles are ± θ, ± θ, that is, angles of the form (2n + 1) ± θ, n ∈ Z
2 2 2
then, the form of trigonometric ratio is altered to its complementary ratio. i.e., it is to
add the prefix “co” if it is absent and remove the prefix “co” if it is already present
(i.e., sine becomes cosine, cosine become sine etc.,)
(iv) For determining the sign, first find out the quadrant and then attach the appropriate sign
(+ or −) according to the quadrant rule “ASTC”.
Example 3.11 Find the value of (i) sin 150◦ (ii) cos 135◦ (iii) tan 120◦ .
Solution:
1
(i) sin 150◦ = sin (90◦ + 60◦ ) = cos(60◦ ) =
2
1
(or) sin 150◦ = sin (180◦ − 30◦ ) = sin(30◦ ) =
2
1
(ii) cos 135◦ = cos (90◦ + 45◦ ) = − sin(45◦ ) = − √
2
1
(or) cos 135◦ = cos (180◦ − 45◦ ) = − cos(45◦ ) = − √
√ 2
◦ ◦ ◦ ◦
(iii) tan 120 = tan (180 − 60 ) = − tan(60 ) = − 3
(or) write tan 120◦ as tan (90◦ + 30◦ ) and find the value.
Example 3.13 Prove that tan(315◦ ) cot (−405◦ ) + cot(495◦ ) tan (−585◦ ) = 2
Solution:
L.H.S = tan (360◦ − 45◦ ) [− cot (360◦ + 45◦ )] + cot (360◦ + 135◦ ) [− tan (360◦ + 225◦ )]
= [− tan 45◦ ] [− cot 45◦ ] + [− tan 45◦ ] [− tan 45◦ ] = (−1)(−1) + (−1)(−1) = 2.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1 y=sinx
-2π -π -π
_ π
_ π 2π 3π 4π
x
2 2
-1
One cycle
Here x represents a variable angle. Take the horizontal axis to be the x-axis and vertical axis
to be the y-axis. Graph of the function y = sin x is shown in the Figure 3.13. First, note that it
is periodic of period 2π. Geometrically it means that if you take the curve and slide it 2π either
left or right, then the curve falls back on itself. Second, note that the graph is within one unit of
π
the y-axis. The graph increases and decreases periodically. For instance, increases from − to
2
π π 3π
and decreases from to .
2 2 2
(ii) The graph of the cosine function
y
1
y=cosx
-2π -π -π
_ π
_ π 2π 3π 4π
x
2 2
-1
One cycle
Trigonometry 102
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Observe that the graph of y = cos x looks just like the graph of y = sin x except it is being
π π
translated to the left by . This is because of the identity cos x = sin + x . It easily follows
2 π 2
from the graph that cos x = cos (−x) = sin +x
2
(i) The sine and cosine functions are useful for one very important reason, since they repeat
in a regular pattern (i.e., they are periodic). There are a vast array of things in and around
us that repeat periodically. For example, the rising and setting of the sun, the motion of
a spring up and down, the tides of the ocean and so on, are repeating at regular intervals
of time. All periodic behaviour can be studied through combinations of the sine and
cosine functions.
(ii) Periodic functions are used throughout science to describe oscillations, waves and other
phenomena that occur periodically.
Example 3.14 Determine whether the following functions are even, odd or neither.
(i) sin2 x − 2 cos2 x − cos x (ii) sin (cos(x)) (iii) cos (sin(x)) (iv) sin x + cos x
Solution:
(i) In general, a function is an even function if its graph is unchanged under reflection about
the y-axis. A function is odd if its graph is symmetric about the origin.
(ii) The properties of even and odd functions are useful in analyzing trigonometric functions
particularly in the sum and difference formula.
(iii) The properties of even and odd functions are useful in evaluating some definite integrals,
which we will see in calculus.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 3.3
1. Find the values of (i) sin(480◦ ) (ii) sin(−1110◦ ) (iii) cos(300◦ ) (iv) tan(1050◦ )
◦ 19π 11π
(v) cot(660 ) (vi) tan (vii) sin − .
3 3
√ !
5 2 6
2. , is a point on the terminal side of an angle θ in standard position. Determine the six
7 7
trigonometric function values of angle θ.
3. Find the values of other five trigonometric functions for the following:
1
(i) cos θ = − , θ lies in the III quadrant.
2
2
(ii) cos θ = , θ lies in the I quadrant.
3
2
(iii) sin θ = − , θ lies in the IV quadrant.
3
(iv) tan θ = −2, θ lies in the II quadrant.
13
(v) sec θ = , θ lies in the IV quadrant.
5
cot(180◦ + θ) sin(90◦ − θ) cos(−θ)
4. Prove that = cos2 θ cot θ.
sin(270◦ + θ) tan(−θ)cosec(360◦ + θ)
3
5. Find all the angles between 0◦ and 360◦ which satisfy the equation sin2 θ = .
4
π π 7π 4π
6. Show that sin2 + sin2 + sin2 + sin2 = 2.
18 9 18 9
3.5 Trigonometric Identities
3.5.1 Sum and difference identities or compound angles formulas
Now, compound angles are algebraic sum of two or more angles. Trigonometric functions do not
satisfy the functional relations like f (x + y) = f (x) + f (y) and f (kx) = kf (x), k is a real number.
For example, cos(α + β) 6= cos α + cos β, sin(2α) 6= 2 sin α, tan 3α 6= 3 tan α, . . .. Thus, we need to
derive formulas for sin(α + β), cos(α + β), . . . and use them in calculations of application problems.
Music is made up of vibrations that create pressure on ear-drums. Musical tones can be modeled
with sinusoidal graphs (graphs looks like that of y = sin x or y = cos x). When more than one tone
is played, the resulting pressure is equal to the sum of the individual pressures. In this context sum
and difference trigonometric identities are used as an important application. Also, sum and difference
trigonometric identities are helpful in the analysis of waves.
First we shall prove the identity for the cosine of the sum of two angles and extend it to prove all
other sum or difference identities.
Identity 3.1: cos(α + β) = cos α cos β − sin α sin β
Proof. Consider the unit circle with centre at O. Let P = P (1, 0).
y
(0,1)
R (cos(Į+ȕ), sin(Į+ȕ)) Let Q, R and S be points on the unit circle such that
∠P OQ = α, ∠P OR = α + β and ∠P OS = −β as
Q (cos Į, sin Į) shown in the Figure 3.15. Clearly, angles α, α + β and − β
ȕ
Į x
(-1,0) O ȕ are in standard positions. Now, the points Q, R and S are
P(1,0)
given by Q(cos α, sin α), R (cos(α + β), sin(α + β)) and
S (cos (-ȕ, sin (-ȕ)
S (cos(−β), sin(−β)).
(0,-1)
Figure 3.15
Trigonometry 104
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) In the above proof, P R = SQ says that the distance between two points on a circle is
determined by the radius and the central angle .
(ii) Arc lengths PR and SQ, subtends angles α + β and α + (−β) respectively at the center.
Thus, PR = SQ. Thus, distance between the points (cos α, sin α) and (cos(−β), sin(−β))
is same as the distance between the points (cos(α + β), sin(α + β)) and (1, 0).
(iii) In the above derivations, 0 ≤ α < 2π, 0 ≤ β < 2π. Because of periodicity of sine and
cosine, the result follows for any α and β.
The sum and difference formulas for sine and cosine can be written in the matrix form
cos α − sin α cos β − sin β cos(α + β) − sin(α + β)
. = .
sin α cos α sin β cos β sin(α + β) cos(α + β)
tan α + tan β
Identity 3.5: tan(α + β) =
1 − tan α tan β
Proof.
sin(α + β) sin α cos β + cos α sin β
tan(α + β) = =
cos(α + β) cos α cos β − sin α sin β
105 3.5 Trigonometric Identities
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 3.15 Find the values of (i) cos 15◦ and (ii) tan 165◦ .
Solution:
(i) Now, cos 15◦ = cos (45◦ − 30◦ ) = cos 45◦ cos 30◦ + sin 45◦ sin 30◦
√ √
1 3 1 1 3+1
= √ +√ = √
2 2 22 2 2
√
Also, note that sin 75◦ = 3√+ 1 [ try yourself ]
2 2
tan 120◦ + tan 45◦
(ii) Now, tan 165◦ = tan(120◦ + 45◦ ) =
1 − tan 120◦ √
tan 45◦
But, tan 120 = tan(90 + 30 ) = − cot 30 = − 3 and tan 45◦ = 1
◦ ◦ ◦ ◦
√
1 − 3
Thus, tan 165◦ = √ .
1+ 3
Trigonometry 106
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
4 −12
Example 3.16 If sin x = ( in I quadrant ) and cos y = ( in II quadrant), then
5 13
find (i) sin(x − y), (ii) cos(x − y).
Solution:
4
Given that sin x = .
5
r
2 2
p
2 16 3
cos x + sin x = 1 gives cos x = ± 1 − sin x = ± 1 − =±
25 5
3
In the first quadrant, cos x is always positive. Thus, cos x = .
5
12
Also, given that cos y = − in the II quadrant. We have
13
r
p 144 5
sin y = ± 1 − cos2 y = ± 1 − =± .
169 13
5
In the second quadrant, sin y is always positive. Thus, sin y = .
13
4 −12 3 5 63
(i) sin(x − y) = sin x cos y − cos x sin y = − =− .
5 13 5 13 65
3 −12 4 5 16
(ii) cos(x − y) = cos x cos y + sin x sin y = + =− .
5 13 5 13 65
√
3π 3π
Example 3.17 Prove that cos + x − cos − x = − 2 sin x
4 4
Solution:
3π 3π 3π 3π
L.H.S = cos cos x − sin sin x − cos cos x − sin sin x
4 4 4 4
√
π 1
= −2 sin π − sin x = −2 √ sin x = − 2 sin x.
4 2
Example 3.18 Point A(9, 12) rotates around the origin O in a plane through 60◦ in the anticlockwise
direction to a new position B. Find the coordinates of the point B.
Solution:
Let A(9, 12) = A(r cos θ, r sin θ), where r = OA. Then r cos θ = 9 and r sin θ = 12.
Thus, r2 = 81 + 144 = 225 ⇒ r = 15.
Hence, the point A is given by A (15 cos θ, 15 sin θ).
Now, the point B is given by B (15 cos(θ + 60◦ ), 15 sin(θ + 60◦ )).
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
3 √
Similarly, 15 sin(θ + 60◦ ) = (4 + 3 3). Hence, the point B is given by
2
√ 3 √
3
B (3 − 4 3), (4 + 3 3) .
2 2
Example 3.19 A ripple tank demonstrates the effect of two water waves being added together. The
two waves are described by h = 8 cos t and h = 6 sin t, where t ∈ [0, 2π) is in seconds and h is
the height in millimeters above still water. Find the maximum height of the resultant wave and the
value of t at which it occurs.
Solution:
Let H be the height of the resultant wave at time t. Then H is given by
H = 8 cos t + 6 sin t
Let 8 cos t + 6 sin t = k cos(t − α) = k(cos t cos α + sin t sin α)
3
Hence, k = 10 and tan α = , so that
4
H = 10 cos(t − α)
3
Thus, the maximum of H = 10 mm. The maximum occurs when t = α, where tan α = .
4
Trigonometry 108
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(iii) tan 3A − tan 2A − tan A = tan 3A + tan(−2A) + tan(−A) = tan 3A tan 2A tan A
π
(iv) If A + B + C = , then tan A tan B + tan B tan C + tan C tan A = 1 ( How! ).
2
Exercise - 3.4
15 12 π π
1. If sin x = and cos y = , 0 < x < , 0 < y < ,
17 13 2 2
find the value of (i) sin(x + y) (ii) cos(x − y) (iii) tan(x + y).
3 9 π π
2. If sin A = and cos B = , 0 < A < , 0 < B < ,
5 41 2 2
find the value of (i) sin(A + B) (ii) cos(A − B).
4 3π 24 3π
3. Find cos(x − y), given that cos x = − with π < x < and sin y = − with π < y < .
5 2 25 2
8 π 24 3π
4. Find sin(x − y), given that sin x = with 0 < x < and cos y = − with π < y < .
17 2 25 2
7π
5. Find the value of (i) cos 105◦ (ii) sin 105◦ (iii) tan .
√ 12
3 cos x − sin x
6. Prove that (i) cos(30◦ + x) = (ii) cos(π + θ) = − cos θ
2
(iii) sin(π + θ) = − sin θ.
7. Find a quadratic equation whose roots are sin 15◦ and cos 15◦ .
8. Expand cos(A + B + C). Hence prove that
cos A cos B cos C = sin A sin B cos C + sin B sin C cos A + sin C sin A cos B,
π
if A + B + C = .
2
9. Prove that
√
(i) sin(45◦ + θ) − sin(45◦ − θ) = 2 sin θ.
(ii) sin(30◦ + θ) + cos(60◦ + θ) = cos θ.
10. If a cos(x + y) = b cos(x − y), show that (a + b) tan x = (a − b) cot y.
11. Prove that sin 105◦ + cos 105◦ = cos 45◦ .
12. Prove that sin 75◦ − sin 15◦ = cos 105◦ + cos 15◦ .
13. Show that tan 75◦ + cot 75◦ = 4.
14. Prove that cos(A + B) cos C − cos(B + C) cos A = sin B sin(C − A).
15. Prove that sin(n + 1)θ sin(n − 1)θ + cos(n + 1)θ cos(n − 1)θ = cos 2θ, n ∈ Z.
2π 4π
16. If x cos θ = y cos θ + = z cos θ + , find the value of xy + yz + zx.
3 3
17. Prove that
(i) sin(A + B) sin(A − B) = sin2 A − sin2 B
(ii) cos(A + B) cos(A − B) = cos2 A − sin2 B = cos2 B − sin2 A
(iii) sin2 (A + B) − sin2 (A − B) = sin 2A sin 2B
(iv) cos 8θ cos 2θ = cos2 5θ − sin2 3θ
18. Show that cos2 A + cos2 B − 2 cos A cos B cos(A + B) = sin2 (A + B).
3
19. If cos(α − β) + cos(β − γ) + cos(γ − α) = − , then prove that
2
cos α + cos β + cos γ = sin α + sin β + sin γ = 0.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) y = sin 2x and y = 2 sin x are different. Draw their graphs and identify the difference.
(ii) Application of sin 2A = 2 sin A cos A: When an object is projected with speed u at an
angle α to the horizontal over level ground, the horizontal distance (Range) it travels
u2 sin 2α
before striking the ground is given by the formula R = .
g
u2 π
Clearly maximum of R is , when α = .
g 4
sin 2A 1
(iii) |sin A cos A| = ≤ .
2 2
Trigonometry 110
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1 1
Thus, − ≤ sin A cos A ≤ .
2 2
1 π
From this, we infer that the maximum value of sin A cos A is when A = .
2 4
Example 3.21 A foot ball player can kick a football from ground level with an initial velocity of
80 ft/second. Find the maximum horizontal distance the football travels and at what angle?
(Take g = 32).
Solution:
The formula for horizontal distance R is given by
2 tan A
Identity 3.9: tan 2A =
1 − tan2 A
Proof.
tan α + tan β
Now, tan(α + β) =
1 − tan α tan β
tan A + tan A
Take α = β = A. We have, tan(A + A) =
1 − tan A tan A
2 tan A
tan 2A = .
1 − tan2 A
2 tan A
Identity 3.10: sin 2A =
1 + tan2 A
Proof.
2 sin A cos A
we know that sin 2A = 2 sin A cos A =
sin2 A + cos2 A
2 sin A cos A
cos2 A 2 tan A
= 2 2 = .
sin A + cos A 1 + tan2 A
cos2 A
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1 − tan2 A
Identity 3.11: cos 2A =
1 + tan2 A
Proof.
cos2 A − sin2 A
We know that cos 2A = cos2 A − sin2 A =
cos2 A + sin2 A
cos2 A − sin2 A
= cos2 A
cos2 A + sin2 A
cos2 A
1 − tan2 A
Thus, cos 2A = .
1 + tan2 A
(i) In the power reducing identities, we have reduced the square power on one side to
power 1 on the other side.
(ii) Power reducing identities allow us to rewrite the even powers of sine or cosine in
terms of the first power of cosine.
For example, using power reducing identities one can easily prove that
1 1 3 1 1 3
cos4 x = cos 4x + cos 2x + and sin4 x = cos 4x − cos 2x + (Try it!).
8 2 8 8 2 8
(iii) Power reducing formulas are important in higher level mathematics.
Triple-Angle Identities
Using double angle identities, we can derive triple angle identities.
Identity 3.12: sin 3A = 3 sin A − 4 sin3 A
Proof.
Trigonometry 112
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
= 4 cos3 A − 3 cos A.
3 tan A − tan3 A
Identity 3.14: tan 3A =
1 − 3 tan2 A
Proof.
Half-Angle Identities
Half angle identities are closely related to the double angle identities. We can use half angle identities
when we have an angle that is half the size of a special angle. For example, sin 15◦ can be computed by
30◦
writing sin 15◦ = sin . Also one can find exact values for some angles using half-angle identities.
2
θ θ
If we put 2A = θ or A = in the double angle identities, we get new identities in terms of angle .
2 2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Let us list out the half angle identities in the following table:
Double angle identity Half-angle identity
θ θ
sin 2A = 2 sin A cos A sin θ = 2 sin cos
2 2
2 tan θ
2 tan A 2
tan 2A = tan θ =
1 − tan2 A θ
1− tan2
2
θ
2 tan A 2 tan 2
sin 2A = sin θ =
1 + tan2 A θ
1+ tan2
2
θ
1 − tan2 A 1 − tan2
cos 2A = cos θ = 2
1 + tan2 A θ
1 + tan2
2
(i) The half angle identities are often used to replace a squared trigonometric function by a
non squared trigonometric function.
(ii) Half angle identities allow us to find the value of the sine and cosine of half the angle if
we know the value of the cosine of the original angle.
1◦
Example 3.22 Find the value of sin 22
2
Solution: r
2 θ θ 1 − cos θ
We know that cos θ = 1 − 2 sin ⇒ sin = ± . Take θ = 45◦
2 2 2
r
45 ◦
1 − cos 45 ◦ 1◦
we get sin =± , (taking positive sign only, since 22 lies in the first quadrant)
2 2 2
√
s
1 − √12
p
1◦ 2− 2
Thus, sin 22 = = .
2 2 2
12
Example 3.23 Find the value of sin 2θ, when sin θ = , θ lies in the first quadrant.
13
Solution:
5
Using a right triangle, we can easily find that cos θ =
13
12 5 120
sin 2θ = 2 sin θ cos θ = 2 = .
13 13 169
Trigonometry 114
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
constructing the triangle, we can also find the value of cos θ using
Instead of p
cos θ = ± 1 − sin2 θ formula.
x x x x
Example 3.25 Prove that sin x = 210 sin cos cos ... cos
210 2 22 210
Solution:
x x x x x
sin x = 2 sin cos = 2 × 2 × sin 2 cos 2 cos
2 2 2 2 2
2 x x x
= 2 sin 2 cos cos 2
2 2 2
Applying repeatedly the half angle sine formula, we get
x x x x
10
sin x = 2 sin 10 cos cos 2 ... cos 10 .
2 2 2 2
sin θ + sin 2θ
Example 3.26 Prove that = tan θ
1 + cos θ + cos 2θ
Solution:
sin θ + sin 2θ sin θ + 2 sin θ cos θ sin θ(1 + 2 cos θ)
We have = = = tan θ.
1 + cos θ + cos 2θ cos θ + (1 + cos 2θ) cos θ(1 + 2 cos θ)
1 sin3 x + cos3 x
Example 3.27 Prove that 1 − sin 2x =
2 sin x + cos x
Solution:
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 3.29 Find the values of (i) sin 18◦ (ii) cos 18◦ (iii) sin 72◦ (iv) cos 36◦ (v) sin 54◦
Solution:
Observe that sin 18◦ = cos 72◦ , cos 18◦ = sin 72◦ and cos 36◦ = sin 54◦
r
θ 1−a φ cos θ − a
Example 3.30 If tan = tan , then prove that cos φ = .
2 1+a 2 1 − a cos θ
Trigonometry 116
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Solution:
By the half-angle identity, we have
φ 1+a θ
1 − tan2 1− tan2
2 = 1−a 2
cos φ =
φ
1+a θ
1 + tan2 1+ tan2
2 1−a 2
θ
1 − tan2
2−a
2 θ
1 + tan cos θ − a
= 2 = .
2 θ 1 − a cos θ
1 − tan
1 − a
2
θ
1 + tan2
2
√
Example 3.31 Find the value of 3 cosec 20◦ − sec 20◦
Solution:
√
√ 3 ◦ 1 ◦
√ ◦ ◦ 3 1 2 cos 20 − 2 sin 20
We have 3 cosec 20 − sec 20 = − = 4
sin 20◦ cos 20◦ 2 sin 20◦ cos 20◦
sin 2n A
Example 3.32 Prove that cos A cos 2A cos 22 A cos 23 A . . . cos 2n−1 A =
2n sin A
Solution:
Exercise - 3.5
1. Find the value of cos 2A, A lies in the first quadrant, when
15 4 16
(i) cos A = (ii) sin A = (iii) tan A = .
17 5 63
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Trigonometry 118
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
C +D C −D
sin C − sin D = 2 cos sin (3.10)
2 2
C +D C −D
cos C + cos D = 2 cos cos (3.11)
2 2
C +D D−C
cos C − cos D = 2 sin sin (3.12)
2 2
1
Identity 3.15: Prove that sin(60◦ − A) sin A sin(60◦ + A) = sin 3A
4
Proof.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 3.35 Find the value of sin 34◦ + cos 64◦ − cos 4◦ .
Solution:
64◦ + 4◦ 64◦ − 4◦
◦ ◦ ◦ ◦
We have sin 34 + cos 64 − cos 4 = sin 34 − 2 sin sin
2 2
= sin 34◦ − 2 sin 34◦ sin 30◦ = 0.
1
Example 3.36 Show that cos 36◦ cos 72◦ cos 108◦ cos 144◦ = .
16
Solution:
L.H.S. = cos 36◦ cos (90◦ − 18◦ ) cos (90◦ + 18◦ ) cos (180◦ − 36◦ )
= sin2 18◦ cos2 36◦
√ !2 √ !2
5−1 5+1 1
= = .
4 4 16
Trigonometry 120
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Try to solve using sin 75◦ = cos 15◦ and cos 75◦ = sin 15◦
3
Example 3.38 Show that cos 10◦ cos 30◦ cos 50◦ cos 70◦ = .
16
Solution:
1
We know that cos (60◦ − A) cos A cos (60◦ + A) = cos 3A
4
cos 10◦ cos 30◦ cos 50◦ cos 70◦ = cos 30◦ [cos 10◦ cos 50◦ cos 70◦ ]
= cos 30◦ [cos (60◦ − 10◦ ) cos 10◦ cos (60◦ + 10◦ )]
√ √ √ !
3 1 ◦ 3 1 3 3
= cos 30 = =
2 4 2 4 2 16
Exercise - 3.6
1. Express each of the following as a sum or difference
(i) sin 35◦ cos 28◦ (ii) sin 4x cos 2x (iii) 2 sin 10θ cos 2θ (iv) cos 5θ cos 2θ (v) sin 5θ sin 4θ.
2. Express each of the following as a product
(i) sin 75◦ − sin 35◦ (ii) cos 65◦ + cos 15◦ (iii) sin 50◦ + sin 40◦ (iv) cos 35◦ − cos 75◦ .
1
3. Show that sin 12◦ sin 48◦ sin 54◦ = .
8
π 2π 3π 4π 5π 6π 7π 1
4. Show that cos cos cos cos cos cos cos = .
15 15 15 15 15 15 15 128
sin 8x cos x − sin 6x cos 3x
5. Show that = tan 2x.
cos 2x cos x − sin 3x sin 4x
(cos θ − cos 3θ) (sin 8θ + sin 2θ)
6. Show that = 1.
(sin 5θ − sin θ) (cos 4θ − cos 6θ)
7. Prove that sin x + sin 2x + sin 3x = sin 2x (1 + 2 cos x).
sin 4x + sin 2x
8. Prove that = tan 3x.
cos 4x + cos 2x
9. Prove that 1 + cos 2x + cos 4x + cos 6x = 4 cos x cos 2x cos 3x.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
θ 7θ 3θ 11θ
10. Prove that sin sin + sin sin = sin 2θ sin 5θ.
2 2 2 2
1
11. Prove that cos (30◦ − A) cos (30◦ + A) + cos (45◦ − A) cos (45◦ + A) = cos 2A + .
4
sin x + sin 3x + sin 5x + sin 7x
12. Prove that = tan 4x.
cos x + cos 3x + cos 5x + cos 7x
sin (4A − 2B) + sin (4B − 2A)
13. Prove that = tan (A + B).
cos (4A − 2B) + cos (4B − 2A)
4 cos 2A
14. Show that cot (A + 15◦ ) − tan (A − 15◦ ) = .
1 + 2 sin 2A
3.5.4 Conditional Trigonometric Identities
We know that trigonometric identities are true for all admissible values of the angle involved. There
are some trigonometric identities which satisfy the given additional conditions. Such identities are
called conditional trigonometric identities.
In this section, we shall make use of the relations obtained in the earlier sections to establish some
conditional identities based on some relationship.
Trigonometry 122
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
A B C
sin sin sin > 0, if A + B + C = π
2 2 2
π−A π−B π−C
= 1 + 4 sin sin sin
4 4 4
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 3.41 If A + B + C = π, prove that cos2 A + cos2 B + cos2 C = 1 − 2 cos A cos B cos C.
Solution:
1
cos2 A + cos2 B + cos2 C = 2 cos2 A + 2 cos2 B + 2 cos2 C
2
1
= [(1 + cos 2A) + (1 + cos 2B) + (1 + cos 2C)]
2
3 1
= + [(cos 2A + cos 2B) + cos 2C]
2 2
3 1
+ 2 cos(A + B) cos(A − B) + (2 cos2 C − 1 ]
=
2 2
3 1
+ −2 cos C cos(A − B) + 2 cos2 C − 1
= (A + B = π − C)
2 2
3 1 1
= − + [−2 cos C (cos(A − B) − cos C)]
2 2 2
= 1 − cos C [cos(A − B) − cos C]
= 1 − cos C [cos(A − B) + cos(A + B)]
= 1 − cos C [2 cos A cos B]
= 1 − 2 cos A cos B cos C
Exercise - 3.7
1. If A + B + C = 180◦ , prove that
(i) sin 2A + sin 2B + sin 2C = 4 sin A sin B sin C
A B C
(ii) cos A + cos B − cos C = −1 + 4 cos cos sin
2 2 2
2 2 2
(iii) sin A + sin B + sin C = 2 + 2 cos A cos B cos C
(iv) sin2 A + sin2 B − sin2 C = 2 sin A sin B cos C
A B B C C A
(v) tan tan + tan tan + tan tan = 1
2 2 2 2 2 2
A B C
(vi) sin A + sin B + sin C = 4 cos cos cos
2 2 2
(vii) sin(B + C − A) + sin(C + A − B) + sin(A + B − C) = 4 sin A sin B sin C.
2. If A + B + C = 2s, then prove that sin(s − A) sin(s − B) + sin s sin(s − C) = sin A sin B.
2x 2y 2z 2x 2y 2z
3. If x + y + z = xyz, then prove that + + = .
1 − x2 1 − y 2 1 − z 2 1 − x2 1 − y 2 1 − z 2
π
4. If A + B + C = , prove the following
2
(i) sin 2A + sin 2B + sin 2C = 4 cos A cos B cos C
(ii) cos 2A + cos 2B + cos 2C = 1 + 4 sin A sin B sin C.
π
5. If 4ABC is a right triangle and if ∠A = , then prove that
2
(i) cos2 B + cos2 C = 1
(ii) sin2 B + sin2 C = 1
√ B C
(iii) cos B − cos C = −1 + 2 2 cos sin .
2 2
Trigonometry 124
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
General Solution
The solution of a trigonometric equation giving all the admissible values obtained with the help of
periodicity of a trigonometric function is called the general solution of the equation.
Principal Solution
The smallest numerical value of unknown angle satisfying the equation in the interval [0, 2π] (or)
[−π, π] is called a principal solution. We shall take the interval [−π, π] for defining the principal
solution. Further, in this interval we may have two solutions. Even though both are valid solutions,
we take only the numerically smaller one. This helps us to define the principal domain of the
trigonometric functions in order to have their inverses.
−π π
Principal value of sine function lies in the interval , and hence lies in I quadrant or IV
2 2
quadrant. Principal value of cosine is in [0, π] and hence in I quadrant or II quadrant. Principal
function
−π π
value of tangent function is in , and hence in I quadrant or IV quadrant.
2 2
(i) Trigonometric equations are different from trigonometric identities, since trigonometric
identities are true for all admissible values of unknown angle θ. But trigonometric
equations are valid only for particular values of unknown angle.
(ii) There is no general method for solving trigonometric equations. However, one may
notice that some equations may be factorisable; some equations may be expressed in
terms of single function; some equations may be squared.
(iii) To find solutions to trigonometric equations, some times one may go for the technique
of squaring both sides. One has to take care as it can also produce false solutions
(extraneous solutions).
For example, to find solution for sin x − cos x = 1 in 0 ≤ x < 360◦ , we do squaring
on both sides to get (sin x − 1)2 = cos2 x, which gives 2 sin x(sin x − 1) = 0. So, we
π
get x = 0, , π. Clearly x = 0 is a false solution. Thus, we have to check for correct
2
solutions, in the squaring process.
(iv) Mostly we write the solutions of trigonometric equations in radians.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
sin θ = sin α
sin θ − sin α = 0
θ+α θ−α
2 cos sin = 0 , which gives either
2 2
θ+α θ−α
cos = 0 or sin = 0.
2 2
θ+α θ−α
Now, cos =0 Now, sin = 0,
2 2
θ+α π θ−α
= (2n + 1) , n ∈ Z = nπ, n ∈ Z
2 2 2
θ = (2n + 1) π − α, n ∈ Z ...(i) θ = 2nπ + α, n ∈ Z ...(ii)
cos θ = cos α
cos θ − cos α = 0
θ+α α−θ
2 sin sin = 0
2 2
θ+α θ−α
sin sin = 0 , which gives either
2 2
θ+α θ−α
sin = 0 or sin = 0
2 2
θ+α θ−α
sin = 0 gives sin = 0 gives
2 2
θ+α θ−α
= nπ, n ∈ Z = nπ, n ∈ Z
2 2
θ = 2nπ − α, n ∈ Z. ...(i) θ = 2nπ + α, n ∈ Z ...(ii)
tan θ = tan α
sin θ sin α
= ⇒ sin θ cos α − cos θ sin α = 0
cos θ cos α
sin (θ − α) = 0 ⇒ θ − α = nπ
θ = nπ + α, n ∈ Z
Thus, tan θ = tan α ⇒ θ = nπ + α, n ∈ Z (3.15)
Trigonometry 126
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
√ b
Take a = r cos α, b = r sin α. Then r = a2 + b2 ; tan α = , a 6= 0
a
a cos θ + b sin θ = c ⇒ r cos α cos θ + r sin α sin θ = c
r cos(θ − α) = c
c c
cos(θ − α) = =√ = cos φ (say)
r a2 + b 2
θ−α = 2nπ ± φ, n ∈ Z
θ = 2nπ + α ± φ, n ∈ Z.
√
The above√method can be used only when c ≤ a2 + b2 .
If c > a2 + b2 , then the equation a cos θ + b sin θ = c has no solution.
sin θ = 0 θ = nπ; n ∈ Z
π
cos θ = 0 θ = (2n + 1) ; n ∈ Z
2
tan θ = 0 θ = nπ; n ∈ Z
h π πi
sin θ = sin α, where α ∈ − , θ = nπ + (−1)n α, n ∈ Z
2 2
√
1 3
Example 3.42 Find the principal solution of (i) sin θ = (ii) sin θ = −
2 2
1
(iii) cosecθ = −2 (iv) cos θ =
2
Solution:
1
(i) sin θ = > 0 so principal value lies in the I quadrant.
2
1 π
sin θ = = sin
2 6
π
Thus, θ = is the principal solution.
√6
3
(ii) sin θ = −
2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
h π πi
We know that principal value of sin θ lies in − , .
2 2
√
3
Since, sin θ = − < 0, the principal value of sin θ lies in the IV quadrant.
√ 2
3 π π
sin θ = − = − sin = sin − .
2 3 3
π
Hence, θ = − is the principal solution.
3
(iii) cosec θ = −2
1 1
cosec θ = −2 ⇒ = −2 ⇒ sin θ = −
sin θ 2
1
Since sin θ = − < 0, the principal value of sin θ lies in the IV quadrant.
2
1 π π
sin θ = − = − sin = sin −
2 6 6
π
Thus, θ = − is the principal solution.
6
1
(iv) cos θ =
2
Principal value of cos θ lies in the I and II quadrant.
1 h πi
Since cos θ = > 0, the principal value of cos θ lies in the interval 0, .
2 2
1 π
cos θ = = cos
2 3
π
Thus, θ = is the principal solution.
3
√
3
Example 3.43 Find the general solution of sin θ = −
2
Solution: h π πi
The general solution of sin θ = sin α, α ∈ − , , is θ = nπ + (−1)n α, n ∈ Z
2 2
√
3 π
sin θ = − = sin − ,
2 3
Thus the general solution is
π π
θ = nπ + (−1)n − = nπ + (−1)n+1 ; n ∈ Z ... (i)
3 3
π
In arriving at the above general solution, we took the principal value as − with our
3
convention that principal value is the numerically smallest one in the interval [−π, π]. Now
through this example, we shall justify that the principal value may also be taken in [0, 2π] ,
Trigonometry 128
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) sec θ = −2
1
sec θ = −2 ⇒ cos θ = −
2
We know that the general solution of cos θ = cos α, α ∈ [0, π], is θ = 2nπ ± α, n ∈ Z
1 π 2π
Let us find α ∈ [0, π] such that cos α = − = cos π − = cos .
2 3 3
2π
so, α = .
3
2π
√general solution is θ = 2nπ ± 3 , n ∈ Z.
Thus, the
(ii) tan θ = 3
√ π
tan θ = 3 = tan
3 π π
We know that the general solution of tan θ = tan α, α ∈ − , is θ = nπ + α, n ∈ Z
π 2 2
Thus, θ = nπ + , n ∈ Z, is the general solution.
3
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
cos x+ sin x =cos 2x ⇒ cos x− cos 2x= sin2x − sinx
+ sin 2x
x + 2x 2x − x 2x + x 2x − x
2 sin sin = 2 cos sin
2 2 2 2
3x x 3x x
2 sin sin = 2 cos sin
2 2 2 2
x 3x
3x
sin sin − cos =0
2 2 2
x
3x 3x
Thus, either sin = 0 (or) sin − cos = 0.
2 2 2
x
3x 3x
When sin =0 When sin − cos =0
2 2 2
x 3x π
= nπ ⇒ x = 2nπ, n ∈ Z. ⇒ tan = 1 = tan
2 2 4
3x π 2nπ π
= nπ + ⇒ x = + .
2 4 3 6
2nπ π
Thus, the general solution is x = 2nπ (or) x = + , n ∈ Z.
3 6
π sin θ
If sin θ = cos θ, then θ 6= (2n + 1) , n ∈ Z. So, we have =1
2 cos θ
Trigonometry 130
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
π
When cos 5θ = 0 ⇒ 5θ = (2n + 1) When, sin 4θ = 0 ⇒ 4θ = nπ
2
π nπ
⇒ θ = (2n + 1) , n ∈ Z ⇒θ= ,n ∈ Z
10 4
π nπ
Thus, the general solution of the given equation is θ = (2n + 1) , θ = , n ∈ Z.
10 4
π
Example 3.49 Solve tan 2x = − cot x +
3
Solution:
π π π 5π
tan 2x = − cot x + = tan +x+ = tan +x
3 2 3 6
5π 5π
2x = nπ + + x, n ∈ Z ⇒ x = nπ + , n ∈ Z.
6 6
sin x + cos x = 1
Hence,
√ 1 1
2 √ sin x + √ cos x = 1
2 2
√ π π 1
2 cos − x = 1 ⇒ cos −x = √
4 4 2
π π
Thus, we have x − = ± + 2nπ, n ∈ Z
4 4
π
x = + 2nπ, or x = 2nπ, n ∈ Z.
2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1
Either cos x = 0 or sin2 x =
2
1 π
cos x = 0 = sin2
sin2 x =
2 4
π π
⇒ x = (2n + 1) , n ∈ Z x = nπ ± , n ∈ Z How
2 4
π π
Thus the solution is x = (2n + 1) , x = nπ ± , n ∈ Z.
2 4
√ √
Example 3.53 Prove that for any a and b , − a2 + b2 ≤ a sin θ + b cos θ ≤ a2 + b2
Solution:
√
a b
Now, a sin θ + b cos θ = a2 + b2 √ sin θ + √ cos θ
a 2 + b2 a 2 + b2
√
= a2 + b2 [cos α sin θ + sin α cos θ]
a b
where cos α = √ , sin α = √
√ a2 + b2 a2 + b2
= a2 + b2 sin(α + θ)
√
Thus, |a sin θ + b cos θ| ≤ a2 + b2
√ √
Hence, − a2 + b2 ≤ a sin θ + b cos θ ≤ a2 + b2 .
√ √
Example 3.54 Solve 3 sin θ − cos θ = 2
Solution:
√ √
3 sin θ − cos θ =√ 2 √ √
Here a = −1; b = 3; c = 2; r = a2 + b2 = 2.
Thus, the given equation can be rewritten as
√
3 1 1
sin θ − cos θ = √
2 2 2
π π π
sin θ cos − cos θ sin = sin
6 6 4
π π
sin θ − = sin
6 4
π π
θ − = nπ ± (−1)n , n ∈ Z
6 4
π π
Thus, θ = nπ + ± (−1)n , n ∈ Z.
6 4
Trigonometry 132
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
√ √
Example 3.55 Solve 3 tan2 θ + 3 − 1 tan θ − 1 = 0
Solution:
√ 2
√
3 tan θ + 3 − 1 tan θ − 1 = 0
√ √
√3 tan2 θ + 3 tan θ − tan θ − 1 = 0
3 tan θ − 1 (tan θ + 1) = 0
√
Thus, either 3 tan θ − 1 = 0 (or) tan θ + 1 = 0
√
If 3 tan θ − 1 = 0, then If tan θ + 1 = 0 then
1 π −π
tan θ = √ = tan tan θ = −1 = tan
3 6 4
π π
⇒ θ = nπ + , n ∈ Z...(i) ⇒ θ = nπ − , n ∈ Z...(ii)
6 4
Exercise - 3.8
1. Find the principal solution and general solutions of the following:
1 √ 1
(i) sin θ = − √ (ii) cot θ = 3 (iii) tan θ = − √ .
2 3
2. Solve the following equations for which solutions lies in the interval 0◦ ≤ θ < 360◦
(i) sin4 x = sin2 x
(ii) 2 cos2 x + 1 = −3 cos x
(iii) 2 sin2 x + 1 = 3 sin x
(iv) cos 2x = 1 − 3 sin x.
3. Solve the following equations:
(i) sin 5x − sin x = cos 3x
(ii) 2 cos2 θ + 3 sin θ − 3 = 0
(iii) cos θ + cos 3θ = 2 cos 2θ
(iv) sin θ + sin 3θ + sin 5θ = 0
(v) sin 2θ − cos 2θ − sin θ + cos θ = 0
√
(vi) sin θ + cos θ = 2
√
(vii) sin θ + 3 cos θ = 1
√
(viii) cot θ + cosecθ = 3
√
π 2π
(ix) tan θ + tan θ + + tan θ + = 3
3 3
√
5+1
(x) cos 2θ =
4
2
(xi) 2 cos x − 7 cos x + 3 = 0
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
A A A
D B c A b C
a
A R c b
A R
c a
O B R R C O
R O
R
a 180°-A D
B C
A is acute A = 90° A is obtuse
Figure 3.18
Trigonometry 134
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Case I: ∠A is acute.
Produce BO to meet the circle at D.
∠BDC = ∠BAC = A
∠BCD = 90◦
BC a a
sin ∠BDC = or sin A = ⇒ = 2R
BD 2R sin A
Case II: ∠A is right angle.
In this case O must be on the side BC of the4ABC.
a BC 2R a
Now, = ◦
= = 2R ⇒ = 2R
sin A sin 90 1 sin A
Case III: ∠A is obtuse .
Produce BO to meet the circle at D.
∠BDC + ∠BAC = 180◦
∠BDC = 180◦ − ∠BAC = 180◦ − A
∠BCD = 90◦
BC a a
sin ∠BDC = or sin(180◦ − A) = sin A = ⇒ = 2R
BD 2R sin A
a
In each case, we have = 2R
sin A
b c
Similarly, by considering angles B and C, we can prove that = 2R and = 2R
sin B sin C
respectively.
a b c
Thus, = = = 2R.
sin A sin B sin C
Napier’s Formula
Theorem 3.2: In 4ABC, we have
A−B a−b C
(i) tan = cot
2 a+b 2
B−C b−c A
(ii) tan = cot
2 b+c 2
C −A c−a B
(iii) tan = cot
2 c+a 2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Proof.
a b c
We know the sine formula: = = = 2R
sin A sin B sin C
a−b C 2R sin A − 2R sin B C
Now, cot = cot
a+b 2 2R sin A + 2R sin B 2
sin A − sin B C
= cot
sin A + sin B 2
A+B A−B
2 cos sin
= 2 2 cot C
A+B A−B 2
2 sin cos
2 2
A+B A−B C
= cot tan cot
2 2 2
C A − B C
= cot 90◦ − tan cot
2 2 2
C A−B C A−B
= tan tan cot = tan
2 2 2 2
Similarly we can prove the other two results.
3.7.2 Law of Cosines
When two sides and included angle or the three sides of a triangle are given, the triangle cannot be
solved using the sine formula. In such a situation, the law of cosines can be used to solve the triangle.
Also, the Law of Cosines is used to derive a formula for finding the area of a triangle given two sides
and the included angle.
Theorem 3.3 (The Law of Cosines): In 4ABC, we have
b2 + c2 − a2 c2 + a2 − b2 a2 + b2 − c2
cos A = ; cos B = ; cos C = .
2bc 2ca 2ab
Proof. In 4ABC, draw AD⊥BC. A
In 4ABD, we have AB 2 = AD2 + BD2 ⇒ c2 = AD2 + BD2 .
Now, we find the values of AD and BD in terms of the elements
of 4ABC.
c b
AD
= sin C ⇒ AD = b sin C
AC
BD = BC − DC = a − b cos C B a C
D
2 2 2
c = (b sin C) + (a − b cos C)
Figure 3.19
= b2 sin2 C + a2 + b2 cos2 C − 2ab cos C
= a2 + b2 sin2 C + cos2 C − 2ab cos C
= a2 + b2 − 2ab cos C
a2 + b 2 − c2
Thus, c2 = a2 + b2 − 2ab cos C or cos C = .
2ab
Similarly, we can prove the other two results, namely
b2 + c2 − a2
a2 = b2 + c2 − 2bc cos A or cos A =
2bc
c + a2 − b2
2
b2 = c2 + a2 − 2ca cos B or cos B =
2ca
Trigonometry 136
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) a2 = b2 + c2 − 2bc cos A says that the square of a side is the sum of squares of other two
sides diminished by twice the product of those two sides and the cosine of the included
angle. Also one formula will give the other formula by cycling through the letters a, b, c.
(ii) The Laws of Cosine for right triangles reduce to Pythagorean theorem. Thus, the Law
of cosines can be viewed as a generalisation of Pythagorean theorem.
(iii) The advantage of using law of cosines over law of sines is that unlike the sine function,
the cosine function distinguishes between acute and obtuse angles. If cosine of an angle
is positive, then it is acute. Otherwise, it is obtuse.
(iv) The Law of Cosines says : The direct route is the shortest. Let us explain this. In a
4ABC, c2 = a2 + b2 − 2ab cos C. Since − cos C < 1 we have c2 < a2 + b2 + 2ab.
Thus, we have c < a + b. Hence, In 4ABC, we have a < b + c, b < c + a, c < a + b
(v) When using the law of cosines, it is always best to find the measure of the largest
unknown angle first, since this will give us the obtuse angle of the triangle if there
is one such angle.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) The formula for the area of an oblique triangle says that the B
Seg D
area is equal to one half of the product of two sides and the me
nt
sine of their included angle. θ
(ii) The area formula is used to compute the area of the segment A
r O
of a circle. Segment of a circle is the region between a chord
and the arc it cuts off.
Let r be the radius of a circle and θ be the angle subtended
by the chord AB at the centre.
Figure 3.22
Area of the segment ABD = Area of the sector − Area of the 4OAB
1 1
= r2 θ − r2 sin θ
2 2
1
= r2 (θ − sin θ)
2
(iii) The area formula of a triangle is viewed as generalisation of area formula of a right
triangle.
(iv) In the above formula, it is clear that the measure of third side is not required in finding
the area of the triangles. Also there is no need of finding the altitude of the triangle in
order to find its area.
Example 3.56
The Government plans to have a circular zoological B
park of diameter 8 km. A separate area in the form Seg D
me
of a segment formed by a chord of length 4 km is to nt
4 4
be allotted exclusively for a veterinary hospital in the θ
park. Find the area of the segment to be allotted for the O 4 A
r
veterinary hospital.
Solution:
Let AB be the chord and O be the centre of the circular park. Figure 3.23
Let ∠AOB = θ.
Trigonometry 138
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) Using Heron’s formula , Pythagorean theorem can be proved for right triangle and
conversely, using Pythagorean theorem for right triangle one can establish Heron’s area
formula.
(ii) If area of a triangle is given as an integer, then Heron’s formula is useful in finding
triangles with integer sides.
(iii) If the perimeter of a triangle is fixed, then Heron’s formula is useful for finding triangles
having integer area and integer sides.
For example, if the perimeter of a triangle is 100m, then there is a triangle with sides
32 m, 34 m, 34 m and area 480 m2 .
B−C b−c A
Example 3.58 In a 4ABC, prove that sin = cos .
2 a 2
Solution:
a b c
The Sine formula is, = = = 2R
sin A sin B sin C
b−c A 2R sin B − 2R sin C A
Now, cos = cos
a 2 2R sin A 2
B−C B+C
2 sin cos
2 2 A
= cos
A A 2
2 sin cos
2 2
B−C ◦ A
sin cos 90 −
2 2
=
A
sin
2
B−C A
sin sin
2 2
=
A
sin
2
B−C
= sin .
2
Trigonometry 140
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 3.59 If the three angles in √ a triangle are in the ratio 1 : 2 : 3, then prove that the
corresponding sides are in the ratio 1 : 3 : 2.
Solution:
Let the angles be θ, 2θ, 3θ.
Then θ + 2θ + 3θ = 180◦
Thus, θ = 30◦
a b c
Using the sine formula, = = , we have,
sin A sin B sin C
a b c
◦
= ◦
=
sin 30 sin 60 sin 90◦
a : b : c = sin 30◦ : sin 60◦ : sin 90◦
√
1 3 √
= : :1=1: 3:2
2 2
Solution:
a2 + b2 1 + cos(A − B) cos C
Example 3.61 In a triangle ABC, prove that 2 2
=
a +c 1 + cos(A − C) cos B
Solution:
a b c
The sine formula is, = = = 2R
sin A sin B sin C
a2 + b2 (2R sin A)2 + (2R sin B)2
L.H.S = 2 =
a + c2 (2R sin A)2 + (2R sin C)2
sin2 A + sin2 B 1 − cos2 A + sin2 B
= =
sin2 A + sin2 C 1 − cos2 A + sin2 C
1 − cos2 A − sin2 B
1 − cos(A + B) cos(A − B)
= 2
=
2
1 − cos A − sin C 1 − cos(A + C) cos(A − C)
1 + cos(A − B) cos C
= .
1 + cos(A − C) cos B
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 3.62 Derive cosine formula using the law of sines in a 4ABC.
Solution:
a b c
The law of Sines: = = = 2R
sin A sin B sin C
b2 + c2 − a2 (2R sin B)2 + (2R sin C)2 − (2R sin A)2
=
2bc 2 (2R sin B) (2R sin C)
sin2 B + sin(C + A) sin(C − A)
=
2 sin B sin C
sin B [sin B + sin(C − A)]
=
2 sin B sin C
sin(C + A) + sin(C − A)
= = cos A
2 sin C
b2 + c2 − a2
Thus, cos A = . Similarly we can derive other two cosine formulas.
2bc
Example 3.63 Using Heron’s formula, show that the equilateral triangle has the maximum area for
any fixed perimeter. [Hint: In xyz ≤ k, maximum occurs when x = y = z].
Solution:
Let ABC be a triangle
p with constant perimeter 2s. Thus s is constant.
We know that 4 = s(s − a)(s − b)(s − c)
Observe that 4 is maximum, when (s − a)(s − b))(s − c) is maximum.
3
s3
(s − a) + (s − b) + (s − c)
Now, (s − a)(s − b)(s − c) ≤ = [G.M ≤ A.M.]
3 27
3
s
Thus, we get (s − a)(s − b)(s − c) ≤
27
Equality occurs when s − a = s − b = s − c. That is, when a = b = c, maximum of
s3
(s − a)(s − b))(s − c) is
27
Thus, for a fixed perimeter 2s, the area of a triangle is maximum when a = b = c.
Hence, for a fixedrperimeter, the equilateral triangle has the maximum area and the maximum area
s (s3 ) s2
is given by 4 = = √ sq.units.
27 3 3
Exercise - 3.9
sin A sin(A − B)
1. In a 4ABC, if = , prove that a2 , b2 , c2 are in Arithmetic Progression.
sin C sin(B − C)
√ √
2. The angles of a triangle ABC, are in Arithmetic Progression and if b : c = 3 : 2, find ∠A.
Trigonometry 142
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
sin A
3. In a 4ABC, if cos C = , show that the triangle is isosceles.
2 sin B
sin B c − a cos B
4. In a 4ABC, prove that = .
sin C b − a cos C
5. In a 4ABC, prove that a cos A + b cos B + c cos C = 2a sin B sin C.
◦ B−C
6. In a 4ABC, ∠A = 60 . Prove that b + c = 2a cos .
2
7. In a 4ABC, prove the following
A A
(i) a sin + B = (b + c) sin
2 2
A
(ii) a(cos B + cos C) = 2(b + c) sin2
2
a2 − c2 sin(A − C)
(iii) =
b2 sin(A + C)
a sin(B − C) b sin(C − A) c sin(A − B)
(iv) 2 2
= 2 2
=
b −c c −a a2 − b2
a+b A+B A−B
(v) = tan cot .
a−b 2 2
8. In a 4ABC, prove that (a2 − b2 + c2 ) tan B = (a2 + b2 − c2 ) tan C.
9. An Engineer has to develop a triangular shaped park with a perimeter 120 m in a village. The park
to be developed must be of maximum area. Find out the dimensions of the park.
10. A rope of length 12 m is given. Find the largest area of the triangle formed by this rope and find
the dimensions of the triangle so formed.
11. Derive Projection formula from (i) Law of sines, (ii) Law of cosines.
Working Rule:
• In a right triangle, two sides determine the third side via the Pythagorean theorem and one acute
angle determine the other by using the fact that acute angles in a right triangle are complementary.
• If all the sides of a triangle are given, then we can use either cosine formula or half-angle formula
to calculate all the angles of the triangle.
• If any two angles and any one of the sides opposite to given angles are given, then we can use sine
formula to calculate the other sides.
• If any two sides of a triangle and the included angle are given, we cannot use the Law of sines;
but then we can use the law of cosines to calculate other side and other angles of the triangle. In
this case we have a unique triangle.
• All methods of solving an oblique triangle require that the length of atleast one side must be
provided.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Let us summarise the working rule to solve an oblique triangle in the following table
Given Information
Oblique triangle SAA SSA* SAS SSS AAA
(all angles are acute or
one angle is obtuse
Details and Law of #(ambiguity The given angle must Law of Cosines; Infinite
Application sines arises) be included angle; First find number
for solutions Either law of Cosines the largest of triangles
or tangents angle
b2 + c2 − a2 52 + 72 − 32 13
cos A = = =
2bc 2(5)(7) 14
11 1
Similarly, cos B = , cos C = − .
14 2
√ √
Example 3.66 In a 4ABC, if a = 2 2, b = 2 3 and C = 75◦ , find the other side and the angles.
Solution: √ √
Given that a = 2 2, b = 2 3 and C = 75◦ .
Trigonometry 144
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
a2 + b2 − c2
Using cosine formula, cos C =
2ab
√
◦ 8 + 12 − c2 3−1 8 + 12 − c2 √ √
cos 75 = √ ⇒ √ = √ ⇒c= 2 3+1
8 6 2 2 8 6
b2 + c2 − a2 1
Also, cos A = = √ , Thus A = 60◦ , B = 180◦ − (A + C) = 45◦ .
2bc 2
Example 3.67 Find the area of the triangle whose sides are 13 cm, 14 cm and 15 cm.
Solution:
a+b+c 13 + 14 + 15
We know that s = ⇒s= = 21 cm.
p2 2
Area of a triangle = s(s − a)(s − b)(s − c)
p
= 21(21 − 13)(21 − 14)(21 − 15) = 84 sq.cm.
842
Example 3.68 In any 4ABC, prove that a cos A + b cos B + c cos C = .
abc
Solution:
We know that a cos A + b cos B + c cos C = 2a sin B sin C
842
24 24
Thus, a cos A + b cos B + c cos C = 2a =
ac ab abc
Example 3.69
Suppose that there are two cell phone towers within range of a cell
phone. The two towers are located at 6 km apart along a straight 31
5km km
highway, running east to west and the cell phone is north √ of the x
θ
highway. The signal is 5 km from the first tower and 31 km 6km
from the second tower. Determine the position of the cell phone
north and east of the first tower and how far it is from the highway. Figure 3.24
Solution:
Let θ be the position of the cell phone from north to east of the first tower.
Then, using the cosine formula, we have,
√ 2
31 = 52 + 62 − 2 × 5 × 6 cos θ
31 = 25 + 36 − 60 cos θ
1
cos θ = ⇒ θ = 60◦
2
Let x be the distance of the cell phone’s position from
√ the highway.
x 5 × 3
Then, sin θ = ⇒ x = 5 sin θ = 5 sin 60◦ = km.
5 2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 3.70
Suppose that a boat travels 10 km from the B
port towards east and then turns 60◦ to its
m
left. If the boat travels further 8 km, how far
8k
from the port is the boat? Port 60°
Solution: P 10 km
Example 3.71
Suppose two radar stations located 100km apart, each detect a A
fighter aircraft between them. The angle of elevation measured
a
by the first station is 30◦ , whereas the angle of elevation mea- x
sured by the second station is 45◦ . Find the altitude of the aircraft 30° 45°
at that instant. R1 100 N R2
Figure 3.26
Solution:
Let R1 and R2 be two radar stations and A be the position of fighter aircraft at the time of detection.
Let x be the required altitude of the aircraft.
Draw ⊥AN from A to R1 R2 meeting at N .
Exercise - 3.10
1. Determine whether the following measurements produce one triangle, two triangles or no triangle:
∠B = 88◦ , a = 23, b = 2. Solve if solution exists.
Trigonometry 146
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
be 8 km, while the distance to the western most point from P to be 6 km. If the angle between the
two lines of sight is 60◦ , find the width of the pond.
9. Two Navy helicopters A and B are flying over the Bay of Bengal at same altitude from the sea
level to search a missing boat. Pilots of both the helicopters sight the boat at the same time while
they are apart 10 km from each other. If the distance of the boat from A is 6 km and if the line
segment AB subtends 60◦ at the boat, find the distance of the boat from B.
10. A straight tunnel is to be made through a mountain. A surveyor observes the two extremities A and
B of the tunnel to be built from a point P in front of the mountain. If AP = 3km, BP = 5 km
and ∠AP B = 120◦ , then find the length of the tunnel to be built.
11. A farmer wants to purchase a triangular shaped land with sides 120f eet and 60f eet and the
angle included between these two sides is 60◦ . If the land costs |500 per sq.ft, find the amount he
needed to purchase the land. Also find the perimeter of the land.
12. A fighter jet has to hit a small target by flying a horizontal distance. When the target is sighted,
the pilot measures the angle of depression to be 30◦ . If after 100 km, the target has an angle of
depression of 60◦ , how far is the target from the fighter jet at that instant?
13. A plane is 1 km from one landmark and 2 km from another. From the planes point of view the
land between them subtends an angle of 45◦ . How far apart are the landmarks?
14. A man starts his morning walk at a point A reaches two points B and C and finally back to A such
that ∠A = 60◦ and ∠B = 45◦ , AC = 4km in the 4ABC. Find the total distance he covered
during his morning walk.
15. Two vehicles leave the same place P at the same time moving along two different roads. One
vehicle moves at an average speed of 60km/hr and the other vehicle moves at an average speed
of 80 km/hr. After half an hour the vehicle reach the destinations A and B. If AB subtends 60◦
at the initial point P , then find AB.
16. Suppose that a satellite in space, an earth station and the centre of earth all lie in the same plane.
Let r be the radius of earth and R be the distance from the centre of earth to the satellite. Let d be
the distance from the earth station to the satellite. Let 30◦ be the angle of elevation from the earth
connecting earth station and satellite subtends angle α at
station to the satellite. If the line segment r
r 2 r
the centre of earth, then prove that d = R 1 + − 2 cos α.
R R
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
The inverse functions sin−1 x, cos−1 x, tan−1 x, cosec−1 (x), sec−1 (x), cot−1 (x) are
called inverse circular functions. For the function y = sin x, there are infinitely many angles x which
h π πsin
satisfy i x = t, −1 ≤ t ≤ 1. Of these infinite set of values, there is one which lies in the interval
− , . This angle is called the principal angle and denoted by sin−1 t. The principal value of
2 2
an inverse function is that value of the general value which is numerically least. It may be positive
or negative. When there are two values, one is positive and the other is negative such that they are
numerically equal, then the principal value is the positive one.
We shall illustrate below the restricted domains, ranges of trigonometric functions and the
domains, ranges of the corresponding inverse functions.
h π πi
sin x : − π2 , π2 → [−1, 1] ; sin−1 x : [−1, 1] → − ,
(i)
2 2
−1
(ii) cos x : [0, π] → [−1, 1] ; cos x : [−1, 1] → [0, π]
π π
π π −1
(iii) tan x : − 2 , 2 → (−∞, ∞) ; tan x : (−∞, ∞) → − ,
2 2
(iv) cot x : (0, π) → (−∞, ∞) ; cot−1 x : (−∞, ∞) → (0, π)
h π πi
cosecx : − π2 , π2 − {0} → R − (−1, 1) ; cosec−1 x : R − (−1, 1) → − ,
(v) − {0}
2 2
nπ o
sec x : [0, π] − π2 → R − (−1, 1) ; sec−1 x : R − (−1, 1) → [0, π] −
(vi)
2
1
(i) sin−1 x does not mean .
sin x
(ii) Another notation for sin−1 x is arcsin x due to Sir. John FW Herschel (1813).
(iii) While discussing the inverse of sine function, we confined to y = sin x, − π2 ≤ x ≤ π2
and
x = sin−1 y, −1 ≤ y ≤ 1
(iv) The graph of inverse function f −1 is the reflexion of the graph of f about the line y = x.
Thus, if (a, b) ∈ f then (b, a) ∈ f −1 .
Trigonometry 148
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) Properties, graphs, theorems on inverse trigonometric functions will be studied in higher
secondary second year.
(ii) Inverse trigonometric functions are much useful in the evaluation of some integrals
which will be studied later.
√ !
3 2
Example 3.72 Find the principal value of (i) sin−1 , (ii) cosec −1
√ ,
2 3
−1 −1
(iii) tan √ .
3
Solution:
√ !
3 π π
(i) Let sin−1 = y, where − ≤ y ≤
2 2 2
√
3 π π
⇒ sin y = = sin ⇒ y =
2 3 3 √ !
3 π
Thus, the principal value of sin−1 =
2 3
2 π π
(ii) Let cosec −1 √ = y, where − ≤ y ≤
3 2 2
√
2 3
⇒ cosec y = √ = sin y =
3 2
−1 2 π
Thus, the principal value of cosec √ =
3 3
−1 π π
(iii) Let tan−1 √ = y, where − ≤ y ≤
3 2 2
1 π π
tan y = − √ ⇒ tan y = tan − ⇒y=−
3 6 6
−1 π
Thus the principal value of tan−1 √ =− .
3 6
Exercise - 3.11
√ √
−1 1 −1 3 −1 −1
1. Find the principal value of (i) sin √ (ii) cos (iii) cosec (−1) (iv) sec − 2
√ 2 2
(v) tan−1 3 .
2. A man standing directly opposite to one side of a road of width x meter views a circular shaped
traffic green signal of diameter a meter on the other side of the road. The bottom of the green
signal is b meter height from the horizontal level of viewer’s eye. If α denotes the angle subtended
by the diameter of the green signal at the viewer’s eye, then prove that
−1 a+b −1 b
α = tan − tan .
x x
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 3.12
Choose the correct answer or the most suitable answer:
√
1 3
1. − =
cos 80◦ sin 80◦
√ √
(1) 2 (2) 3 (3) 2 (4) 4
2. If cos 28◦ + sin 28◦ = k 3 , then cos 17◦ is equal to
k3 k3 k3 k3
(1) √ (2) − √ (3) ± √ (4) − √
2 2 2 3
2 2 x x
3. The maximum value of 4 sin x + 3 cos x + sin + cos is
2 2
√ √
(1) 4 + 2 (2) 3 + 2 (3) 9 (4) 4
π 3π 5π 7π
4. 1 + cos 1 + cos 1 + cos 1 + cos =
8 8 8 8
1 1 1 1
(1) (2) (3) √ (4) √
8 2 3 2
√
q
3π
5. If π < 2θ < , then 2 + 2 + 2 cos 4θ equals to
2
(1) −2 cos θ (2) −2 sin θ (3) 2 cos θ (4) 2 sin θ
◦ ◦
tan 140 − tan 130
6. If tan 40◦ = λ, then =
1 + tan 140◦ tan 130◦
1 − λ2 1 + λ2 1 + λ2 1 − λ2
(1) (2) (3) (4)
λ λ 2λ 2λ
7. cos 1◦ + cos 2◦ + cos 3◦ + . . . + cos 179◦ =
(1) 0 (2) 1 (3) −1 (4) 89
1 k
sin x + cosk x where x ∈ R and k ≥ 1. Then f4 (x) − f6 (x) =
8. Let fk (x) =
k
1 1 1 1
(1) (2) (3) (4)
4 12 6 3
9. Which of the following is not true?
3 1
(1 ) sin θ = − (2) cos θ = −1 (3) tan θ = 25 (4) sec θ =
4 4
10. cos 2θ cos 2φ + sin2 (θ − φ) − sin2 (θ + φ) is equal to
(1) sin 2(θ + φ) (2) cos 2(θ + φ) (3) sin 2(θ − φ) (4) cos 2(θ − φ)
sin(A − B) sin(B − C) sin(C − A)
11. + + is
cos A cos B cos B cos C cos C cos A
(1) sin A + sin B + sin C (2) 1 (3) 0 (4) cos A + cos B + cos C
12. If cos pθ + cos qθ = 0 and if p 6= q, then θ is equal to (n is any integer)
π(3n + 1) π(2n + 1) π(n ± 1) π(n + 2)
(1) (2) (3) (4)
p−q p±q p±q p+q
Trigonometry 150
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
sin(α + β)
13. If tan α and tan β are the roots of x2 + ax + b = 0, then is equal to
sin α sin β
b a a b
(1) (2) (3) − (4) −
a b b a
14. In a triangle ABC, sin2 A + sin2 B + sin2 C = 2, then the triangle is
(1) equilateral triangle (2) isosceles triangle (3) right triangle (4) scalene triangle.
15. If f (θ) = |sin θ| + |cos θ| , θ ∈ R, then f (θ) is in the interval
h √ i
(1) [0, 2] (2) 1, 2 (3) [1, 2] (4) [0, 1]
cos 6x + 6 cos 4x + 15 cos 2x + 10
16. is equal to
cos 5x + 5 cos 3x + 10 cos x
(1) cos2x (2) cos x (3) cos 3x (4) 2 cos x
17. The triangle of maximum area with constant perimeter 12m
(1) is an equilateral triangle with side 4m (2) is an isosceles triangle with sides 2m, 5m, 5m
(3) is a triangle with sides 3m, 4m, 5m (4) Does not exist.
18. A wheel is spinning at 2 radians/second. How many seconds will it take to make 10 complete
rotations?
(1) 10π seconds (2) 20π seconds (3) 5π seconds (4) 15π seconds
19. If sin α + cos α = b, then sin 2α is equal to
√ √ √
(1) b2 − 1, if b ≤ 2 (2) b2 − 1, if b > 2 (3) b2 − 1, if b ≥ 1 (4) b2 − 1, if b ≥ 2
20. In a 4ABC, if
A B C
(i) sin sin sin > 0
2 2 2
(ii) sin A sin B sin C > 0 then
(1) Both (i) and (ii) are true (2) Only (i) is true
(3) Only (ii) is true (4) Neither (i) nor (ii) is true.
Summary
Sum and Difference Identities(Ptolemy Identities):
cos(α ± β) = cos α cos β ∓ sin α sin β; sin(α ± β) = sin α cos β ± cos α sin β
tan α + tan β tan α − tan β
tan(α + β) = ; tan(α − β) =
1 − tan α tan β 1 + tan α tan β
151 Summary
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Trigonometry 152
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
ICT CORNER-3(a)
Expected Outcome⇒
Step–1
Open the Browser and type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code..
Step–2
GeoGebra Work book called “XI Std Trigonometry” will appear. In this several work
sheets of different Trigonometry concepts are seen. Select one you want. For example,
open “Sine and Cosine - Addition Formula”
Step–3
Move the Sliders to change α and β values. Angles in the Diagram changes and the
Addition formula values change correspondingly.
Observe for each value and calculate by formulae and check the results. Similarly Open and check
other work sheets for Ratios and Unit circle etc..
*Pictures are only indicatives.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Step–1
Open the Browser andtype the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code.
Step–2
GeoGebra Work sheet called “The Sine Law” will appear. In the worksheet a Triangle
is seen with vertices A,B and C with sides a, b and c. Move the vertices to change the
Triangle size.
For any triangle Sine Law is maintained and the working is shown on right-hand side-
Observe.
Trigonometry 154
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Combinatorics and
Chapter 4 Mathematical Induction
- Newton
4.1 Introduction
Combinatorics is the branch of mathematics which is related to counting. It deals with arrangements
of objects as well as enumeration, that is, counting of objects with specific properties. The roots of the
subject can be traced as far back as 2800 BC(BCE) when it was used to study magic squares and
patterns within them.
English physicist and mathematician Sir Isaac Newton, most famous for his law of gravitation,
was instrumental in the scientific revolution of the 17th century. Newton’s belief in the “Persistance
of patterns” led to his first significant mathematical discovery, the generalization of the expansion of
binomial expressions.
Newton discovered Binomial Theorem which he claimed the easiest
way to solve the quadratures of curves. This discovery is essential
in understanding probability. The generalized version of the Binomial
Theorem, the Multinomial Theorem, applies to multiple variables. It is
widely used in Combinatorics and Statistics.
He was the first to use fractional indices and to employ coor-
dinate geometry to derive solutions to Diophantine equations. He
approximated partial sums of the harmonic series by logarithms (a
precursor to Euler’s summation formula) and was the first to use
power series with confidence and to revert power series. Newton’s
work on infinite series was inspired by Simon Stevin’s decimals. Newton (1643−1727)
In 1705, he was knighted by Queen Anne of England, making him Sir Isaac Newton. Newton made
discoveries in optics and theory of motions. Along with mathematician Leibnitz, Newton is credited
for developing essential theories of calculus.
Combinatorics has many real life applications where counting of objects are involved. For
example, we may be interested to know if there are enough mobile numbers to meet the demand
or the number of allowable passwords in a computer system. It also deals with counting techniques
and with optimisation methods, that is, methods related to finding the best possible solution among
several possibilities in a real problem. In this chapter we shall study counting problems in terms of
ordered or unordered arrangements of objects. These arrangements are referred to as permutations and
combinations. Combinatorics are largely used in the counting problems of Network communications,
Cryptography, Network Security and Probability theory. We shall explore their properties and apply
them to counting problems.
Consider another situation: We all know that our electricity consumer card number is of the form
A: B : C, where A denotes the electrical substation /larger capacity transformer number, B denotes the
smaller capacity electricity transformer number and C denotes the consumer number. There may be
conditions that to each substation certain maximal number of transformer can only be linked and with
155
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
a particular transformer certain maximal number of consumer connection can only be linked. Now
the question of deciding, whether a new Transformer/Substation needs to be erected, can be made by
the count of the number of consumer connections linked with a substation transformer. How to get
that count? This count can be easily arrived by the use of counting principles.
In this Chapter, the art of counting is discussed starting with the Fundamental principles of
counting, travelling through Permutation and Combinations.
Learning Objectives
On completion of this chapter, the students are expected to know
• the principles of counting and applying it to various situations.
• how to compute the number of ways in arranging a set of distinct objects.
• how to compute the number of arrangements from a set containing identical objects.
• how to compute and applying the strategies to find the number of combinations of a set of
different objects.
• the applications of the principle of mathematical induction.
We shall start the chapter with the section on
1. The Sum Rule Let us consider two tasks which need to be completed. If the first task can be
completed in M different ways and the second in N different ways, and if these cannot be
performed simultaneously, then there are M + N ways of doing either task. This is the sum
rule of counting.
Example 4.1 Suppose one girl or one boy has to be selected for a competition from a class
comprising 17 boys and 29 girls. In how many different ways can this selection be made?
Solution:
The first task of selecting a girl can be done in 29 ways. The second task of selecting a boy can
be done in 17 ways. It follows from the sum rule, that there are 17+29 = 46 ways of making this
selection.
The sum rule may be extended to more than two tasks. Thus if there are n non-simultaneous
tasks T1 , T2 , T3 , · · · , Tn which can be performed in m1 , m2 , · · · , mn ways respectively, then
the number of ways of doing one of these tasks is m1 + m2 + · · · + mn .
2. The Product Rule Let us suppose that a task comprises of two procedures. If the first
procedure can be completed in M different ways and the second procedure can be done in N
different ways after the first procedure is done, then the total number of ways of completing
the task is M × N
Example 4.2 Consider the 3 cities Chennai, Trichy and Tirunelveli. In order to reach Tirunelveli
from Chennai, one has to pass through Trichy. There are 2 roads connecting Chennai with Trichy
and there are 3 roads connecting Trichy with Tirunelveli. What are the total number of ways of
travelling from Chennai to Tirunelveli?
Combinatorics and Mathematical Induction 156
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Solution:
There are 2 roads connecting Chennai to Trichy. Suppose these are R1 and R2 . Further there are
3 roads connecting Trichy to Tirunelveli . Let us name them as S1 , S2 and S3 . Suppose a person
chooses R1 to travel from Chennai to Trichy and may further choose any of the 3 roads S1 , S2 or S3
to travel from Trichy to Tirunelveli. Thus the possible road choices are (R1 , S1 ), (R1 , S2 ), (R1 , S3 ).
Similarly, if the person chooses R2 to travel from Chennai to Trichy, the choices would be
(R2 , S1 ), (R2 , S2 ), (R2 , S3 ).
R1 S1
S2
CH TR TV
R2 S3
Figure 4.1
3. The Inclusion-Exclusion Principle Suppose two tasks A and B can be performed simulta-
neously. Let n(A) and n(B) represent the number of ways of performing the tasks A and B
independent of each other. Also let n(A ∩ B) be the number of ways of performing the two
tasks simultaneously. We cannot use the sum rule to count the number of ways of performing
one of the tasks as that would lead to over counting. To obtain the correct number of ways
we add the number of ways of performing each of the two tasks and then subtract the number
of ways of doing both tasks simultaneously. This method is referred to as the principle of
inclusion - exclusion. Using the notation of set theory we write it as
Suppose we have to find the number of positive integers divisible by 2 or 7 (but not both), upto 1000.
Let n(A) denote the number of integers divisible by 2, n(B) denote the number of integers divisible
by 7 and n(A ∩ B) the number of integers divisible by both 2 and 7. Then the number of positive
integers divisible by 2 or 7 is given by
(Note that n(A) will include all multiples of 2 upto 1000, n(B) will include all multiples of 7 upto
1000 and so on.)
Tree Diagrams: Tree diagrams are often helpful in representing the possibilities in a counting
problem. Typically in a tree the branches represent the various possibilities. For example, suppose
a person wants to buy a Car for the family. There are two different branded cars and five colours are
available for each brand. Each colour will have three different variant on it namely GL,SS,SL. Then
the various choices for choosing a car can be represented through a tree diagram as follows:
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
My New Car
GL SS SL GL SS SL GL SS SL GL SS SL GL SS SL GL SS SL GL SS SL GL SS SL GL SS SL GL SS SL
Figure 4.2
We shall now illustrate the different rules described above through examples
Example 4.3 A School library has 75 books on Mathematics, 35 books on Physics. A student can
choose only one book. In how many ways a student can choose a book on Mathematics or Physics?
Solution:
(i) A student can choose a Mathematics book in “75” different ways.
(ii) A student can choose a Physics book in “35” different ways.
Hence applying the Rule of Sum, the number of ways a student can choose a book is
75 + 35 = 110.
Example 4.4 If an electricity consumer has the consumer number say 238:110: 29, then describe
the linking and count the number of house connections upto the 29th consumer connection linked
to the larger capacity transformer number 238 subject to the condition that each smaller capacity
transformer can have a maximal consumer link of say 100.
Solution:
The following figure illustrates the electricity distribution network.
Substation
Figure 4.3
There are 110 smaller capacity transformers attached to a larger capacity transformer. As
each smaller capacity transformer can be linked with only 100 consumers, we have for the 109
transformers, there will be 109 × 100 = 10900 links. For the 110th transformer there are only
29 consumers linked. Hence, the total number of consumers linked to the 238th larger capacity
transformer is 10900 + 29 = 10929.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.5 A person wants to buy a car. There are two brands of car available in the market and
each brand has 3 variant models and each model comes in five different colours as in Figure 4.2 In
how many ways she can choose a car to buy?
Solution:
A car can be bought by choosing a brand, then a variant model, and then a colour. A brand can be
chosen in 2 ways; a model can be chosen in 3 ways and a colour can be chosen in 5 ways. By the
rule of product the person can buy a car in 2 × 3 × 5 = 30 different ways.
Example 4.6 A Woman wants to select one silk saree and one sungudi saree from a textile shop
located at Kancheepuram. In that shop, there are 20 different varieties of silk sarees and 8 different
varieties of sungudi sarees. In how many ways she can select her sarees?
Solution:
The work is done when she selects one silk saree and one sungudi saree. The Woman can select a
silk saree in 20 ways and sungudi saree in 8 ways. By the rule of product, the total number of ways
of selecting these 2 sarees is 20 × 8 = 160.
Example 4.7 In a village, out of the total number of people, 80 percentage of the people own
Coconut groves and 65 percent of the people own Paddy fields. What is the minimum percentage of
people own both?
Solution:
Let n(C) denote the percentage of people who own the Coconut groves and n(P ) denote the
percentage of people who own Paddy fields. We are given n(C) = 80 and n(P ) = 65. By the
rule of inclusion - exclusion n(C ∩ P ) = n(C) + n(P ) − n(C ∪ P ) . The maximum value of
n(C ∪ P ) is 100. Therefore, the minimum value of n(C ∩ P ) is 80 + 65 − 100 = 45. That is, the
minimum percentage of the people who own both is 45.
In the next problem, we use the notion of a ’string’. A string is formed by writing given
letters one by one in a sequence. For instance, strings of length three formed out of the
letters a,b,c & d are aaa, abb, bda, dca, cdd · · · .
Example 4.8
(i) Find the number of strings of length 4, which can be formed using the letters of the word
BIRD, without repetition of the letters.
(ii) How many strings of length 5 can be formed out of the letters of the word PRIME taking all
the letters at a time without repetition.
Solution:
(i) There are as many strings as filling the 4 vacant places by the 4 letters, keeping in mind that
repetition is not allowed. The first place can be filled in 4 different ways by any one of the
letters B,I,R,D. Following which, the second place can be filled in by any one of the remaining
3 letters in 3 different ways, following which the third place can be filled in 2 different ways,
following which fourth place can be filled in 1 way.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Thus the number of ways in which the 4 places can be filled, by the rule of product is
4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 24. Hence, the required number of strings is 24.
(ii) There are 5 different letters with which 5 places are to be filled. The first place can be filled
in 5 ways as any one of the five letters P,R,I,M,E can be placed there. Having filled the first
place with any of the 5 letters, 4 letters are left to be placed in the second place, three letters
are left for the third place and 2 letters are left to be put in the fourth place. The remaining 1
letter has to be placed in the fifth place.
Hence, the total number of ways filling up five places is 5 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 120.
Example 4.9 How many strings of length 6 can be formed using letters of the word FLOWER if
(i) either starts with F or ends with R?
(ii) neither starts with F nor ends with R?
Solution:
In any such string, each of the letters F,L,O,W,E,R is used exactly once.
(i) If such a string starts with F, then the other five positions are to be filled with the letters
L, O, W, E, R.
As there cannot be any repetition of let-
ters in the formation of the strings we can fill
up the 2nd, 3rd, 4th, 5th and 6th places in 5,
4, 3, 2 and 1 ways.
Hence, by the rule of product, the number Figure 4.4
of strings of length 6 starting with F is equal
to 5 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 120.
If such a string ends with R, then the
other five positions are to be filled with the
letters F,L,O,W,E. Figure 4.5
As in the previous case, we conclude that
the number of strings of length ending with
R is 120.
If a string starts with F and also ends with
R, then the other 4 positions are to be filled Figure 4.6
with letters L, O, W, E.
As in the previous cases, the number of strings of length of 6 starting with F and ending
with R is 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 24.
By the principle of inclusion - exclusion, the number of strings of length 6, either starting
with F or ending with R is 120 + 120 − 24 = 216.
(ii) A string that neither starts with F nor ends with R is one which has not been counted in
(i). Together, they account for all possible strings of length 6 formed out of the letters,
F,L,O,W,E,R, where no letter is repeated.
Now, the number of all such strings is formed by filling the first position by any of the
6 letters, the second by any of the remaining 5 letters and so on. That is, there are in total
6 × 5 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 720 such strings. The number of words neither starting with F nor
ending with R is the same as the difference between total number of letter strings and the
number of strings either starting with F or end with R which is 720 − 216 = 504.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.10 How many licence plates may be made using either two distinct letters followed by
four digits or two digits followed by 4 distinct letters where all digits or letters are distinct?
Solution:
Here we have two cases:
Case 1: The number of licence plates having two letters followed by four digits is
26 × 25 × 10 × 9 × 8 × 7 = 32, 76, 000.
Case 2: The number of licence plates having two digits followed by four letters is
10 × 9 × 26 × 25 × 24 × 23 = 3, 22, 92, 000.
Since either case 1 or case 2 is possible, the total number of licence plates is
(26 × 25 × 10 × 9 × 8 × 7) + (10 × 9 × 26 × 25 × 24 × 23) = 3, 55, 68, 000.
Example 4.11 Count the number of positive integers greater than 7000 and less than 8000 which
are divisible by 5, provided that no digits are repeated.
Solution:
It should be a 4-digit number greater than 7000 and
less than 8000. Then the 1000th place will be the digit
7. Further, as the number must be divisible by 5 the
unit place should be either 0 or 5. Figure 4.7
As repetition is not permitted, the 100th place can be filled in 8 ways using remaining numbers
and 10th place can be filled in 7 ways.
Hence, the required number of numbers is 1 × 8 × 7 × 2 = 112.
Example 4.12 How many 4 - digit even numbers can be formed using the digits 0, 1, 2, 3 and 4, if
repetition of digits are not permitted?
Solution:
There are two conditions as follows:
1. It is 4-digit number and hence its 1000th place cannot be 0.
2. It is an even number and hence its unit place can be either 0, 2 or 4.
Two cases arise in this situation. Either 0 in the unit place or not.
Case 1. When the unit place is filled by 0, then the 1000th place
can be filled in 4 ways, 100th place can be filled in 3
ways and 10th place in 2 ways. Therefore, number of
4-digit numbers having 0 at unit place is Figure 4.8
4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 24.
Case 2. When the unit place is filled with non-zero numbers,
that is 2 or 4, the number of ways is 2, the number of
ways of filling the 1000th place is in 3 ways (excluding
’0’), 100th place in 3 ways and 10th place in 2 ways. Figure 4.9
Therefore, number of 4-digit numbers without 0 at unit
place is 3 × 3 × 2 × 2 = 36.
Hence, by the rule of sum, the required number of 4 digit even numbers is 24+36 = 60.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.13 Find the total number of outcomes when 5 coins are tossed once.
Solution:
When a coin is tossed, the outcomes are in two ways which are {Head, T ail}.
By the rule of product rule, the number of outcomes when 5 coins are tossed is
2 × 2 × 2 × 2 × 2 = 25 = 32.
Example 4.14 In how many ways (i) 5 different balls be distributed among 3 boxes? (ii) 3 different
balls be distributed among 5 boxes?
Solution:
(i) Each ball can be placed into any one of the three boxes in 3 different ways. Therefore, by
rule of product, the number of ways of distributing 5 different balls among three boxes is
3 × 3 × 3 × 3 × 3 = 35 = 243.
(ii) Each ball can be placed into any one of the five boxes in 5 different ways. Therefore, by
rule of product, the number of ways of distributing 3 different balls among five boxes is
5 × 5 × 5 = 53 = 125.
In order to avoid confusions, take the objects(balls) and distribute them in places(boxes).
More generally, if n different objects are to be placed in m places, then the number of ways
of placing is mn .
Example 4.15 There are 10 bulbs in a room. Each one of them can be operated independently. Find
the number of ways in which the room can be illuminated.
Solution:
Each of the 10 bulbs are operated independently means that each bulb can be operated in two ways.
That is in off mode or on mode. The total number of doing this are 210 which includes the case in
which 10 bulbs are off. Keeping all 10 bulbs in “off” mode, the room cannot be illuminated. Hence,
the total number of ways are 210 − 1 = 1024 − 1 = 1023.
Another concept which is an essential tool in a counting process which is stated as follows:
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
In order to understand the Permutation and Combinations we need a concept called “Factorials” which
will be discussed in the next section.
4.3 Factorials
Factorial of a natural number n is the product of the first n natural numbers. It is denoted by n!.
That is,
n! = 1 × 2 × 3 × · · · × n.
We read this symbol as “n factorial” or “factorial of n”. The notation n! was introduced by the French
mathematician Christian Kramp in the year 1808. Note that for a positive integer n
n! = n × (n − 1) × (n − 2) × · · · × 3 × 2 × 1
= n(n − 1)! for n > 1
= n(n − 1)(n − 2)! for n > 2
= n(n − 1)(n − 2)(n − 3)! for n > 3 and so on.
Observe that,
1! = 1
2! = 2×1=2
3! = 3×2×1=6
4! = 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 24
5! = 5 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 120
... = ...
22! = 22 × 21 × 20 × · · · × 3 × 2 × 1 = 1124000727777607680000
The number 22 ( the Birth date of Ramanujan) has a special place with respect to factorial that, it is
the least integer N greater than 1 whose factorial has exactly N digits.
It will be a good exercise for both students and teachers to find the next number N such that N !
has exactly N digits.
Note that 0! = 1 is evident by substituting n = 0 in the equation (n + 1)! = (n + 1) × n! as
1! = (0 + 1) × 0! =⇒ 0! = 1!1 = 1. This way, we talk of factorial for non-negative integers. Note
that factorials can be extended to certain negative numbers and also to complex numbers, which are
beyond the scope of this book.
We shall now discuss certain examples in order to familiarise the computation of factorials.
Solution:
(i) 5! = 5 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 120.
(ii) 6! − 5! = 6 × 5! − 5! = (6 − 1) × 5! = 5 × 120 = 600.
8! 8 × 7 × 6 × 5! 8×7×6
(iii) = = = 168.
5! × 2! 5! × 2! 2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
7!
Example 4.17 Simplify
2!
Solution:
7! 7 × 6 × 5 × 4 × 3 × 2!
= = 7 × 6 × 5 × 4 × 3 = 2520.
2! 2!
n!
Example 4.18 Evaluate when (i) n = 7, r = 5 (ii) n = 50, r = 47 (iii) For any n
r!(n − r)!
with r = 3.
Solution:
(i) When n = 7, r = 5
n! 7! 7 × 6 × 5! 7×6
= = = = 21.
r!(n − r)! 5!(7 − 5)! 5! × 2! 1×2
(ii) When n = 50, r = 47
n! 50! 50 × 49 × 48 × 47! 50 × 49 × 48
= = = = 19600.
r!(n − r)! 47!(50 − 47)! 47! × 3! 1×2×3
(iii) For any n and r = 3
n! n! n × (n − 1) × (n − 2)(n − 3)! n(n − 1)(n − 2)
= = = .
r!(n − r)! 3!(n − 3)! 1 × 2 × 3 × (n − 3)! 6
Example 4.19 Let N denote the number of days. If the value of N ! is equal to the total number of
hours in N days then find the value of N ?
Solution:
We need to solve the equation N ! = 24 × N .
For N = 1, 2, 3, 4, N ! < 24 × N .
For N = 5, we have N ! = 5! = 4! × 5 = 24N .
For N > 5, we have N ! ≥ 5!N > 24 × N . Hence N = 5.
6!
Example 4.20 If = 6, then find the value of n.
n!
Solution:
6! 1.2.3.4.5.6.
= = 6. As n < 6 we get, n = 5.
n! 1.2.3...n
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.22 What is the unit digit of the sum 2! + 3! + 4! + ..... + 22!?
Solution:
From 5! onwards for all n! the unit digit is zero and hence the contribution to the unit digit is through
1 1 A
Example 4.23 If + = then find the value of A.
7! 8! 9!
Solution:
A 1 1
We have, = +
9 × 8 × 7! 7! 8 × 7!
1 A 1 1 A 9
Therefore, × = × 1+ equivalently, = , which imply A = 81.
7! 9 × 8 7! 8 72 8
(2n)!
Example 4.24 Prove that = 2n (1.3.5 · · · (2n − 1)).
n!
Solution:
Exercise - 4.1
1. (i) A person went to a restaurant for dinner. In the menu card, the person saw 10 Indian and 7
Chinese food items. In how many ways the person can select either an Indian or a Chinese
food?
(ii) There are 3 types of toy car and 2 types of toy train available in a shop. Find the number of
ways a baby can buy a toy car and a toy train?
(iii) How many two-digit numbers can be formed using 1,2,3,4,5 without repetition of digits?
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(iv) Three persons enter in to a conference hall in which there are 10 seats. In how many ways
they can take their seats?
(v) In how many ways 5 persons can be seated in a row?
2. (i) A mobile phone has a passcode of 6 distinct digits. What is the maximum number of attempts
one makes to retrieve the passcode?
(ii) Given four flags of different colours, how many different signals can be generated if each
signal requires the use of three flags, one below the other?
3. Four children are running a race.
(i) In how many ways can the first two places be filled?
(ii) In how many different ways could they finish the race?
4. Count the number of three-digit numbers which can be formed from the digits 2,4,6,8 if
(i) repetitions of digits is allowed. (ii) repetitions of digits is not allowed
5. How many three-digit numbers are there with 3 in the unit place? (i) with repetition (ii) without
repetition.
6. How many numbers are there between 100 and 500 with the digits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ? if (i) repetition
of digits allowed (ii) the repetition of digits is not allowed.
7. How many three-digit odd numbers can be formed by using the digits 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 ? if (i) the
repetition of digits is not allowed (ii) the repetition of digits is allowed.
8. Count the numbers between 999 and 10000 subject to the condition that there are (i) no restriction.
(ii) no digit is repeated. (iii) at least one of the digits is repeated.
9. How many three-digit numbers, which are divisible by 5, can be formed using the digits 0, 1, 2, 3,
4, 5 if (i) repetition of digits are not allowed? (ii) repetition of digits are allowed?
10. To travel from a place A to place B, there are two different bus routes B1 , B2 , two different train
0
routes T1 , T2 and one air route A1 . From place B to place C there is one bus route say B1 , two
0 0 0
different train routes say T1 , T2 and one air route A1 . Find the number of routes of commuting
from place A to place C via place B without using similar mode of transportation.
11. How many numbers are there between 1 and 1000 (both inclusive) which are divisible neither by
2 nor by 5?
12. How many strings can be formed using the letters of the word LOTUS if the word
(i) either starts with L or ends with S? (ii) neither starts with L nor ends with S?
13. (i) Count the total number of ways of answering 6 objective type questions, each question
having 4 choices.
(ii) In how many ways 10 pigeons can be placed in 3 different pigeon holes ?
(iii) Find the number of ways of distributing 12 distinct prizes to 10 students?
14. Find the value of
12! (n + 3)!
(i) 6! (ii) 4! + 5! (iii) 3! − 2! (iv) 3! × 4! (v) (vi)
9! × 3! (n + 1)!
n!
15. Evaluate when
r!(n − r)!
(i) n = 6, r = 2 (ii) n = 10, r = 3 (iii) For any n with r = 2.
16. Find the value of n if
1 1 n
(i) (n + 1)! = 20(n − 1)! (ii) + = .
8! 9! 10!
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Double Factorial of n:
Factorial of an integer n, denoted by n! can be viewed as a function f : N ∪ {0} → N, where N
is the set of all Natural numbers, defined as
(
1 for n = 0,
f (n) =
n × (n − 1) × (n − 2) × .... × 3 × 2 × 1 for n 6= 0.
4.4 Permutations
What is a permutation ?
Permuations come in various disguises.
Suppose three friends A, B and C have to stand in line for a
photograph. In how many order can they stand? Some of the possible
arrangements (from left to right) are
A, B, C: A, C, B: B, A, C
B, C, A: C, B, A: C, A, B.
Thus there are six possible ways in which they can arrange themselves
for the photograph.
Thus if 3 objects have to be arranged in a row there are 3 × 2 × 1 = 3! possible permutations. The
number of permutations of 4 objects taken all at a time is 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 4! Thus if n objects have to
be arranged in a line there are n × (n − 1) × (n − 2) × · · · × 3 × 2 × 1 = n! possible arrangements
or permutations.
Suppose you have 7 letters A,B,C,D,E,F and G. We want to make a 4 letter string. We have
7 choices for the 1st letter. Having chosen the first letter, we have 6 choices for the second letter.
Proceeding this way, we have 4 choices for the 4th letter.
Hence, the number of permutations of 4 letters chosen from 7 letters is
7×6×5×4×3×2×1 7! 7!
7×6×5×4= = = .
3×2×1 3! (7 − 4)!
More generally, the number of distinct permutations of r objects which can be made from n distinct
n!
objects is . It is denoted by n Pr . The formal proof of this result will be proved in this section.
(n − r)!
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
There are n objects that can be filled in the first position. For the second position there are
remaining n − 1 objects. There are n − 2 objects for the third position. Continuing like this until
finally we place one of the (n − (r − 1)) possible objects in the rth position. By the rule of product
we conclude n Pr = n (n − 1) (n − 2) · · · (n − r + 1).
n!
Theorem 4.2: If n ≥ 1, and 0 ≤ r ≤ n, then n Pr = .
(n − r)!
Proof. By Theorem 4.1, we have,
n
Pr = n × (n − 1) × (n − 2) × · · · × (n − r + 1)
n × (n − 1) × (n − 2) × · · · × (n − r + 1) × (n − r) × (n − r − 1) · · · 2 × 1
=
(n − r) × (n − r − 1) × · · · × 2 × 1
n!
= .
(n − r)!
n!
n for r ≤ n,
Pr = (n − r)!
0 for r > n.
(
n
n Pn = n! for r = n,
Pr = n
P0 = 1 for r = 0.
Theorem 4.3: The number of permutations of n different objects taken r at a time where repetition
is allowed, is nr .
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
We can fill the first position with n objects. For the second position (still we can use the object
used in first position), there are n objects, and so on the rth position can be filled with n objects.By the
rule of product, The number of permutations of n different objects taken r at a time when repetition
allowed is n × n × n × · · · n (r times) = nr .
Proof. We have,
n n! n! n!
Pn−1 = = = n! = = n Pn
(n − (n − 1))! 1! (n − n)!
2.
n
Pr = n ×n−1 Pr−1
Proof. We have,
n−1 (n − 1)! n!
n × Pr−1 = n × = = n Pr .
((n − 1) − (r − 1))! (n − r)!
Continuing this process, we arrive at
n
Pr = n × n−1 Pr−1 = n × (n − 1) ×n−2 Pr−2
= n × (n − 1) × (n − 2) ×n−3 Pr−3 × · · · × (n − (r − 1))n−r P0
= n × (n − 1) × (n − 2) × · · · × (n − r + 1).
n
Pr = n × (n − 1) × (n − 2) × · · · × (n − r + 1).
3. n Pr = n−1 Pr + r × n−1
Pr−1
Proof. We have,
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Solution:
(i) 4 P4 = 4 × 3 × 2 × 1 = 4! = 24.
(ii) 5 P3 = 5 × 4 × 3 = 60.
(iii) 8 P4 = 8 × 7 × 6 × 5 = 1680.
(iv) 6 P5 = 6 × 5 × 4 × 3 × 2 = 6! = 720.
10! 7!
=
(10 − r)! (5 − r)!
i.e.,
10 × 9 × 8 × 7! 7!
=
(10 − r) × (9 − r) × (8 − r) × (7 − r) × (6 − r) × (5 − r)! (5 − r)!
(10 − r) × (9 − r) × (8 − r) × (7 − r) × (6 − r) = 10 × 9 × 8 = 6 × 5 × 4 × 3 × 2.
Therefore, 10 − r = 6 ⇒ r = 4.
Example 4.28 How many ‘letter strings’ together can be formed with the letters of the word
“VOWELS” so that
(i) the strings begin with E
(ii) the strings begin with E and end with W.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Solution:
The given strings contains 6 letters (V,O,W,E,L,S).
Therefore the total number of strings with E as the starting letter and W as the final letter is
4! = 24.
Example 4.29 A number of four different digits is formed with the use of the digits 1,2,3,4 and 5
in all possible ways. Find the following
(i) How many such numbers can be formed?
(ii) How many of these are even?
(iii) How many of these are exactly divisible by 4?
Solution:
(i) The solution for this is the same as the
number of permutations taking four digits
out of 5 digits is 5 P4 = 5×4×3×2 = 120.
(ii) For even number last digits must be 2 or 4
which is filled in 2 P1 ways and remaining
Figure 4.12
3 places filled from remaining 4 digits in
4
P3 ways. Therefore the required number
of ways is 2 P1 × 4 P3 = 2 × 24 = 48.
2
(iii) Since the number divisible by 4, then P1 ways
last two digit must be divisible by 4.
The Last two digits become 12,24,32,52
Figure 4.13
( 4 ways). The remaining first two places
filled from remaining 3 digits in 3 P2 ways.
The required number of numbers which
are divisible by 4 is 4 P1 × 3 P2 = 4 × 6 = 4
P1 ways
24.
Figure 4.14
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.30 How many different strings can be formed together using the letters of the word
“EQUATION” so that
(i) the vowels always come together?
(ii) the vowels never come together?
Solution:
(i) There are 8 letters in the word “EQUATION” which includes 5 vowels (E,U,A,I,O) and 3
consonants (Q,T,N). Considering 5 vowels as one letter, we have 4 letters which can be
arranged in 4 P4 = 4! ways. But corresponding each of these arrangements, the vowels
E,U,A,I,O can be put in 5 P5 = 5! ways.
Hence, by the rule of product required number of words is 4! × 5! = 24 × 120 = 2880.
(ii) The total number of strings formed by using all the eight letters of the word “EQUATION” is
8
P8 = 8! = 40320.
So, the total number of strings in which vowels are never together is the same as the difference
between the total number of strings and the number of strings in which vowels are together is
40320 − 2880 = 37440.
Example 4.31 There are 15 candidates for an examination. 7 candidates are appearing for
mathematics examination while the remaining 8 are appearing for different subjects. In how many
ways can they be seated in a row so that no two mathematics candidates are together?
Solution:
Let us arrange the 8-non-mathematics candidates in 8 P8 = 8! ways. Each of these arrangements
create 9 gaps. Therefore, the 7 mathematics candidates can be placed in these 9 gaps in 9 P7 ways.
9 9! 8! × 9!
8! × P7 = 8! × = .
2! 2!
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.32 In how many ways 5 boys and 4 girls can be seated in a row so that no two girls are
together.
Solution:
The 5 boys can be seated in the row in 5 P5 = 5! ways. In each of these arrangements 6 gaps are
created. Since no two girls are to sit together, we may arrange 4 girls in this 6 gaps. This can be
done in 6 P4 ways. Hence, the total number of seating arrangements is
6
5! × P4 = 120 × 360 = 43200.
Example 4.33 4 boys and 4 girls form a line with the boys and girls alternating. Find the number
of ways of making this line.
Solution:
4 boys can be arranged in a line in 4 P4 = 4! ways. By keeping boys as first in each of these
arrangements, 4 gaps are created. In these 4 gaps, 4 girls can be arranged in 4 P4 = 4! ways.
Therefore, keeping boys as first, the total number of arrangements are 4! × 4!. Similarly, keeping
girls as first, by a similar argument, the total number of arrangements are 4! × 4!. Hence, by the rule
of sum, keeping either a boy or a girl first, the total number of arrangements are
Example 4.34 A van has 8 seats. It has two seats in the front with two rows of three seats behind.
The van belongs to a family, consisting of seven members, F, M, S1 , S2 , S3 ,
D1 , D2 . How many ways can the family sit in the van if
(i) There are no restriction?
(ii) Either F or M drives the van?
(iii) D1 , D2 sits next to a window and F is driving?
Solution:
(i) As there 8 seats to be occupied out of which one seat is for the one who drives. Since there
are no restrictions any one can drive the van. Hence the number of ways of occupying the
driver seat is 7 P1 = 7 ways . The number of ways of occupying the remaining 7 seats by the
remaining 6 people is 7 P6 = 5040. Hence the total number of ways the family can be seated
in the car is 7 × 5040 = 35280.
(ii) As the driver seat can be occupied by only F or M, there are only two ways it can be occupied.
Hence the total number of ways the family can be seated in the car is 2 × 5040 = 10080.
(iii) As there are only 5 window seats available for D1 &D2 to occupy the number of ways of
seated near the windows by the two family members is 5 P2 = 20. As the driver seat is
occupied by F, the remaining 4 people can be seated in the available 5 seats in 5 P4 = 120.
Hence the total number of ways the family can be seated in the car is
20 × 1 × 120 = 2400.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
To understand the next problem we now define, The Rank of a word in the dictionary.
It is the place at which the given word comes when writing all the strings formed by the letters of the
given word in the dictionary order or lexicographic order.
Example 4.35 If the letters of the word TABLE are permuted in all possible ways and the words
thus formed are arranged in the dictionary order (alphabetical order), find the ranks of the words
(i) TABLE, (ii) BLEAT
Solution:
The dictionary order of the letters of given word is A, B, E, L, T. In the dictionary order of the words
which begin with A come first. If we fill the first place with A, remaining 4 letters (B, E, L, T) can
be arranged in 4! ways. On proceeding like this we get
(i) The rank of the word TABLE
A − − − − = 4! = 24 ways
B − − − − = 4! = 24 ways
E − − − − = 4! = 24 ways
L − − − − = 4! = 24 ways
T ABEL = 1 way
T ABLE = 1 way
The rank of the word TABLE is 4 × 4! + 1 + 1 = 98.
A − − − − = 4! = 24 ways
BA − −− = 3! = 6 ways
BE − −− = 3! = 6 ways
BLA − − = 2! = 2 ways
BLEAT = 1 way
E1 JE2 ,
E2 JE1 EJE
E1 E2 J,
E 2 E1 J EEJ
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
It is because of the two E1 , E2 permuted internally will give rise to the same permutations. Since they
3!
are same, the required number of permutations is = 3.
2!
Theorem 4.4: The number of permutations of n objects, where p objects are of the same kind and
n!
rest are all different is .
p!
Generally, the number of permutations of n objects, where p1 objects are of one kind, p2 objects are
n!
of second kind, · · · pk , are of k th kind and the rest of it are of different kind is .
p1 ! × p2 ! × · · · × pk !
Example 4.36 Find the number of ways of arranging the letters of the word BANANA.
Solution:
This word has 6 letters in which there are 3 A’S, 2 N’s and one B. The number of ways of
6!
arrangements is = 60.
3! × 2!
Example 4.37 Find the number of ways of arranging the letters of the word
RAMANUJAN so that the relative positions of vowels and consonants are not changed.
Solution:
In the word RAMANUJAN there are 4 vowels (A,A,U,A)in that 3 A’s, 1 U and 5 consonants
(R,M,N,J,N) in that two N’s and rest are distinct. The 4 vowels (A,A,A,U) can be arranged
themselves in 4!
3!
= 4 ways. The 5 consonants (R,M,N,J,N) can be arranged themselves in 5!
2!
= 60
4! 5!
ways. Therefore the number of required arrangements are 3! × 2! = 4 × 60 = 240.
Example 4.38 Three twins pose for a photograph standing in a line. How many arrangements are
there (i). when there are no restrictions. (ii). when each person is standing next to his or her twin?
Solution:
(i) The six persons without any restriction may be arranged in 6 P6 = 6! = 720 ways.
(ii) Let us consider three twins as T1 , T2 , T3 . Each twin is considered as a single unit and these
three can be permuted in 3! ways. Again each twin can be permuted between themselves in
2! ways. Hence, the total number of arrangements is 3! × 2! × 2! × 2! = 48 ways.
Example 4.39 How many numbers can be formed using the digits 1,2,3,4,2,1 such that, even digits
occupies even place?
Solution:
There are 6 places in that there are 3 even places we have 2,4,2 as even numbers. The number of
3!
ways of permuting 2,4,2 in the 3 even places in 2! = 3 ways. The remaining numbers 1,3,1 can
3!
be permuted in the remaining 3 places in 2! = 3 ways. Hence, the required number of numbers is
3 × 3 = 9.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.40 How many paths are there from start to end on a 6 × 4 grid as shown in the picture?
How Many Paths?
End
Start
Figure 4.15
Solution:
Note that any such path comprises 6 horizontal unit lengths and 4 vertical unit lengths. This each
path consists of 10 unit lengths where 6 are of one kind (horizontal) and 4 are of another kind
(vertical).
10!
Thus the total number of paths is = 210.
4! × 6!
Example 4.41 If the different permutations of all letters of the word BHASKARA are listed as in
a dictionary, how many strings are there in this list before the first word starting with B?
Solution:
The required number of strings is the total number of strings starting with A and using the letters
7!
A,A,B,H,K,R,S is = 2520.
2!
Example 4.42 If the letters of the word IITJEE are permuted in all possible ways and the strings
thus formed are arranged in the lexicographic order, find the rank of the word IITJEE
Solution:
The lexicographic order of the letters of given word is E, E, I, I, J, T. In the lexicographic order,
the strings which begin with E come first. If we fill the first place with E, remaining 5 letters
5!
(E, I, I, J, T ) can be arranged in ways. On proceeding like this we get,
5! 2!
E − − − −− = = 60 ways
2!
IE − −− = 4! = 24 ways
IIE − −− = 3! = 6 ways
3!
IIJ − −− = = 3 ways
2!
IIT E − − = 2! = 2 ways
IIT JEE = 1 way
Example 4.43 Find the sum of all 4-digit numbers that can be formed using the digits 1, 2, 4, 6, 8.
Solution:
The number of 4-digit numbers that can be formed using the given 5 digits is 5 P4 = 120. We first
find the sum of the digits in the unit place of all these 120 numbers. By filling the 1 in unit place,
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
the remaining three places can be filled with remaining 4 digits in 4 P3 = 24 ways. This means, the
number of 4-digit numbers having 1 in units place is 4 P3 = 24. Similarly, each of the digits 2, 4, 6,
8 appear 24 times in units place. An addition of all these digits gives the sum of all the unit digits
of all 120 numbers. Therefore,
(4 P3 × 1) + (4 P3 × 2) + (4 P3 × 4) + (4 P3 × 6) + (4 P3 × 8)
= 4 P3 × (1 + 2 + 4 + 6 + 8)
= 4 P3 × (sum of the digits)
= 4 P3 × 21.
Similarly, we get the sum of the digits in 10th place as 4 P3 × 21. Since it is in 10th place, its value
is 4 P3 × 21 × 10. Similarly, the values of the sum of the digits in 100th place and 1000th place are
4
P3 × 21 × 100 and 4 P3 × 21 × 1000 respectively. Hence the sum of all the 4 digit numbers formed
by using the digits 1, 2, 4, 6, 8 is
(4 P3 × 21) + (4 P3 × 21 × 10) + (4 P3 × 21 × 100) + (4 P3 × 21 × 1000)
= 4 P3 (21 × 1111)
= 24 × 21 × 1111
= 559944.
Deduction 4.1: The sum of all r-digit numbers that can be formed using the given n non zero digits
is (n−1) P(r−1) × (sum of the digits) × 111 · · · 1(r times)
Deduction 4.2: If 0 is one digit among the given n digits, then we get that the sum of the r-digits
numbers that can be formed using the given n digits (including 0) is
{(n−1) P(r−1) × (sum of the digits) × 111 · · · 1(r times)} −
{(n−2) P(r−2) × (sum of the digits) × 111 · · · 1((r-1) times)}.
Permutation as Function
Permutation on any finite set Sn = {x1 , x2 , x3 , · · · , xn } is a bijective function from Sn → Sn .
Therefore the set of all permutations on a finite set with n elements is the same as the total
number of bijective functions on the set. This is precisely n!. Hence the study of permutation is
the same as the study of the bijective mappings on the set. Few representations for a permutation
on S3 are given by
A B C A B C A B C
, , ,···
B C A C A B C B A
Exercise - 4.2
1. If (n−1) P3 :n P4 = 1 : 10, find n.
2. If 10 Pr−1 = 2 ×6 Pr , find r.
3. (i) Suppose 8 people enter an event in a swimming meet. In how many ways could the gold,
silver and bronze prizes be awarded?
(ii) Three men have 4 coats, 5 waist coats and 6 caps. In how many ways can they wear them?
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
4. Determine the number of permutations of the letters of the word SIMPLE if all are taken at a time?
5. A test consists of 10 multiple choice questions. In how many ways can the test be answered if
(i) Each question has four choices?
(ii) The first four questions have three choices and the remaining have five choices?
(iii) Question number n has n + 1 choices?
6. A student appears in an objective test which contain 5 multiple choice questions. Each question
has four choices out of which one correct answer.
(i) What is the maximum number of different answers can the students give?
(ii) How will the answer change if each question may have more than one correct answers?
7. How many strings can be formed from the letters of the word ARTICLE, so that vowels occupy
the even places?
8. 8 women and 6 men are standing in a line.
(i) How many arrangements are possible if any individual can stand in any position?
(ii) In how many arrangements will all 6 men be standing next to one another?
(iii) In how many arrangements will no two men be standing next to one another?
9. Find the distinct permutations of the letters of the word MISSISSIPPI?
10. How many ways can the product a2 b3 c4 be expressed without exponents?
11. In how many ways 4 mathematics books, 3 physics books, 2 chemistry books and 1 biology book
can be arranged on a shelf so that all books of the same subjects are together.
12. In how many ways can the letters of the word SUCCESS be arranged so that all Ss are together?
13. A coin is tossed 8 times,
(i) How many different sequences of heads and tails are possible?
(ii) How many different sequences containing six heads and two tails are possible?
14. How many strings are there using the letters of the word INTERMEDIATE, if
(i) The vowels and consonants are alternative (ii) All the vowels are together
(iii) Vowels are never together (iv) No two vowels are together.
15. Each of the digits 1, 1, 2, 3, 3 and 4 is written on a separate card. The six cards are then laid out
in a row to form a 6-digit number.
(i) How many distinct 6-digit numbers are there?
(ii) How many of these 6-digit numbers are even?
(iii) How many of these 6-digit numbers are divisible by 4?
16. If the letters of the word GARDEN are permuted in all possible ways and the strings thus formed
are arranged in the dictionary order, then find the ranks of the words (i) GARDEN (ii) DANGER.
17. Find the number of strings that can be made using all letters of the word THING. If these words
are written as in a dictionary, what will be the 85th string?
18. If the letters of the word FUNNY are permuted in all possible ways and the strings thus formed
are arranged in the dictionary order, find the rank of the word FUNNY.
19. Find the sum of all 4-digit numbers that can be formed using digits 1, 2, 3, 4, and 5 repetitions not
allowed?
20. Find the sum of all 4-digit numbers that can be formed using digits 0, 2, 5, 7, 8 without repetition?
4.5 Combinations
Let us suppose there are four persons A, B, C and D (actual names may be used here) and we have
to select three of them to be a part of a committee. In how many ways can we make this selection?
For example, A, B, C is one possible choice. Here the order of selection is immaterial. Thus A, B, C
is the same as B, A, C or C, A, B as long as the same three persons are selected. Thus the possible
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
In general, this leads to an important relationship between permutations and combinations as,
n
Pr =n Cr × r!.
Normally for any reader there may be a confusion between permutation and combination. The
following table with an example may be helpful in clearing the confusion.
Theorem 4.5: The number of combinations of n distinct objects taken r at a time is given by
n n!
Cr = , 0 ≤ r ≤ n.
r!(n − r)!
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
In view of,
n n! n!
Cn−r = = =n Cr ,
(n − r)!(n − (n − r))! (n − r)!r!
we have,
Property 2:
n
Cr =n Cn−r .
n n! n!
Cr +n Cr−1 = +
r!.(n − r)! (r − 1)!.(n − (r − 1))!
n! n!
= +
r! × (n − r)! (r − 1)! × (n − r + 1)!
n! n!
= +
r.(r − 1)! × (n − r)! (r − 1)!.(n − r)!(n − r + 1)
n! 1 1
= × +
(r − 1)! × (n − r)! r (n − r + 1)
n! (n − r + 1 + r)
= ×
(r − 1)! × (n − r)! r(n − r + 1)
n! (n + 1)
= ×
(r − 1)! × (n − r)! r(n − r + 1)
(n + 1)!
= =n+1 Cr .
r! × (n + 1 − r)!
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Property 5:
n n (n−1)
Cr = × C(r−1) .
r
Proof.
n (n−1) n (n − 1)!
× C(r−1) =
r r (r − 1)! × ((n − 1) − (r − 1))!
n(n − 1)!
= =n C r
r(r − 1)!(n − r)!
Example 4.44 Evaluate the following: (i) 10 C3 (ii) 15 C13 (iii) 100 C99 (iv) 50 C50 .
Solution:
(i) 10 10! 10 × 9 × 8 × 7!
C3 = =
7! × 3! 7! × 3 × 2 × 1
10 × 9 × 8
= = 120
3×2×1
(ii) 15 15! 15 × 14 × 13!
C13 = =
2! × 13! 2 × 1 × 13!
15 × 14
= = 105
2×1
(iii)
100 100 × 99!
C99 = = 100
99!
(iv)
50 50!
C50 = = 1.
50! × 0!
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Therefore,
n × (n − 1) × (n − 2) × (n − 3)
= 495
4×3×2×1
=⇒ n × (n − 1) × (n − 2) × (n − 3) = 495 × 4 × 3 × 2 × 1
Factoring 495 = 3 × 3 × 5 × 11, and writing this product as a product of 4 consecutive numbers in
the descending order we get, n × (n − 1) × (n − 2) × (n − 3) = 12 × 11 × 10 × 9. Equating n with
the maximum number, we obtain n = 12.
Therefore,
11880
r! = = 24 = 4!,
495
gives r = 4. Using this r = 4, in n c4 = 495, and applying the result of the Example (4.46) we get,
n = 12.
4
X
24 (28−r)
Example 4.48 Prove that C4 + C3 =29 C4
r=0
Solution:
4
X
24 (28−r) 24
C4 + C3 = C4 +28 C3 +27 C3 +26 C3 +25 C3 +24 C3
r=0
24
= C4 +24 C3 +25 C3 +26 C3 +27 C3 +28 C3
25
= C4 +25 C3 +26 C3 +27 C3 +28 C3
26
= C4 +26 C3 +27 C3 +28 C3
27
= C4 +27 C3 +28 C3
28
= C4 +28 C3
29
= C4
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.51 A salad at a certain restaurant consists of 4 of the following fruits: apple, banana,
guava, pomegranate, grapes, papaya and pineapple. Find the total possible number of fruit salads.
Solution:
There are seven fruits and we have to select four fruits for the fruit salad. Hence, the total number
of possible ways of making a fruit salad is 7 C4 =7 C3 = 35.
Example 4.52 A Mathematics club has 15 members. In that 8 are girls. 6 of the members are to be
selected for a competition and half of them should be girls. How many ways of these selections are
possible?
Solution:
There are 8 girls and 7 boys in the mathematics club. The number of ways of selecting 6 members
in that half of them girls (3 girls and 3 others) is 8 C3 ×7 C3 = 56 × 35 = 1960.
Example 4.53 In rating 20 brands of cars, a car magazine picks a first, second, third, fourth and
fifth best brand and then 7 more as acceptable. In how many ways can it be done?
Solution:
The picking of 5 brands for a first, second, third, fourth and fifth best brand from 20 brands in 20 P5
ways. From the remaining 15 we need to select 7 acceptable in 15 C7 ways. By the rule of product it
can be done in 20 P5 ×15 C7 ways.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.54 From a class of 25 students, 10 students are to be chosen for an excursion party.
There are 4 students who decide that either all of them will join or none of them will join. In how
many ways can the excursion party be chosen?
Solution:
There are two possibilities (i) All the 4 students will got to the excursion party then, we need to
21!
select 6 students out of 21 students. It can be done in 21 C6 = ways.
6! × 15!
(ii) All the 4 students will not go to the excursion party then, we need to select 10 students out
21!
of 21 students. It can be done in 21 C10 = . Hence, the total number of ways is
10! × 11!
21 21! 21!
C6 +21 C10 = + .
6! × 15! 10! × 11!
Example 4.55 A box of one dozen apple contains a rotten apple. If we are choosing 3 apples
simultaneously, in how many ways, one can get only good apples.
Solution:
The total number of ways of selecting 3 apples from 12 apples is 12 C3 = 220.
The total number of ways of getting a rotten apple when selecting 3 apples from 12 apples is
equal to selecting 1 rotten apple and remaining 2 apples can be selected from 11 apples is 11 C2 = 55.
Therefore, the total number of ways of getting only good apples is
12
C3 − 11 C2 = 220 − 55 = 165
Example 4.56 An exam paper contains 8 questions, 4 in Part A and 4 in Part B. Examiners are
required to answer 5 questions. In how many ways can this be done if
(i) There are no restrictions of choosing a number of questions in either parts.
(ii) At least two questions from Part A must be answered.
Solution:
(i) There are no restrictions. Totally there are 8 questions in both Part A and Part B. The total
number of ways of attempting 5 questions from 8 questions is 8 C5 = 8 C3 = 56.
(ii) At least two questions from Part A needs to be answered.Accordingly, various choices
are tabulated as follows.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.57 Out of 7 consonants and 4 vowels, how many strings of 3 consonants and 2 vowels
can be formed?
Solution:
Number of ways of selecting (3 consonants out of 7) and (2 vowels out of 4) is
7
C3 ×4 C2
Each string contains 5 letters. Number of ways of arranging 5 letters among themselves is 5! = 120
Hence required number of ways is,
7
C3 ×4 C2 × 5! = 35 × 6 × 120 = 25200
.
Example 4.58 Find the number of strings of 5 letters that can be formed with the letters of the word
PROPOSITION.
Solution:
There are 11 letters in the word, with respect to number of repetitions of letters there are 4 distinct
letters (R, S, T, N), 2 sets of two alike letters (PP,II), 1 set of three alike letters (OOO). The
following table will illustrate the combination of these sets and the number of words
Hence, the total number of strings are 2520 + 20 + 300 + 450 + 3600 = 6890.
Example 4.59 If a set of m parallel lines intersect another set of n parallel lines (not parallel to the
lines in the first set), then find the number of parallelograms formed in this lattice structure.
Solution:
Whenever we select 2 lines from the first set of m lines and 2 lines from the second set of n lines,
one parallelogram is formed. Thus the number of parallelograms formed is m C2 ×n C2 .
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.60 How many diagonals are there in a polygon with n sides?
Solution:
A polygon of n sides has n vertices. By joining any two vertices of a polygon, we obtain either a
side or a diagonal of the polygon. Number of line segments obtained by joining the vertices of a
n(n − 1)
n sided polygon taken two at a time is n C2 = . Out of these lines, there are n sides of
2
polygon. Therefore, number of diagonals of the polygon is
n(n − 1) n(n − 3)
−n= .
2 2
5(5−3)
In particular for a pentagon and heptagon (Septagon), number of diagonals respectively are 2
=
5 and 7(7−3)
2
= 14.
Exercise - 4.3
1. If n C12 =n C9 find 21 Cn .
9. (i) A Kabaddi coach has 14 players ready to play. How many different teams of 7 players could
the coach put on the court?
(ii) There are 15 persons in a party and if each 2 of them shakes hands with each other, how
many handshakes happen in the party?
(iii) How many chords can be drawn through 20 points on a circle?
(iv) In a parking lot one hundred , one year old cars, are parked. Out of them five are to be
chosen at random for to check its pollution devices. How many different set of five cars can
be chosen?
(v) How many ways can a team of 3 boys,2 girls and 1 transgender be selected from 5 boys, 4
girls and 2 transgenders?
10. Find the total number of subsets of a set with
[Hint: n C0 +n C1 +n C2 + · · · +n Cn = 2n ]
(i) 4 elements (ii) 5 elements (iii) n elements.
11. A trust has 25 members.
(i) How many ways 3 officers can be selected?
(ii) In how many ways can a President, Vice President and a Secretary be selected?
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
12. How many ways a committee of six persons from 10 persons can be chosen along with a chair
person and a secretary?
13. How many different selections of 5 books can be made from 12 different books if,
(i) Two particular books are always selected?
(ii) Two particular books are never selected?
14. There are 5 teachers and 20 students. Out of them a committee of 2 teachers and 3 students is to
be formed. Find the number of ways in which this can be done. Further find in how many of these
committees
(i) a particular teacher is included?
(ii) a particular student is excluded?
15. In an examination a student has to answer 5 questions, out of 9 questions in which 2 are
compulsory. In how many ways a student can answer the questions?
16. Determine the number of 5 card combinations out of a deck of 52 cards if there is exactly three
aces in each combination.
17. Find the number of ways of forming a committee of 5 members out of 7 Indians and 5 Americans,
so that always Indians will be the majority in the committee.
18. A committee of 7 peoples has to be formed from 8 men and 4 women. In how many ways can this
be done when the committee consists of
(i) exactly 3 women?
(ii) at least 3 women?
(iii) at most 3 women?
19. 7 relatives of a man comprises 4 ladies and 3 gentlemen, his wife also has 7 relatives; 3 of them
are ladies and 4 gentlemen. In how many ways can they invite a dinner party of 3 ladies and 3
gentlemen so that there are 3 of man’s relative and 3 of the wife’ s relatives?
20. A box contains two white balls, three black balls and four red balls. In how many ways can three
balls be drawn from the box, if at least one black ball is to be included in the draw?
21. Find the number of strings of 4 letters that can be formed with the letters of the word
EXAMINATION?.
22. How many triangles can be formed by joining 15 points on the plane, in which no line joining any
three points?
23. How many triangles can be formed by 15 points, in which 7 of them lie on one line and the
remaining 8 on another parallel line?
24. There are 11 points in a plane. No three of these lies in the same straight line except 4 points,
which are collinear. Find,
(i) the number of straight lines that can be obtained from the pairs of these points?
(ii) the number of triangles that can be formed for which the points are their vertices?
25. A polygon has 90 diagonals. Find the number of its sides?
1 = 1
1+3 = 4
1+3+5 = 9
1+3+5+7 = 16
1+3+5+7+9 = 25
187 4.6 Mathematical induction
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
and so on. We note that the right hand side of the expressions are the perfect squares 1, 4, 9, 16, 25 · · · .
This pattern compels us to make the conjecture that the sum of the first n odd numbers is equal to n2 .
Symbolically, we express this as,
1 + 3 + 5 + · · · + (2n − 1) = n2 .
However we have only made a conjecture. In order to prove the conjecture we shall use the Principle
of Mathematical Induction. Mathematical Induction is a method or technique of proving mathematical
results or theorems of the above kind. This technique relies upon making conjectures by observing all
possible cases of a specific result. It is well suited for proving results in algebra or in other disciplines
of mathematics where results or theorems are stated in terms of n, n being a positive integer. The
process of Mathematical Induction may be compared to that of climbing an infinite staircase.
In order to ensure that we complete the climb, it is sufficient to ensure the following.
(a) We can climb the first step.
(b) Once we have reached a particular step of the staircase, we can climb to the next step.
Being sure of (a) and (b) will enable us to climb all the steps in the staircase. Similarly, when we apply
this method to prove a mathematical statement P (n), the process of induction involves the following
steps.
Figure 4.16
Step 1: Verify that the statement is true for n = 1, that is, verify that P(1) is true. This is akin to
climbing the first step of the staircase and is referred to as the initial step.
Step 2: Verify that the statement is true for n = k + 1 whenever it is true for n = k, where k
is a positive integer. This means that we need to prove that P (k + 1) is true whenever
P (k) is true. This is referred to as the inductive step.
Step 3: If steps 1 and 2 have been established then the statement P (n) is true for all positive
integers n.
One of the interesting method of proof in Mathematics is by the Mathematical induction. We shall
illustrate the method through problems. As an illustration of the process let us revisit a well known
result through an example below:
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.61 By the principle of mathematical induction, prove that, for all integers n ≥ 1,
n(n + 1)
1 + 2 + 3 + ··· + n = .
2
Solution:
Let,
n(n + 1)
P (n) := 1 + 2 + 3 + · · · + n = .
2
1(1 + 1)
Substituting the value of n = 1, in the statement we get, P (1) = = 1. Hence, P (1) is
2
true.
Let us assume that the statement is true for n = k. Then
k(k + 1)
P (k) = 1 + 2 + 3 + ... + k = .
2
We need to show that P (k + 1) is true. Consider,
k(k + 1)
P (k + 1) = |1 + 2 + 3{z+ · · · + k} +(k + 1) = + (k + 1).
2
That is,
k(k + 1) + 2(k + 1) (k + 1)(k + 2)
P (k + 1) = = .
2 2
This implies, P (k + 1) is true. The validity of P (k + 1) follows from that of P (k). Therefore by
the principle of mathematical induction, for all integers n ≥ 1,
n(n + 1)
1 + 2 + 3 + ··· + n = .
2
Example 4.62 Prove that the sum of first n positive odd numbers is n2 .
Solution:
Let P (n) = 1 + 3 + 5 + · · · + (2n − 1) . Therefore P (1) = 1 = 12 is true.
We assume that P (k) = 1 + 3 + 5 + ...(2k − 1) is true for n = k. That is P (k) = k 2
We need to prove P (k + 1) = (k + 1)2 .
P (k + 1) = 1 + 3 + 5 + ...(2(k + 1) − 1)
= 1 + 3 + 5 + 7 + ... + (2k − 1) +2k + 1
| {z }
= P (k) + 2k + 1
= k 2 + 2k + 1 = (k + 1)2
This implies, P (k + 1) is true. Hence, by the principle of mathematical induction, P (n) is true for
all natural numbers.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 4.63 By the principle of mathematical induction, prove that, for all integers n ≥ 1,
n(n + 1)(2n + 1)
12 + 22 + 32 + · · · + n2 = .
6
Solution:
Let,
n(n + 1)(2n + 1)
P (n) := 12 + 22 + 32 + · · · + n2 = .
6
1(1 + 1)(2(1) + 1)
Substituting n = 1 in the statement we get, P (1) = = 1 . Hence, P (1) is true.
6
Let us assume that the statement is true for n = k. Then
k(k + 1)(2k + 1)
P (k) = 12 + 22 + 32 + · · · + k 2 = .
6
We need to show that P (k + 1) is true. Consider
P (k + 1) = 1| 2 + 22 + 3{z
2
+ · · · + k}2 +(k + 1)2
= P (k) + (k + 1)2
k(k + 1)(2k + 1)
= + (k + 1)2
6
k(k + 1)(2k + 1) + 6(k + 1)2
=
6
(k + 1) (k(2k + 1) + 6(k + 1))
=
6
(k + 1) (2k 2 + 7k + 6)
=
6
(k + 1) [(k + 2)(2k + 3)]
=
6
(k + 1) [((k + 1) + 1)(2(k + 1) + 1)]
= .
6
That is,
(k + 1)((k + 1) + 1) (2(k + 1) + 1)
P (k + 1) = .
6
This implies, P (k + 1) is true. The validity of P (k + 1) follows from that of P (k). Therefore by
the principle of mathematical induction,
n(n + 1)(2n + 1)
12 + 22 + 32 + · · · + n2 = , for all n ≥ 1.
6
Example 4.64 Using the Mathematical induction, show that for any natural number n,
1 1 1 1 n
+ + + ··· + = .
1.2 2.3 3.4 n(n + 1) n+1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Solution:
1 1 1 1 n
Let P (n) := + + + ··· + = . Substituting the value of n = 1, in the
1.2 2.3 3.4 n(n + 1) n+1
1 1
statement we get, P (1) = = . Hence, P (1) is true. Let us assume that the statement is true
1.2 2
for n = k. Then
1 1 1 1 k
P (k) = + + + ··· + = .
1.2 2.3 3.4 k(k + 1) k+1
We need to show that P (k + 1) is true. Consider,
1 1 1 1 1
P (k + 1) = + + + ··· + +
1.2 2.3 3.4 k(k + 1) (k + 1)(k + 2)
| {z }
1
= P (k) +
(k + 1)(k + 2)
k 1
= +
(k + 1) (k + 1)(k + 2)
1 k 1
= +
k+1 1 k+2
2
1 k + 2k + 1
=
k+1 k+2
(k + 1)2
1 (k + 1)
= = .
k+1 k+2 (k + 2)
This implies, P (k + 1) is true. The validity of P (k + 1) follows from that of P (k). Therefore, by
the principle of mathematical induction, for any natural number n,
1 1 1 1 n
+ + + ··· + = .
1.2 2.3 3.4 n(n + 1) n+1
Example 4.65 Prove that for any natural number n, an − bn is divisible by a − b, where a > b
Solution:
Let
P (n) := an − bn , is divisible by a − b.
Substituting the value of n = 1, in the statement we get,
P (1) = a − b,
which is divisible by a − b. Hence, P (1) is true. Let us assume that the statement is true for n = k.
Then P (k) = ak − bk , is divisible by a − b. We can write
P (k) = ak − bk = λ(a − b), λ ∈ N.
We need to show that P (k + 1) = ak+1 − bk+1 , is divisible by a − b.
P (k + 1) = ak+1 − bk+1
= ak+1 − abk + abk − bk+1
= a(ak − bk ) + bk (a − b)
= a(λ(a − b)) + bk (a − b)
(a − b) aλ + bk
=
= (a − b)λ1 , λ1 = aλ + bk , λ1 ∈ N.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
which is divisible by a − b. This implies that P (k + 1) is true. The validity of P (k + 1) follows from
that of P (k). Therefore by the principle of mathematical induction, an − bn is divisible by a − b,
where a > b, for all natural numbers n.
which is divisible by 8. Hence, P (1) is true. Let us assume that the statement is true for n = k.
Then P (k) = 32k+2 − 8k − 9, is divisible by 8. We can write
P (k + 1) = 32(k+1)+2 − 8(k + 1) − 9
= 32 32k+2 − 8k − 8 − 9
= 32 (8k1 + 8k + 9) − 8k − 17
= 72k1 + 64k + 64
= 8 (9k1 + 8k + 1)
= 8k2 , k2 = 9k1 + 8k + 1 ∈ N
which is divisible by 8. This implies that P (k + 1) is true. This means that the validity of P (k + 1)
follows from that of P (k). Therefore by the principle of mathematical induction, 32n+2 − 8n − 9 is
divisible by 8 for all n ≥ 1.
Example 4.67 Using the Mathematical induction, show that for any integer
Solution:
Let P (n) be the statement that 3n2 > (n + 1)2 with n ≥ 2. Therefore the first stage is n = 2.
Now, P (2) = 3 × 22 = 12 and 32 = 9. As 12 > 9 we get P (2) is true.
We assume that P (n) is true for n = k.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Now,
P (k + 1) = 3(k + 1)2 = 3k 2 + 6k + 3
= P (k) + 6k + 3
> (k + 1)2 + 6k + 3
= k 2 + 8k + 4
= k 2 + 4k + 4 + 4k
= (k + 2)2 + 4k
> (k + 2)2 since k > 0.
This is the statement P (k + 1). The validity of P (k + 1) follows from that of P (k). Therefore by
the principle of mathematical induction, for all n ≥ 2, 3n2 > (n + 1)2 .
Example 4.68 Using the Mathematical induction, show that for any integer
n ≥ 2, 3n > n2
Solution:
Let P (n) be the statement that 3n > n2 with n ≥ 2. Therefore the first stage is n = 2. Now,
P (2) = 32 = 9 and 22 = 4. As 9 > 4, we get P (2) is true
We assume that P (n) is true for n = k. That is P (k) > k 2 . Now,
P (k + 1) = 3k+1 = 3 × 3k = 3 × P (k)
> 3k 2
> (k + 1)2 , by Example 4.67.
Solution:
Let P (n) := cos(α) + cos(α + β) + cos(α + 2β) + ... + cos(α + (n − 1)β). Then,
cos(α). sin( β2 )
P (1) = cos(α) = ,
sin( β2 )
which shows P (1) is true. We now assume that P (n) is true for n = k. That is,
kβ
(k − 1)β sin 2
cos(α) + cos(α + β) + cos(α + 2β) + · · · + cos(α + (k − 1)β) = cos α + × β
.
2 sin 2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Then,
P (k + 1) = P (k) + cos(α + kβ)
cos α + (k−1)β sin kβ
2 2
= + cos(α + kβ)
β
sin( )
2
1 (k − 1)β kβ β
= β
cos α + sin + cos(α + kβ) sin
sin( 2 ) 2 2 2
1 kβ β kβ β
= β
cos α+ − sin + cos(α + kβ) sin
sin( 2 ) 2 2 2 2
1 kβ β
= β
cos α + cos
sin 2 2 2
kβ β kβ β
+ sin α + sin sin + cos(α + kβ) sin
2 2 2 2
1 kβ β kβ
= β
cos α + cos sin
sin 2 2 2 2
β kβ kβ
+ sin sin α + sin + cos(α + kβ)
2 2 2
1 kβ β kβ
= β
cos α + cos sin
sin 2 2 2 2
#
sin β2
kβ kβ
+ 2 sin α + sin + 2 cos(α + kβ)
2 2 2
1 kβ β kβ
= β
cos α + cos sin
sin 2 2 2 2
#
sin β2
+ (cos α − cos (α + kβ) + 2 cos(α + kβ))
2
" #
sin β2
1 kβ β kβ
= cos α + cos sin + (cos α + cos(α + kβ))
sin β2 2 2 2 2
" #
sin β2
1 kβ β kβ kβ −kβ
= cos α + cos sin + 2 cos α + cos
sin β2 2 2 2 2 2 2
cos α + kβ
2 kβ β β kβ
= sin cos + sin cos
sin β2
2 2 2 2
cos α + kβ sin (k+1)β
2 2
= β
sin 2
That is,
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
This implies that P (k + 1) is true. The validity of P (k + 1) follows from that of P (k). Therefore
by the principle of mathematical induction,
Example 4.70 Using the Mathematical induction, show that for any natural number n, with the
assumption i2 = −1,
(r(cos θ + i sin θ))n = rn (cos nθ + i sin nθ) ,
Solution:
Let,
P (n) = (r(cos θ + i sin θ)n = rn (cos nθ + i sin nθ) .
Hence, P (1) is true. Let us assume that the statement is true for n = k. Then
This implies that P (k + 1) is true. The validity of P (k + 1) follows from that of P (k). Therefore
by the principle of mathematical induction, for any natural number n,
What we have proved in Example 4.70 is called the Demoivre’s theorem for natural
numbers, which will be studied in detail in the second year of Higher Secondary course.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 4.4
1. By the principle of mathematical induction, prove that, for n ≥ 1
2
3 3 3 3 n(n + 1)
1 + 2 + 3 + ··· + n =
2
n(2n − 1)(2n + 1)
12 + 32 + 52 + · · · + (2n − 1)2 = .
3
n(n + 1)(n + 2)
1.2 + 2.3 + 3.4 + · · · + n.(n + 1) = .
3
5. Using the Mathematical induction, show that for any natural number n ≥ 2,
1 1 1 1 n+1
1− 2 1− 2 1 − 2 ··· 1 − 2 = .
2 3 4 n 2n
6. Using the Mathematical induction, show that for any natural number n ≥ 2,
1 1 1 1 n−1
+ + + ··· + = .
1+2 1+2+3 1+2+3+4 1 + 2 + 3 + ··· + n n+1
7. Using the Mathematical induction, show that for any natural number n,
1 1 1 1 n(n + 3)
+ + + ··· + = .
1.2.3 2.3.4 3.4.5 n.(n + 1).(n + 2) 4(n + 1)(n + 2)
8. Using the Mathematical induction, show that for any natural number n,
1 1 1 1 n
+ + + ··· + = .
2.5 5.8 8.11 (3n − 1)(3n + 2) 6n + 4
10. Using the Mathematical induction, show that for any natural number n, x2n − y 2n is divisible by
x + y.
11. By the principle of Mathematical induction, prove that, for n ≥ 1
n3
12 + 22 + 32 + · · · + n2 > .
3
12. Use induction to prove that n3 − 7n + 3, is divisible by 3, for all natural numbers n.
13. Use induction to prove that 5n+1 + 4 × 6n when divided by 20 leaves a remainder 9, for all natural
numbers n.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
14. Use induction to prove that 10n + 3 × 4n+2 + 5, is divisible by 9, for all natural numbers n.
15. Prove that using the Mathematical induction
π 2π
sin(α) + sin α + + sin α + + ···
6 6
sin α + (n−1)π × sin nπ
(n − 1)π 12
12 .
+ sin α + = π
6 sin 12
Exercise - 4.5
Choose the correct or the most suitable answer
1. The sum of the digits at the 10th place of all numbers formed with the help of 2, 4, 5, 7 taken all
at a time is
(1) 432 (2) 108 (3) 36 (4) 18
2. In an examination there are three multiple choice questions and each question has 5 choices .
Number of ways in which a student can fail to get all answer correct is
(1) 125 (2) 124 (3) 64 (4) 63
3. The number of ways in which the following prize be given to a class of 30 boys first and second in
mathematics, first and second in physics, first in chemistry and first in English is
(1) 304 × 292 (2) 303 × 293 (3) 302 × 294 (4) 30 × 295 .
4. The number of 5 digit numbers all digits of which are odd is
(1) 25 (2) 55 (3) 56 (4) 625.
5. In 3 fingers, the number of ways four rings can be worn is · · · · · · · · · ways.
(1) 43 − 1 (2) 34 (3) 68 (4) 64
(n+5) 11(n−1) (n+3)
6. If P(n+1) = ( 2 ) Pn , then the value of n are
(1) 7 and 11 (2) 6 and 7 (3) 2 and 11 (4) 2 and 6.
7. The product of r consecutive positive integers is divisible by
(1) r! (2) (r − 1)! (3) (r + 1)! (4) rr .
8. The number of five digit telephone numbers having at least one of their digits repeated is
(1) 90000 (2) 10000 (3) 30240 (4) 69760.
a2 −a a2 −a
9. If C2 = C4 then the value of ’a’ is
(1) 2 (2) 3 (3) 4 (4) 5
10. There are 10 points in a plane and 4 of them are collinear. The number of straight lines joining any
two points is
(1) 45 (2) 40 (3) 39 (4) 38.
11. The number of ways in which a host lady invite 8 people for a party of 8 out of 12 people of whom
two do not want to attend the party together is
(1) 2 ×11 C7 +10 C8 (2) 11
C7 +10 C8 (3) 12
C8 −10 C6 (4) 10
C6 + 2!.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
12. The number of parallelograms that can be formed from a set of four parallel lines intersecting
another set of three parallel lines.
(1) 6 (2) 9 (3) 12 (4) 18
13. Everybody in a room shakes hands with everybody else. The total number of shake hands is 66.
The number of persons in the room is · · · · · · · · · · · ·
(1) 11 (2) 12 (3) 10 (4) 6
14. Number of sides of a polygon having 44 diagonals is · · · · · ·
(1) 4 (2) 4! (3) 11 (4) 22
15. If 10 lines are drawn in a plane such that no two of them are parallel and no three are concurrent,
then the total number of points of intersection are
(1) 45 (2) 40 (3)10! (4) 210
16. In a plane there are 10 points are there out of which 4 points are collinear, then the number of
triangles formed is
(1) 110 (2) 10 C3 (3) 120 (4) 116
17. In 2n C3 :n C3 = 11 : 1 then n is
(1) 5 (2) 6 (3)11 (4)7
(n−1) (n−1)
18. Cr + C(r−1) is
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Summary
In this chapter, we acquired the knowledge of
• Factorial of a natural number n is the product of the first n natural numbers.
• The number of distinct permutations of r objects which can be made from n distinct objects
is
n n!
Pr = = n(n − 1)(n − 2) · · · (n − r + 1).
(n − r)!
• The number of permutations of n objects taken all at a time where P1 objects one of first
kind, P2 objects one of second kind, · · · Pk objects one of the k th kind and the rest, if any
are all different and is given by
n!
.
P1 !P2 ! · · · Pk !
• Order matters for a permutation where as order does not matter for a combination.
ICT CORNER-4(a)
Expected Outcome ⇒
Step–1: Open the Browser and type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code. GeoGebra
worksheet Permutations and Combination will appear. You can select the worksheet you
want to open, for example open Combination Game
Step–2: Press Instruction button and read how to play. After reading once again press Instruction
button and press Start the game.
Step–3: Find the number of combination to dress up the girl with 3 Shirts and 2 Skirts. After selecting
each pair, click on Camera picture, so that the selected will appear in right space. After
completing the selection press check button to see the result.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
ICT CORNER-4(b)
Expected Outcome ⇒
Step–1: Open the Browser and type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code.
Step–2: GeoGebra worksheet “Problems on Permutations and Combination” will appear. By clicking
on “New Problem” new question will be generated as many times you want to do. You have
to work out the problem yourself and find the answer. Now click on “Show Solution” on each
Permutation and Combination to get the respective solution and check with your answer.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Binomial Theorem,
Chapter 5 Sequences and Series
“Life stands before me like an eternal spring with new and brilliant clothes”
5.1 Introduction
Binomial theorem facilitates the algebraic expansion of the binomial (a + b) for a positive integral
exponent n. Binomial theorem is used in all branches of Mathematics and also in other Sciences. For
example using the Binomial theorem one can easily find the coefficient of x20 in the expansion of
(2x − 7)23 . If one wants to know the maturity amount after 10 years on a sum of money deposited in
a nationalised bank at the rate of 8% compound interest per year or to know the size of population of
our country after 15 years if the annual growth rate and present population size are known, Binomial
theorem helps us in finding the above quantities. The coefficients in the binomial expansion of (a +
b)n , n ∈ N, are called binomial coefficients. Binomial theorem plays a vital role in determining the
probabilities of events when the random experiment involves finite sample space and each outcome
is either success or failure. In this chapter we learn binomial theorem and some of its applications.
Greek Mathematician Euclid mentioned the special case of binomial theorem for exponent 2.
Binomial theorem for exponent 3 was known by 6th century in India. In 1544, Michael Stifel
(German Mathematician) introduced the term binomial coefficient and expressed (1 + x)n in terms
of (1 + x)n−1 .
The German Mathematician Johann Carl Friedrich Gauss is one of the
most renowned Mathematicians in history. Many have referred to him as
the “Prince of Mathematics ”. He has contributed in the areas of Number
theory, Physics, Astronomy etc., Number Theory was Gauss’s favourite field
and he referred to Number theory as the “Queen of Mathematics”. Anecdote
involves, his school teacher who wanted to test the students asked them to
sum the integers from 1 to 100. Within a few seconds Gauss shown the
answer has 5050. Nobody is sure which method of summing an arithmetic Johann Carl
sequence Gauss used as a child. Friedrich Gauss
(1777–1855)
Over the period of thousand years, legends have developed mathematical problems involving
sequences and series. One of the famous legends about series concerns the invention of chess, where
the cells of chess board were related to 1, 2, 4, 8, . . . (imagine the number related to 64th cell). There
are many applications of arithmetic and geometric progressions to real life situations.
In the earlier classes we have learnt about sequences, series. Roughly speaking a sequence is an
arrangement of objects in some order and a series is the sum of the terms of a sequence of numbers.
9
The concept of infinite series helps us to compute many values, like sin 44 π, log 43 and e20 to a desired
level of approximation. Sequences are important in differential equations and analysis. We learn more
about sequences and series.
202
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Learning Objectives
On completion of this chapter, the students are expected to know
• the concept of Binomial Theorem, to compute binomial coefficients and their applications
• the concepts of sequences and series
• how to compute arithmetic, geometric and harmonic means
• how to find the sum of finite and infinite series of real numbers
• how to add series using telescopic summation
• how to apply binomial, exponential and logarithmic series
Pascal Triangle
The Pascal triangle is an arrangement of the values of n Cr in a triangular form. The (k + 1)st row
consists values of
k
C0 , k C 1 , k C2 , k C3 , . . . , k Ck .
0
C0 1
1 1
C0 C1 1 1
2 2 2
C0 C1 C2 1 2 1
3
C0 3
C1 3
C2 3
C3 ⇔ 1 3 3 1
4 4 4 4 4
C0 C1 C2 C3 C4 1 4 6 4 1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Recall the expansion and observe the coefficients of each term of the identities (a + b)0 , (a + b)1 ,
(a + b)2 , (a + b)3 . There is a pattern in the arrangements of coefficents
(a + b)0 = 1 1
(a + b)1 = a + b 1 1
(a + b)2 = a2 + 2ab + b2 1 2 1
If we observe carefully the Pascal triangle, we may notice that each row starts and ends with 1
and other entries are the sum of the two numbers just above it. For example ‘3’ is the sum of 1 and 2
above it; ‘10’ is the sum of 4 and 6 above it. We will prove in a short while that
which is the binomial expansion of (a + b)n . The binomial expansion of (a + b)n for any n ∈ N can
be written using Pascal triangle. For example, from the fifth row we can write down the expansion of
(a + b)4 and from the sixth row we can write down the expansion of (a + b)5 and so on. We know the
terms (without coefficients) of (a + b)5 are
a5 , a4 b, a3 b2 , a2 b3 , ab4 , b5
1 5 10 10 5 1.
The Pascal triangle can be constructed using addition alone, without using any multiplication or
division. So without multiplication we can write down the binomial expansion for (a + b)n for any
n ∈ N.
The above pattern resembling a triangle, is credited in the name of the seventeenth century French
Mathematician Blaise Pascal, who studied mathematical properties of this structure and used this
concept effectively in Probability Theory.
Proof. We prove the theorem by using mathematical induction. For any positive integer n, let P (n)
be the statement
Since
1 1
C0 = 1 and C1 = 1,
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
the expression in the right hand side of P (1) is a1 b0 + a0 b1 which is same as a + b; the left hand side
is (a + b)1 . Hence P (1) is true.
We assume that for a positive integer k, P (k) is true. That is,
= (a + b) k C0 ak b0 + k C1 ak−1 b1 + · · · + k Cr ak−r br + · · · + k Ck a0 bk
= k C0 ak+1 b0 + k C1 ak b1 + · · · + k Cr ak−r+1 br + · · · + k Ck a1 bk
+ · · · + k Ck + k Ck−1 a1 bk + k Ck a0 bk+1
k+1
= C0 ak+1 b0 + k+1
C1 a k b 1 + k+1
C2 ak−1 b2 + · · · + k+1
Cr ak−r+1 br
k+1
+··· + Ck a 1 b k + k+1
Ck+1 a0 bk+1
(a + b)k+1 = k+1
C0 a(k+1) b0 + k+1
C1 a(k+1)−1 b1 + k+1
C2 a(k+1)−2 b2 + · · ·
+ k+1 Cr a(k+1)−r br + · · · + k+1
Ck a1 b(k+1)−1 + k+1
Ck+1 a0 bk+1 .
This shows that P (k + 1) is true whenever P (k) is true. Thus, by the principle of mathematical
induction, P (n) is true for all natural numbers n. Hence,
(i) The expansion of (a + b)n , n ∈ N can also be written as
Tr+1 = n Cr an−r br , r = 0, 1, 2, · · · , n.
(v) In the product (a + b)(a + b) · · · (a + b), n times, to get br , we need any r factors
out of these n factors. This can be done in n Cr ways. That is why, we have n Cr
as the coefficient of an−r br .
(vi) In the expansion of (a + b)n , n ∈ N, the coefficients at equidistant from the
beginning and from the end are equal due to the fact that n Cr = n Cn−r .
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(a − b)n = n
C0 an b0 − n C1 an−1 b1 + n C2 an−2 b2 − · · ·
+(−1)r n Cr an−r br + · · · + (−1)n n Cn a0 bn .
Observe that the sign ‘+’ and ‘−’ appear alternately in the binomial expansion of (a − b)n .
(ii) Replacing a by 1 and b by x, in the binomial expansion of (a + b)n , we get
(1 + x)n = n C0 + n C1 x + n C2 x2 + · · · + n Cr xr + · · · + n Cn xn .
n
In particular, when x = 1, C0 + n C1 + n C2 + · · · + n Cn = 2n .
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
10 10 × 9 × 8 × 7 4
C6 a 4 b 6 = 10
C4 a 4 b 6 = 3 (2x)6 = 210 × 34 × 26 x6 . [∵ 10
C6 = 10
C4 ]
4×3×2×1
So coefficient of x6 in the expansion of (3 + 2x)10 is 210 × 34 26 .
7 7×6×5 4
C3 a 4 b 3 = 2 (−3x)3 = 35 × 24 × (−3)3 x3 .
3×2×1
So coefficient of x3 in the expansion of (2 − 3x)7 is 35 × 16 × (−27) = −15120.
Example 5.7 The 2nd , 3rd and 4th terms in the binomial expansion of
(x + a)n are 240, 720 and 1080 for a suitable value of x. Find x, a and n.
Solution:
It is given that T2 = 240 , T3 = 720 and T4 = 1080.
n
T2 = C1 xn−1 a = 240 (1)
n
T3 = C2 xn−2 a2 = 720 (2)
n
T4 = C3 xn−3 a3 = 1080 (3)
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
5x4 a 240
a = 6
x 4
1 4
Example 5.8 Expand 2x − 2x
.
Solution:
We have
4 0 1 2
1 4 4 1 4 3 1 4 2 1
2x − = C0 (2x) − + C1 (2x) − + C2 (2x) −
2x 2x 2x 2x
3 4
1 1
+ 4 C3 (2x)1 − + 4 C4 (2x)0 −
2x 2x
2 3 4
4 3 1 2 1 1 1
= (2x) − 4(2x) + 6(2x) − 4(2x) +
2x 2x 2x 2x
1 1
= 16x4 − 16x2 + 6 − 2 +
x 16x4
√ 5 √ 5
Example 5.9 Expand x2 + 1 − x2 + x2 − 1 − x2 .
Solution:
We have
2
√ 5
5
√
2 5
0
5 2 4
√ 1
x + 1−x 2 = C0 (x ) 1−x 2 + C1 (x ) 1−x 2
√ 2 √ 3
+ 5 C2 (x2 )3 1 − x2 + 5 C3 (x2 )2 1 − x2
√ 4 √ 5
+ 5 C4 (x2 )1 1 − x2 + 5 C5 (x2 )0 1 − x2
√ √
= x10 + 5x8 1 − x2 + 10x6 (1 − x2 ) + 10x4 (1 − x2 ) 1 − x2
√
+5x2 (1 − x2 )2 + (1 − x2 )2 ( 1 − x2 )
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
√ 5 √ 0 √ 1
x2 − 1 − x2 = 5
C0 (x2 )5 − 5 C1 (x2 )4
1 − x2 1 − x2
√ 2 √ 3
+ 5 C2 (x2 )3 1 − x2 − 5 C3 (x2 )2 1 − x2
√ 4 √ 5
5 2 1 2 5 2 0 2
+ C4 (x ) 1−x − C5 (x ) 1−x
√ √
= x10 − 5x8 1 − x2 + 10x6 (1 − x2 ) − 10x4 (1 − x2 ) 1 − x2
√
+5x2 (1 − x2 )2 − (1 − x2 )2 ( 1 − x2 )
Thus
√ 5 √ 5
x2 + 1 − x2 + x2 − 1 − x2 = 2[x10 + 10x6 (1 − x2 ) + 5x2 (1 − x2 )2 ]
= 2[x10 + 10x6 − 10x8 + 5x2 (1 − 2x2 + x4 )]
= 2[x10 − 10x8 + 15x6 − 10x4 + 5x2 ]
Example 5.10 Using Binomial theorem, prove that 6n −5n always leaves remainder 1 when divided
by 25 for all positive integer n.
Solution:
To prove this it is enough to prove, 6n − 5n = 25k + 1 for some integer k. We first consider the
expansion
Thus 6n − 5n always leaves remainder 1 when divided by 25 for all positive integer n.
Example 5.11 Find the last two digits of the number 7400 .
Solution:
We have
= 502 200
C0 50198 − 200
C1 50197 + · · · + 200
C198 (−1)198 − 200 × 50 + 1.
As 502 and 200 are divisible by 100, the last two digits of 7400 is 0 1.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 5.1
3 √ 4 √ 4
1. Expand (i) 2x2 − x3 (ii) 2x2 − 3 1 − x2 + 2x2 + 3 1 − x2 .
2. Compute (i) 1024 (ii) 994 (iii) 97 .
3. Using binomial theorem, indicate which of the following two number is larger: (1.01)1000000 ,
10000. 10
15 2 1
4. Find the coefficient of x in x + 3 .
x 6
2 6 2 1
5. Find the coefficient of x and the coefficient of x in x − 3 .
x
1
4 3 50 2
6. Find the coefficient of x in the expansion of (1 + x ) (x + )5 .
5 x
1
7. Find the constant term of 2x3 − 2 .
3x
8. Find the last two digits of the number 3600 .
9. If n is a positive integer, using Binomial theorem, show that, 9n+1 − 8n − 9 is always divisible by
64.
10. If n is an odd positive integer, prove that the coefficients of the middle terms in the expansion of
(x + y)n are equal.
11. If n is a positive integer and r is a nonnegative integer, prove that the coefficients of xr and xn−r
in the expansion of (1 + x)n are equal.
12. If a and b are distinct integers, prove that a − b is a factor of an − bn , whenever n is a positive
integer. [Hint: write an = (a − b + b)n and expand]
13. In the binomial expansion of (a + b)n , if the coefficients of the 4th and 13th terms are equal then,
find n.
14. If the binomial coefficients of three consecutive terms in the expansion of (a + x)n are in the ratio
1 : 7 : 42, then find n.
15. In the binomial expansion of (1 + x)n , the coefficients of the 5th , 6th and 7th terms are in AP. Find
all values of n.
(2n)!
16. Prove that C02 + C12 + C22 + · · · + Cn2 = .
(n!)2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
y
4
1 2 3 4 x
Figure 5.1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
a must be 0. What can we say about the common ratio r? If we take r as 1, 2 or any other number
we get the same sequence 0, 0, 0, 0, . . . . We are left with the situation where a geometric sequence
has infinitely many common ratios. To overcome these confusions some mathematicians exclude this
sequence from the class of geometric sequences by assuming a 6= 0 in the definition. (We made this
assumption)
Definition 5.1
A sequence of the form
Definition 5.2
A sequence h1 , h2 , h3 , . . . is said to a harmonic sequence or a harmonic progression if
1
, 1 , 1 , 1 , . . . is an arithmetic sequence.
h1 h2 h3 h4
Note that a sequence is in harmonic progression if reciprocal of its term are in arithmetic progression.
But we should not say that harmonic progressions are reciprocals of arithmetic progressions; in fact,
if an arithmetic sequence contains a zero term, then its reciprocal is not meaningful. Of course, if
an arithmetic progression contains no zero term, then its reciprocal is a harmonic progression. So a
general harmonic progression will be of the form
1 1 1 1
, , , ,...
a a + d a + 2d a + 3d
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) The sequence n1 = 1, 21 , 13 , · · · is a harmonic sequence. One can draw the graph
of
{(n, n1 ) : n ∈ N} and visualize the harmonic sequence n1 .
2ac
(ii) If a, b, c are in HP, then b = .
a+c
(iii) In a triangle, if the altitudes are in AP, then the sides are in HP
a a−b
Example 5.12 Prove that if a, b, c are in HP, if and only if c
= b−c
.
Solution:
If a, b, c are in HP, then a1 , 1b , 1c are in AP. Thus, we have 2b = a1 + 1c , which gives ab − ac = ac − bc.
So, a(b−c) = c(a−b), which gives ac = a−b b−c
. On the other hand, if ac = a−b
b−c
, then a(b−c) = c(a−b).
1 1 1 1 1 1 1
Dividing each terms of both sides by abc, we get c − b = b − a . Thus, a , b , c are in AP and hence
a, b, c are in HP.
1 1
Example 5.13 If the 5th and 9th terms of a harmonic progression are 19
and 35
, find the 12th term
of the sequence.
Solution:
1
Let hn be the harmonic progression and let an = . Then a5 = 19 and a9 = 35. As an ’s form an
hn
arithmetic progression, we have a + 4d = 19 and a + 8d = 35. Solving these two equations, we
get a = 3 and d = 4. Thus a12 = a + 11d = 47. Thus the 12th term of the harmonic progression
1
is .
47
What can we say about constant sequences? All constant sequences other than the zero sequence
are harmonic progressions also.
5.4.4 Arithmetic, Geometric and Harmonic Mean
We know the concept of “average”. There are many “averages”. Arithmetic mean (AM), Geometric
mean(GM) and Harmonic mean(HM) are also some averages. Let us now recall the definitions of
arithmetic mean and geometric mean, where the terms need not in AP or GP.
Definition 5.3
Let n be any positive integer. Let a1 , a2 , a3 , . . . , an be n numbers . Then the number
a1 + a2 + a3 + · · · + an
n
is called the arithmetic mean of the numbers a1 , a2 , a3 , . . . , an .
The numbers a1 , a2 , a3 , . . . , an need not be distinct and it is not necessary that the numbers are
positive. It easily follows from the definition that 16 is the arithmetic mean of the numbers
14, 14, 17, 20, 15.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Taking the multiplication in place of addition and nth root in place of division by n in the definition
of arithmetic mean we get the definition of geometric mean.
Definition 5.4
Let n be any positive integer. Let a1 , a2 , a3 , . . . , an be n non-negative numbers. Then the number
√n
a1 a2 a3 . . . a n
Here also the numbers a1 , a2 , a3 , . . . , an need not be distinct√but it is necessary that the numbers are
non-negative. The geometric mean of the numbers 4, 6, 9 is 3 216 = 6. The arithmetic mean of these
three numbers is 19 3
= 6 13 . Observe that the arithmetic mean is greater than the geometric mean in this
case. Is this true always?
It can be proved that “For any set of n non-negative numbers, the arithmetic mean is greater than
or equal to the geometric mean”. That is, if AM denotes the arithmetic mean and GM denotes the
geometric mean, then AM ≥ GM .
Let us prove this inequality AM ≥ GM for two non-negative numbers.
Theorem 5.2: If AM and GM denote the arithmetic mean and the geometric mean of two
nonnegative numbers, then AM ≥ GM . The equality holds if and only if the two numbers are equal.
Proof. Let a and b be any two nonnegative numbers. Then
√
a+b
AM = 2
and GM = ab.
√
We have, (a +√b)2 − 4ab = (a − b)2 ≥ 0 Thus, (a + b)2 − 4ab ≥ 0 which gives (a + b) ≥ 2 ab.
Hence a+b2
≥ ab.
In other words, AM ≥ GM .
Moreover, the equality holds if and only if (a+b)2 −4ab = 0. This holds if and only if (a−b)2 = 0
which holds if and only if a = b. Thus AM = GM if and only if a = b.
a+b
√ab 2
D
A B
a M b
Figure 5.2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Through D we draw the perpendicular to AB and let it to meet the semi-circle at C. We draw straight
lines CA, CB and CM . Since M is the center CM = radius = a+b 2
. Clearly M D = a+b2
− a. Using
CD BD 2
the similar
√ triangles ∆ACD and ∆CBD we have AD
= CD
and hence CD
√ = AD × BD = ab. So
CD = ab. (Using Pythagoras theorem also we can prove that CD = ab.) Since √ the length of any
half chord is less than or equal to the radius, we have CD ≤ CM . In other words, ab ≤ a+b 2
. This
means GM ≤ AM .
The length of the half chord DC is equal to the radius if and only if D = M . Thus equality
AM = GM holds if and only if a = b.
Result 5.1: If a1 , a2 , a3 , . . . , an is an arithmetic progression, every term ak (k > 1) is the arithmetic
mean of its immediate predecessor ak−1 and immediate successor ak+1 .
Proof. Let a1 , a2 , a3 , . . . , an be an arithmetic progression with initial term a and common difference
d. Then
ak = a + (k − 1)d, ak−1 = a + (k − 2)d and ak+1 = a + kd.
Thus
ak−1 + ak+1 a + (k − 2)d + a + kd 2a + (2k − 2)d
= = = a + (k − 1)d = ak .
2 2 2
Therefore, ak is the arithmetic mean of ak−1 and ak+1 .
Result 5.2: If a1 , a2 , a3 , . . . , an is a geometric progression, every term ak (k > 1) is the geometric
mean of its immediate predecessor ak−1 and immediate successor ak+1 .
Proof. Let a1 , a2 , a3 , . . . , an be a geometric progression with initial term a and common ratio r. Then
Thus √ √ √
ak−1 ak+1 = ark−2 ark = a2 r2k−2 = ark−1 = ak .
Example 5.15 If the product of the 4th , 5th and 6th terms of a geometric progression is 4096 and if
the product of the 5th , 6th and 7th -terms of it is 32768, find the sum of first 8 terms of the geometric
progression.
Solution:
Let a, ar, ar2 , . . . be the geometric series having the given properties. Since the 4th , 5th and 6th
terms are ar3 , ar4 and ar5 , their product is a3 r12 . Thus a3 r12 = 4096. Similarly a3 r15 = 32768.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
a3 r15 32768
Therefore = . Hence r3 = 8. This implies that r = 2.
a3 r12 4096
a3 r12 = 4096 we have a3 = 1. Therefore a = 1.
a(1 − r8 ) 1 − 28
The sum of the first 8 terms is = = 255.
1−r 1−2
Harmonic Mean
The harmonic mean of a set of positive numbers is the reciprocal of the arithmetic mean of the
reciprocals of the set of numbers. That is, if h1 , h2 , . . . , hn are positive numbers, then their reciprocals
are h11 , h12 , . . . , h1n ; the arithmetic mean of the reciprocals is
1 1 1
h1
+ h2
+ ··· + hn
n
and the reciprocal of this arithmetic mean, that is the harmonic mean of the numbers h1 , h2 , . . . , hn is
n
1 1 1 .
h1
+ h2
+ ··· + hn
Definition 5.5
The harmonic mean of a set {h1 , h2 , . . . , hn } of positive numbers is defined as
n
1 1 1 .
h1
+ h2
+ ··· + hn
2 2ab
In particular, the harmonic mean of two positive numbers a and b is which is equal to a+b
1 .
+ 1b a
It can be proved that “For any set of n positive numbers, the geometric mean is greater than or
equal to the harmonic mean”. That is, GM ≥ HM .
Let us prove this inequality GM ≥ HM for two non-negative numbers.
Theorem 5.3: If GM and HM denote the geometric mean and the harmonic mean of two non-
negative numbers, then GM ≥ HM . The equality holds if and only if the two numbers are equal.
Proof. Let a and b be any two positive numbers. Then
√ 2ab
GM = ab and HM = .
a+b
√ 2ab
GM − HM = ab −
√ a+b
ab(a + b) − 2ab
=
√ a+b √
ab((a + b) − 2 ab)
=
√ √ a +√b 2
ab( a − b)
=
a+b
≥ 0
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
If a vehicle travels at a speed of x kmph. covering certain distance and it returns the
same distance with a speed of y kmph., then the average speed of the vehicle in the
whole travel is the harmonic mean of the upward and downward speeds. Indeed, if d is
the distance, then time taken for upward journey is xd and the time taken for downward
journey is yd .
2d 2xy
Thus average speed is = .
d d x+y
+
x y
For example if a vehicle travels at a speed of 60 kmph. covering certain distance and it returns the
same distance with a speed of 40 kmph., then the average speed of the vehicle in the whole travel is
the harmonic mean of 60 and 40. That is 2×60×40
60+40
= 48 kmph speed.
Exercise - 5.2
1. Write the first 6 terms of the sequences whose nth terms are given below and classify them
as arithmetic progression, geometric progression, arithmetico-geometric progression, harmonic
progression and none of them.
1 (n + 1)(n + 2) 1 n (−1)n
(v) 2n+3 (vii) 3n−2
(i) n+1 (ii) (iii) 4 (iv) (vi) 2018
2 n + 3(n + 4) 2 n 3n+4 3n−1
2. Write the first 6 terms of the sequences whose nth term an is given below.
1 if n = 1
n + 1 if n is odd
(i) an = (ii) an = 2 if n = 2
n if n is even a
n−1 + an−2 if n > 2
n if n is 1, 2 or 3
(iii) an =
an−1 + an−2 + an−3 if n > 3
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
a − (a + (n − 1)d)rn 1 − rn−1
Sn = + dr
1−r (1 − r)2
n−1 !
1 − (1 + 5(n − 1))( 17 )n 1 (1 − 17 )
= 1 +5× 1 2
1− 7 7 (1 − 7 )
5n−4 5 n−1
1− 7n 7
(7 − 1)
= 6 + n−1 6 2
7
7 (7)
7n − 5n + 4 5(7 − 1) n−1
= n−1
+ n−2
7 6 7 36
Thus
√ √ √ √ √ √ √
t1 + t2 + · · · + tn = ( 2 − 1) + ( 3 − 2) + · · · + ( n + 1 − n) = n + 1 − 1
n
1
Example 5.18 Find Σ k(k+1)
.
k=1
Solution:
1
Let tk denote the k th term of the given series. Then tk = k(k+1)
. By using partial fraction we get
1 1 1
= − .
k(k + 1) k k+1
Thus
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
t1 + t2 + · · · + tn = 1 − + − + − + ··· + − =1− .
2 2 3 3 4 n n+1 n+1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 5.3
1. Find the sum of the first 20-terms of the arithmetic progression having the sum of first 10 terms as
52 and the sum of the first 15 terms as 77.
13 13 + 23 13 + 23 + 33
2. Find the sum up to the 17th term of the series + + + ···
1 1+3 1+3+5
3. Compute the sum of first n terms of the following series:
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1/16
4 2 4 1/32
1 1 1 1
3 8 2
+ + 4 8
1 1
4 16 2
+ 41 + 18 + 16
1
1/2
1 1
5 32 2
+ 14 + 18 + 16
1
+ 321
Intuitively we feel that “finally” nothing will remain in plate A and the full cake will be in plate
B. In other words, the cake available in A is 0 and the cake available in B is 1. That is, intuitively we
feel that
1 1 1 1 1
1, , , , , , ...
2 4 8 16 32
“goes” to 0 and
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
, + , + + , + + + , ...
2 2 4 2 4 8 2 4 8 16
“goes” to 1 or equivalently
1 1 1 1
+ + + + ... is 1.
2 4 8 16
In this section let us learn the sense in which the words “finally” and “goes” are used and also let us
learn the addition of infinitely many numbers.
We intuitively feel that 1, 12 , 41 , 81 , 16
1 1
, 32 , . . . “goes” to 0. Similarly we feel that the sequence 1,
1 1 1 1 1
, , , ,
10 100 1000 10000 100000
, . . . also “goes” to 0.
If (an ) is a sequence and a is a number so that for any given small positive number, there is a
stage after which the distance between an and a is smaller than that positive number, then we may say
that an goes to a as n goes to infinity. In technical terms we may say that an tends to a as n tends to
infinity. In other words, in the limiting case an becomes a or the limit of an is a as n tends to ∞. We
also say that the sequence (an ) converges to a. If (an ) converges to a, then we write lim an = a.
n→∞
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, . . .
goes to some number. In other words, this sequence do not converge to any limit. So a sequence may
not have a limit. But we can prove that a sequence cannot converge to more than one limit; that is, if
a sequence converges to a limit, then it is unique.
1 6 15 20 15 6 1
1
1 7 21 35 35 21 7 1
1 8 28 56 70 56 28 8 1
1 1 9 36 84 126 126 84 36 9 1
Figure 5.5
Figure 5.4
Observe that
(i) every third number is a multiple of 3rd term (t3 = 2).
(ii) every fourth number is a multiple of 4th term (t4 = 3).
(iii) every fifth number is a multiple of 5th term (t5 = 5).
(iv) So, every nth number is a multiple of nth term.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Infinite Series
If (an ) is an infinite sequence of numbers, then the formal expression a1 +a2 +· · · is called an infinite
∞
series and is denoted as Σ ak .
k=1
In the beginning of the section we have seen the infinite series
1 1 1 1
+ + + + ···
2 4 8 16
and intuitively felt that “its sum” is 1 (in the cake problem). Actually in the cake problem, the stage
by stage availability of the cake in the plate B is given in the following sequence.
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
, + , + + , + + + ···
2 2 4 2 4 8 2 4 8 16
The nth term of this sequence is
1 1 1 1 1
+ + + + ··· + n
2 4 8 16 2
2n −1
which is equal to 2n
. If sn denote this sum, then lim sn = 1. This is one of the reasons for us to
n→∞
feel that the sum
1 1 1 1
+ + + + ··· is 1.
2 4 8 16
Motivated by this we may define the sum of infinitely many numbers. Let (an ) be a sequence of
real numbers and let sn = a1 + a2 + a3 + · · · + an . If the sequence (sn ) converges to a limit s, then it
is meaningful to say that the sequence (an ) is “summable” and the sum is s. In this case, we write
a1 + a2 + a3 + · · · = s
Definition 5.6
∞
Let Σ an be a series of real numbers and let
n=1
s n = a1 + a2 + a3 + · · · + an , n ∈ N
∞
The sequence (sn ) is called the partial sum sequence of Σ an . If (sn ) converges and if
n=1
lim sn = s, then the series is said to be a convergent series and s is called the sum of the
n→∞
series.
∞ ∞
We write Σ an = s. Let us see some examples. The series Σ (−1)n+1 does not converge because
n=1 n=1
the partial sum sequence 1, 0, 1, 0, 1, 0, . . . does not converge.
We cannot apply algebraic rules meant for finite series to an infinite series blindly.
∞
Consider Σ (−1)n+1 = 1 − 1 + 1 − 1 + · · · If S = 1 − 1 + 1 − 1 + · · · then one
n=1
may argue that S = 0 or 1 or 12 according to S = (1 − 1) + (1 − 1) + · · · ,
S = 1 + (−1 + 1) + (−1 + 1) + · · · or 1 − S = 1 − (+1 − 1 + 1 − 1 + · · · = S)
respectively.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
∞
1
The series Σ xn converges if x = 2
whereas it does not converge if x = 2. This shows that series like
n=0
∞
Σ an xn converges for some values of x and does not converge for some values of x. The problem of
n=0
finding the values of x for which sequences of this form converges is beyond the scope of this book.
However in the rest of the chapter we list some series with the appropriate values of x for which the
series converges and the sum of the series whenever it converges.
1
= 1 + x + x 2 + x3 + · · ·
1−x
∞
1
• Σ (−1)n xn converges for all real number x with |x| < 1 and the sum is 1+x
. That is, for all real
n=0
numbers x satisfying |x| < 1,
1
= 1 − x + x2 − x3 + · · ·
1+x
∞
1 1
• Σ (2x)n converges for all real number x with |x| < 2
and the sum is 1−2x
. That is, for real
n=0
numbers x satisfying |x| < 12 ,
1
= 1 + 2x + 4x2 + 8x3 + · · ·
1 − 2x
∞
xn
• Σ n!
converges for all real number x and the sum is ex . That is,
n=0
x x2 x3 x4
ex = 1 + + + + + ···
1! 2! 3! 4!
for
∞
all real numbers x.
• Σ (−1)n x converges only for x = 0.
n=0
Let us discuss some special series. By assuming the convergence of those series let us solve some
problems.
a dr
S = lim Sn = +
n→∞ 1 − r (1 − r)2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
a dr
S∞ = +
1 − r (1 − r)2
1 3 × 15
= +
1 − 15 (1 − 1 )2
5
5 3 25
= +
4 5 16
35
=
16
∞
1
Example 5.20 Find Σ n2 +5n+6
.
n=1
Solution:
1
Let an denote the nth term of the given series. Then an = n2 +5n+6
. By using partial fraction, we get
1 1
an = − .
n+2 n+3
Let sn denote the sum of first n terms of the given series. Then
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
sn = a1 +a2 +· · ·+an = − + − + − +· · ·+ − = − .
3 4 4 5 5 6 n+2 n+3 3 n+3
1 1 1
But as n tends to infinity, n+3
tends to zero and hence 3
− n+3
tends to 31 . In other words sn tends
∞
to 31 . Thus Σ 1
n2 +5n+6
= 1
3
.
n=1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Binomial theorem (Theorem 5.1) for positive integral exponent (integral exponent means integer
power). Now let us state the Binomial theorem for rational power.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
2
Example 5.21 Expand (1 + x) 3 up to four terms for |x| < 1.
Solution:
Here n = 23 .
2 2
n(n − 1) (
3 3
− 1)
=
2! 2!
2 −1
(
3 3
)
=
2
−1
=
9
2 2
n(n − 1)(n − 2) ( − 1)( 23 − 2)
3 3
=
3! 3!
2 −1 −4
(
3 3
)( 3
)
=
6
4
=
81
Thus
2 2 1 4
(1 + x) 3 = 1 + x − x2 + x3 + · · ·
3 9 81
1
Example 5.22 Expand in powers of x. Find a condition on x for which the expansion is
(1 + 3x)2
valid.
Solution:
If we take 3x = y, then
1 1
2
= .
(1 + 3x) (1 + y)2
1
Now can be expanded using binomial theorem in powers of y. The expansion is valid only
(1 + y)2
1
for values of y satisfying |y| < 1. Replacing y by 3x we can get an expansion of . The
(1 + 3x)2
expansion is valid only for values of x satisfying |3x| < 1; that is the expansion is valid only for
values of x satisfying |x| < 31 .
1
= (1 + 3x)−2
(1 + 3x)2
2(2 + 1) 2(2 + 1)(2 + 2)
= 1 − 2(3x) + (3x)2 − (3x)3
2! 3!
2(2 + 1)(2 + 2)(2 + 3)
+ (3x)4 − · · ·
4!
1
Hence, (1+3x)2
= 1 − 6x + 27x2 − 108x3 + 405x4 − · · · , |x| < 13 .
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1
Example 5.23 Expand in powers of x. Find a condition on x for which the expansion is
(3 + 2x)2
valid.
Solution:
−2 2x
(Clearly we have to use the expansion of (1 + x) . So, we have to write (3 + 2x) as 3 1 +
3
and proceed.)
1 1
= 2
(3 + 2x)2
2x
32 1+
3
−2
1 2x
= 1+
9 3
1 −2 2x
= (1 + y) where =y
9 3
1
= (1 − 2y + 3y 2 − 4y 3 + 5y 4 − · · · ), if |y| < 1
9 !
2 3 4
1 2x 2x 2x 2x 2x
= 1−2 +3 −4 +5 − ··· ,| | < 1
9 3 3 3 3 3
1 4 4 32 80
= 1 − x + x2 − x3 + x 4 − · · ·
9 3 3 27 81
1 1 4 4 2 32 3 80 4 3
Thus, = − x+ x − x + x − · · · , |x| <
(3 + 2x)2 9 27 27 243 729 2
The expansion is valid if |y| < 1. So, the expansion is valid if |x| < 32 .
We can find square root, cube root and other roots of any positive number by using binomial
theorem. Let us see one such problem.
√
3
Example 5.24 Find 65.
Solution:
We know that for |x| < 1,
n(n − 1) 2 n(n − 1)(n − 2) 3
(1 + x)n = 1 + nx + x + x + ...
2! 3!
√
3 1
65 = 65 3
1
= (64 + 1) 3
1
1 1 3
= 64 3 1 +
64
1
1 3
= 4 1+
64
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
2 !
1 1
1 1 − 1 1
= 4 1+ × + 3 3 × + ···
3 64 2! 64
1 1 1 1
= 4+ −4× × × + ···
48 9 64 64
1 1
= 4+ − + ···
48 9216
1
≈ 4 + 0.02 since + · · · is very small
9216
√
3
65 = 4.02 (approximately).
√
3
√ 1
Example 5.25 Prove that x3 + 7 − 3 x3 + 4 is approximately equal to x2
when x is large.
Solution:
√ 1
x3 + 7 = (x3 + 7) 3
3
13
3 7 7
= x 1+ 3 , (| | < 1 as x is large)
x x3
1
7 3
= x 1+ 3
x
2 !
1 1
1 7 − 1 7
= x 1+ × 3 + 3 3 + ···
3 x 2! x3
7 1 49 1
= x 1+ × 3 − × 6 + ···
3 x 9 x
7 1 49 1
= x+ × 2 − × 5 + ···
3 x 9 x
√ 1
x3 + 4 = (x3 + 4) 3
3
13
4
= x3 1 + 3
x
1
4 3 4
= x 1+ 3 (| 3 | < 1)
x x
2 !
1 1
1 4 − 1 4
= x 1+ × 3 + 3 3 + ···
3 x 2! x3
4 1 16 1
= x+ × 2 − × 5 + ···
3 x 9 x
Since x is large, 1 is very small and hence higher powers of 1 are negligible. Thus
x x
√ √
x3 + 7 =x + 37 × x12 and x3 + 4 = x + 34 × x12 . Therefore
3 3
√ √
3 3 7 1 4 1 1
x3 + 7 − x3 + 4 = x+ × 2 − x+ × 2 =
3 x 3 x x2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
√
The binomial theorem is true for all real numbers n. For example, when n = 2, we
have
√ √ √ √ √
√
2
√ 2( 2 − 1) 2 2( 2 − 1)( 2 − 2) 3
(1 + x) = 1 + 2x + x + x + · · · , |x| < 1.
2! 3!
1 1 1 1
e=1+ + + + + ··· .
1! 2! 3! 4!
We have
x x2 x3 x4
ex = 1 + + + + + ··· (5.1)
1! 2! 3! 4!
x x2 x3 x4
e−x = 1 − + − + − ··· . (5.2)
1! 2! 3! 4!
In particular,
1 1 1 1 1
= e−1 = 1 − + − + − · · · .
e 1! 2! 3! 4!
ex + e−x x2 x4 x6 ex − e−x x x3 x5
=1+ + + + · · · and = + + + ···
2 2! 4! 6! 2 1! 3! 5!
In particular we have
e + e−1 1 1 1 e − e−1 1 1 1
= 1 + + + + · · · and = + + + ···
2 2! 4! 6! 2 1! 3! 5!
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
x3 x5
1+x
log =2 x+ + + ··· .
1−x 3 5
Suppose we want to write log(1+2x) in a series, then we can replace 2x by y and use the expansion
y2 y3 y4
log(1 + y) = y − + − + ···
2 3 4
for all values of y satisfying |y| < 1. But if |y| < 1, then |2x| < 1 and hence |x| < 12 . So if |x| < 12 ,
then
(2x)2 (2x)3 (2x)4
log(1 + 2x) = 2x − + − + ··· .
2 3 4
2 3 4
Thus log(1 + 2x) = 2x − 4x + 8x − 16x + · · · for all values of x satisfying |x| < 12 .
2 3 4
Exercise - 5.4
1. Expand the following in ascending powers of x and find the condition on x for which the binomial
expansion is valid.
1 2 2 2
(i) (ii) 2
(iii) (5 + x2 ) 3 (iv) (x + 2)− 3
5+x (3 + 4x)
√3
2. Find 1001 approximately (two decimal places).
√ √
3. Prove that 3 x3 + 6 − 3 x3 + 3 is approximately equal to x12 when x is sufficiently large.
q 2
4. Prove that 1−x
1+x
is approximately equal to 1 − x + x2 when x is very small.
1
5. Write the first 6 terms of the exponential series (i) e5x (ii) e−2x (iii) e 2 x .
1+3x
6. Write the first4 terms of the logarithmic series (i) log(1 + 4x) (ii) log(1 − 2x) (iii) log 1−3x
1−2x
(iv) log 1+2x . Find the intervals on which the expansions are valid.
x2 x3 x4 y2 y3 y4
7. If y = x + 2
+ 3
+ 4
+ · · · , then show that x = y − 2!
+ 3!
− 4!
+ ···.
q q
p (n+1)p+(n−1)q 15
8. If p − q is small compared to either p or q, then show that n
q
' (n−1)p+(n+1)q
. Hence find 8
16
.
3−4x+x2
9. Find the coefficient of x4 in the expansion of e2x
.
∞
1 1 1
10. Find the value of Σ 2n−1 9n−1
+ 92n−1 .
n=1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 5.5
Choose the correct or the most suitable answer.
1. The value of 2 + 4 + 6 + · · · + 2n is
(1) n(n−1)
2
(2) n(n+1)
2
(3) 2n(2n+1)
2
(4) n(n + 1)
2. The coefficient of x6 in (2 + 2x)10 is
10
(1) C6 (2) 26 (3) 10
C6 26 (4) 10
C6 210 .
3. The coefficient of x8 y 12 in the expansion of (2x + 3y)20 is
(1) 0 (2) 28 312 (3) 28 312 + 212 38 (4) 20
C8 28 312 .
4. If n C10 > n Cr for all possible r, then a value of n is
(1) 10 (2) 21 (3) 19 (4) 20.
5. If a is the arithmetic mean and g is the geometric mean of two numbers, then
(1) a≤g (2) a≥g (3) a=g (4) a > g.
2 2 n 2 n+4
6. If (1 + x ) (1 + x) = a0 + a1 x + a2 x + · · · + x and if a0 , a1 , a2 are in AP, then n is
(1) 1 (2) 5 (3) 2 (4) 4.
7. If a, 8, b are in AP, a, 4, b are in GP, and if a, x, b are in HP then x is
(1) 2 (2) 1 (3) 4 (4) 16.
8. The sequence √1 , √ 1 √ , √ 1 √ , · · · form an
3 3+ 2 3+2 2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
1
16. The value of the series 2
+ 74 + 13
8
+ 19
16
+ · · · is
(1) 14 (2) 7 (3) 4 (4) 6.
17. The sum of an infinite GP is 18. If the first term is 6, the common ratio is
1 2 1 3
(1) 3
(2) 3
(3) 6
(4) 4
.
18. The coefficient of x5 in the series e−2x is
2 3 −4 4
(1) 3
(2) 2
(3) 15
(4) 15
.
1 1 1
19. The value of 2!
+ 4!
+ 6!
+ · · · is
e2 +1 (e+1)2 (e−1)2 e2 −1
(1) 2e
(2) 2e
(3) 2e
(4) 2e
.
1 2 1 2 2 2 3
− 14
20. The value of 1 − 2 3
+ 3 3 3
+ · · · is
(1) log 53 3 5 5 5 2 2
(2) 2
log 3
(3) 3
log 3
(4) 3
log 3
.
Summary
In this chapter we have acquired the knowledge of
• Binomial theorem for any n ∈ N,
(a + b)n = n C0 an b0 + n C1 an−1 b1 + · · · + n Cn a0 bn .
n
• C0 + n C1 + · · · + n Cn = 2n .
n
• C1 + n C3 + + n C5 · · · + = n C0 + n C2 + + n C4 · · · + = 2n−1
• AM ≥ GM ≥ HM
• The nth term of an AP is given by Tn = a + (n − 1)d.
• The nth term of an GP is given by Tn = arn−1 .
• The nth term of an AGP is given by Tn = (a + (n − 1)d)rn−1 .
• For any positive numbers a and b, we have
a+b √ 2ab
AM = , GM = ab, HM = .
2 a+b
n
• The sum of first n terms of an AP is given by Sn = (2a + (n − 1)d).
2
a(1 − rn )
• The sum of first n terms of an GP is given by Sn = for r 6= 1.
1−r
a − (a + (n − 1)d)rn n−1
• The sum of first n terms of an AGP is given by Sn = + dr 1−r
(1−r)2
1−r
for r 6= 1.
n n(n+1)
• Σ k = 1 + 2 + 3 + ··· + n = 2
.
k=1
n n(n+1)(2n+1)
• Σ k 2 = 12 + 22 + 32 + · · · + n2 = 6
.
k=1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
n 2
n(n+1)
• Σ k 3 = 13 + 23 + 33 + · · · + n3 = 2
.
k=1
• Fibonacci sequence 1, 1, 2, 3, 5, · · ·
• Binomial theorem for rational exponent
ICT CORNER-5(a)
Expected Outcome ⇒
Step–1
Open the Browser and type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code..
Step–2
Sequences and Series workbook will open. Several worksheets are given in this workbook.
Select a worksheet “Relation between Q.M,A.M,G.M and H.M”
Step–3
You have All the Mean formula working with varying a and b. Move the point named
“Move” and see that Mean values changes corresponding to a and b.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
ICT CORNER-5(b)
Expected Outcome ⇒
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Step–1
Open the Browser and type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code.
GeoGebra worksheet “PASCALS TRIANGLE” will appear. You can see pascal triangle
arrangements. There are check boxes “View Pascal Triangle”, “View Pascal’s Numbers”
and “View Combination”
Step–2
Click on “View Pascal’s Numbers” and move the sliders “n” and “r”. The red colour
point moves over the numbers. Leave on any number and click “View Calculation” to see
combinatorial working. Now compare the pascal numbers with the calculation.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Two Dimensional
Chapter 6 Analytical Geometry
6.1 Introduction
237
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Real life situation 6.4: The quantity demanded of a certain type of Compact Disk is 22,000 units
when a unit price is | 8. The customer will not buy the disk, at a unit price of | 30 or higher. On
the other side the manufacturer will not market any disk if the price is | 6 or lower. However, if
the price is | 14 the manufacturer can supply 24,000 units. Assume that the quantity demanded and
quantity supplied are linearly proportional to the price. How to find (i) the demand equation (ii)
supply equation (iii) the market equilibrium quantity and price. (iv) The quantity of demand and
supply when the price is | 10.
The equation of the straight line for each of the problems stated above, not only solves the specific
case of solutions but also helps us get many information through it. Later, in this chapter, let us try
to solve these types of problems by using the concepts of straight lines. In order to understand the
straight line, we need to get acquainted with some of its basic concepts. Let us discuss those in detail
Learning Objective
On completion of this chapter, the students expected to know
• the equation of a line in different forms
• whether two given lines are parallel or perpendicular;
• the distance of a given point from a given line and between two parallel lines,
• the family of straight lines for a given condition
• the equation of pair of straight lines, angle between them and angle bisectors
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
It is important to understand that a point is not a thing, but a place. We indicate the position of a point
by placing a dot. In plane analytical geometry, points are defined as ordered pairs of real numbers,
say, (x, y) with reference to the coordinate system.
Generally, a horizontal line is called the x-axis; and the line vertical to the x-axis is called the
y-axis. Intersection of these two axes is called the origin. Any point P in the plane can be located by
a unique ordered pair of numbers(x, y) where x gives the distance between the point P and the y-axis
and y denote the distance between the point P and the x-axis. Note that if x is negative it lies left of
y − axis, similarly if y is negative it lies below the x-axis. In applications, often letters other than x
and y are used, and different scales are chosen in the horizontal and vertical directions.
Definition 6.2
The path traced out by a moving point under certain conditions is called the locus of that point.
Alternatively, when a point moves in accordance with a geometrical law, its path is called locus.
The plural of locus is loci.
The following illustrations shows some cases of loci and its different uses.
Illustration 6.1: In cricket, when a ball is bowled by a bowler, the path traced out by the ball is the
locus of the ball. Whenever there is dispute between batsmen and the fielders for leg before wicket
(LBW) decisions, the locus of the ball
solves the crises, raised by the players Image courtesy of
for review, through the third umpire. The ESPNcric info
likely path of the ball can be projected
forward, through the batsman’s legs, to
see whether it would have hit the stumps
or not. Consultation of the third umpire,
for conventional slow motion or Hawk-
Eye, the probable decision will be taken.
This method is currently sanctioned in
international cricket.
https://www.hawkeyeinnovations.com/sports Figure 6.3
Illustration 6.2: Suppose P be a point on the rim (circumference) of a circular wheel. When the
circle is rolling without slipping along a straight line, the locus of the point P on the rim is shown in
figure. The path traced out by the point P is known as cycloid. (Try yourself by taking a point inside
the circle. Find the names of the curve from the web site: www.mathworld.wolfram.com
https://www.geogebra.org/b/bd2ADu2I
P P
P P
Figure 6.4
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Illustration 6.3: A missile is launched from the army ship to attack and another from the land to
intercept it. The loci of the missiles are shown in figure.
Locus of missiles play a vital role in
many wars. During the Gulf War (2
Aug1990-28 Feb 1991), Iraq attacked
Israeli cities with Scud missiles. To
defend from Scud attack, Israel used
Patriot missiles to shoot down enemy
missiles. To launch a satellite or space
shuttle successfully, the determination
Locus of intercepting missiles
of path plays an crucial role in space
research.
Figure 6.5
An equation in the two variables x and y will ordinarily be satisfied by infinitely many pair of
real value of x and y. Every such pair is called a real solution of the equation. Each real solution of
the equation will have its graph. The collection of all these graphs is called the locus of the given
equation.
The following table shows some important loci in mathematics
A moving point P under the given condition Graph Name of the path
A point P moves such that it is equidistant from Perpendicular bisector
two fixed points A and B P of the line segment AB
A B
Figure 6.6
A point P moves such that it is equidistant from Angle bisector of the
two fixed lines ox and oy y angle∠xoy
P
O x
Figure 6.7
Figure 6.8
Now let us discuss the ways of finding the locus of the points. The equation of the locus is the
relation that exists between the coordinates of all the points strictly lying on the path.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(iv) Replace h by x, and k by y, in the resulting equation. The resulting equation is the equation of
the locus of point P.
Example 6.1 Find the locus of a point which moves such that its distance from the x-axis is equal
to the distance from the y-axis.
Solution:
Let P (h, k) be a point on the locus. y
Let A and B be the foot of the perpendiculars drawn B
from the point P on the x-axis and the y-axis respec- P(h, k)
tively.
Therefore P is (OA, OB) = (BP, AP ) = (h, k) x
Given that AP = BP y=
⇒k=h O A x
c
6 0 is the parameter and c is a
Example 6.2 Find the path traced out by the point ct, , here t =
t
constant
Solution: c
Let P (h, k)be a point on the locus. From the given information, we have h = ct and k = .
t
To eliminate t, taking product of these two equations
c
(h) (k) = (ct) ⇒ hk = c2
t
Example 6.3 Find the locus of a point P moves such that its distances from two fixed points
A (1, 0) and B (5, 0) , are always equal.
Solution:
Given that A (1, 0) and B (5, 0) y
P(h, k)
Let P (h, k) be any point on the required path.
From the information we have AP = BP
That is
x=3
q q
2 2
(h − 1) + (k − 0) = (h − 5)2 + (k − 0)2 ⇒ h = 3
O A(1, 0) B(5, 0) x
Therefore the locus of P is x = 3, which is a straight
line parallel to the y-axis. Figure 6.10
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 6.4 If θ is a parameter, find the equation of the locus of a moving point, whose coordinates
are (a sec θ, b tan θ).
Solution:
Let P (h, k) be any point on the required path. From the given information we have
x2 y 2
− 2 = 1.
a2 b
https://www.geogebra.org/geometry
Whenever the parameters are in trigonometric form, try to use trigonometric identities
to eliminate θ
Example 6.5 A straight rod of the length 6 units, slides with its ends A and B always on the x and
y axes respectively. If O is the origin, then find the locus of the centroid of ∆OAB .
Solution:
Let the coordinates of the points O, A and B
are(0, 0) , (a, 0) and (0, b) respectively.
B
Observed that the points A and B are moving points.
Let(h, k) be a centroid of ∆OAB.
Centroid of ∆OAB is
P
0+a+0 0+0+b O
, = (h, k). A
3 3
a b
= h ⇒ a = 3h, = k ⇒ b = 3k
3 3
From right ∆OAB, OA2 + OB 2 = AB 2
Figure 6.11
(3h)2 + (3k)2 = (6)2 ⇒ h2 + k 2 = 4
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 6.6 If θ is a parameter, find the equation of the locus of a moving point, whose coordinates
are (a(θ − sin θ) , a(1 − cos θ)).
Solution:
Let P (h, k) be any point on the required
P P
path. From the given information we have
k = a(1 − cos θ)
√
a−k −1 a−k 2ak − k 2
cos θ = ⇒ θ = cos and sin θ =
a a a
√
a−k
Substituting above values in (6.1) we get h = a cos−1 − 2ak − k 2
a
The locus of (h, k) is p
−1 a−y
x = a cos − 2ay − y 2 (6.3)
a
https://www.geogebra.org/b/bd2ADu2I#material/zCKMj8kE
Though, the parametric form given above is converted to Cartesian form, in some cases
the parametric form may be more useful to work with than the cartesian form.
Exercise - 6.1
1. Find the locus of P , if for all values of α, the co-ordinates of a moving point P is
(i) (9 cos α , 9 sin α) (ii) (9 cos α , 6 sin α).
2. Find the locus of a point P that moves at a constant distant of (i) two units from the x-axis (ii)
three units from the y-axis.
3. If θ is a parameter, find the equation of the locus of a moving point, whose coordinates are
x = a cos3 θ, y = a sin3 θ.
4. Find the value of k and b, if the points P (−3, 1) and Q(2,b) lie on the locus of x2 − 5x + ky = 0.
5. A straight rod of length 8 units slides with its ends A and B always on the x and y axes respectively.
Find the locus of the mid point of the line segmentAB
6. Find the equation of the locus of a point such that the sum of the squares of the distance from the
points (3, 5), (1, −1) is equal to 20
7. Find the equation of the locus of the point P such that the line segment AB, joining the points
A(1, −6) and B(4, −2), subtends a right angle at P .
8. If O is origin and R is a variable point on y 2 = 4x, then find the equation of the locus of the
mid-point of the line segment OR.
a b
9. The coordinates of a moving point P are (cosecθ + sin θ) , (cosecθ − sin θ) , where θ is a
2 2
variable parameter. Show that the equation of the locus P is b2 x2 − a2 y 2 = a2 b2 .
10. If P (2, −7) is a given point and Q is a point on 2x2 + 9y 2 = 18, then find the equations of the
locus of the mid-point of P Q.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
11. If R is any point on the x-axis and Q is any point on the y-axis and P is a variable point on RQ
with RP = b, PQ = a. then find the equation of locus of P .
12. If the points P (6, 2) and Q(−2, 1) and R are the vertices of a ∆P QR and R is the point on the
locus y = x2 − 3x + 4, then find the equation of the locus of centroid of ∆P QR
13. If Q is a point on the locus of x2 + y 2 + 4x − 3y + 7 = 0, then find the equation of locus of P
which divides segment OQ externally in the ratio 3:4,where O is origin.
14. Find the points on the locus of points that are 3 units from x-axis and 5 units from the point (5, 1).
15. The sum of the distance of a moving point from the points (4, 0) and (−4, 0) is always 10 units.
Find the equation of the locus of the moving point.
ax + by + c = 0 (6.4)
where a and b are not both equal to zero. The name “linear” comes from the fact that the set of
solutions of such an equation forms a straight line in the plane. In this chapter “line”, we mean a
straight line unless otherwise stated.
There are many ways to write the equation of a line which can all be converted from one to another
by algebraic manipulation. These forms are generally named by the type of information (data) about
the line that is needed to write down the form. Some of the important data are points, slope, and
intercepts
Definition 6.3 y y
Figure 6.13
Definition 6.4
The slope or gradient of a straight line is a number that measures its “direction and steepness”.
The slope of a line in the plane containing the x and y axes, is generally represented by the letter m.
It can be measured in many ways as given below:
(i) When θ is the angle of inclination of the line with the x-axis measured in the counter clockwise
direction then the slope
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
m = tan θ.
π π
When θ is , ⇒ m = tan is undefined.
2 2
(x2, y2) B
(ii) When (x1 , y1 ) and (x2 , y 2 ) are any two points on the line with
x2 6= x1 , then the slope is the change in the y coordinate divided ∆y = y2 − y1
(iii) When the general form of the linear equation ax + by + c = 0 is given, then the slope of the
line is
a
m = − , b 6= 0.
b
m is undefined when b = 0
The slope of a line can be a positive or negative or zero or undefined as shown below:
y y y y
π
(0 ≤ θ < (
π
< θ < π)
2 2
) θ=0 θ=π
2
θ θ
θ
O x x
O O x O
x
Positive slope Negative slope Zero slope Undefined slope
y increases y decreases y does not change y changes
as x increases as x increases as x increases x does not change
Figure 6.15
Definition 6.5
In a plane three or more points are said to be collinear if they lie on a same straight line.
Let A, Band C be any three points on a plane. If the slope of AB is equal to the slope of BC (or AC),
then they are collinear.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Definition 6.6
The intercept of a line is the point at which the line crosses
either the x-axis or the y-axis. y
The x-intercept is a point where the y value is zero, and the y-intercept
A
y-intercept is a point where the x-value is zero. O x
x-intercept
Therefore the intercepts of a line are the points where the line
intersects, or crosses, the horizontal and vertical axes. Figure 6.16
Therefore it is clear that
(i) the equation of the y-axis is x = 0.
(ii) the equation of the x-axis is y = 0.
In the figure OA is the x-intercept and OB is the y-intercept.
y y y y
B B
O A x A O x A O x O A x
B B
Figure 6.17
We have learnt the definition and detailed information about the points, slope and intercepts. Using
these information, let us recall the different forms of an equation of a straight line.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Now let us look at an important way of describing the relationship between two quantities using
the notion of a function.
(i) Slope and Intercept form
y
Proportional linear functions can be written in the form
y = mx, where m is the slope of the line. Non
proportional linear functions can be written in the form y = mx + b
b
y = m x + b, b 6= 0 (6.5)
x
(1) when b = 0 and m 6= 0, the line passes through the origin and its equation is
y = mx.
(2) when b = 0 and m = 0, the line coincides with the x-axis and its equation is y = 0.
(3) when b 6= 0 and m = 0, the line is parallel to the x-axis and its equation is y = b.
⇒ y − y1 = m(x − x1 ), (6.6) x
Since, the slope m is undefined for lines parallel to the y-axis, the point-slope
form of the equation will not give the equation of a line through A (x1 , y1 )
parallel to the y-axis. However, this presents no difficulty, since for any such
line the abscissa of any point on the line is x1 . Therefore, the equation of such a
line is x = x1 .
(iii) Two Points form
If (x1 , y1 ) and (x2 , y 2 ) are any two points on the line with x2 6= x1 and y1 6= y2 , then the slope
(y2 − y1 )
is m = .
(x2 − x1 )
y2 − y1
The equation using point- slope form, we get y − y1 = (x − x1 ).
x 2 − x1
Rewriting the above equation, we get
(x2, y2)
y − y1 x − x1 y
= (6.7)
y2 − y 1 x 2 − x1
y − y1 x − x1
This equation is called two points form.
(x1, y1) y2 − y1= x2 − x1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Figure 6.23
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
x = ar + x1 and y = br + y1
x − x1 y − y1
= = r, (a 6= 0, b 6= 0) .
a b
y)
ing an angle θ with x-axis. Let P (x, y) be a
,
P(x
1)
1,y
point on the line at a distance r from Q. Drop r
y − y1
x
perpendiculars QN and PM respectively from
Q(
θ
Q andP to the x-axis and perpendicular QR R
x − x1
to PM.
From the right ∆QRP θ
N M x
x − x1 = QR = P Q cos θ = r cos θ
x − x1 Figure 6.24
Therefore = r (6.10)
cos θ
Similarly, y − y1 = RP = QP sin θ = r sin θ
y − y1
⇒ =r (6.11)
sin θ
where the parameter r is the distance between (x1 , y1 ) and any point (x, y) on the line. This is
called the symmetric form or parametric form of the line.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
The below table summarizes the types of straight lines related to the given information.
If we have two variable quantities, then each can be represented by a variable. If the rate of change
of one variable with respect to the other variable is constant, then the relationship between them is
linear.
In linear equation, the choice of one as independent and other as a dependent may represent the
physical reality or may be convenient fiction. The independent variable is normally plotted on the
horizontal axis (x-axis), the dependent variable on the vertical axis (y-axis). That is the values of x
are always independent and y is dependent on those values of x.
The number scales on the two axes need not be the same. Indeed, in many applications different
quantities are represented by x and y. For example, x may represent the number of mobile phones
sold and y the total revenue resulting from the sales. In such cases it is often desirable to choose
different number scales to represent the different quantities. However, that the zero of both number
scales coincide at the origin of the two-dimensional coordinate system.
From the given information, to solve the problem using the concepts of straight lines, we have to
select suitably one of the six equations given above.
Example 6.7 Find the slope of the straight line passing through the points (5,7) and (7,5). Also find
the angle of inclination of the line with the x-axis.
Solution:
Let (x1 , y1 ) and (x2 , y2 ) be (5,7) and (7,5) respectively. Let θ be y
the angle of inclination of the line with the x-axis
y2 − y 1 5−7
Slope of the line m = = = −1 (5, 7)
x2 − x1 7−5
(7, 5)
We know that m = tan θ 3π
3π
That is, tan θ = −1 ⇒ θ = or 135◦ 4
4 O x
Slope and angle of inclination of the line with the x-axis are
3π Figure 6.25
respectively m = −1 and θ =
4
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 6.8 Find the equation of a straight line cutting an intercept of 5 from the negative direction
of the y-axis and is inclined at an angle 150◦ to the x-axis.
Solution:
y
Given that the negative y intercept is 5 i.e., b = −5 and θ = 150◦
1
slope m = tan 150◦ = tan(180◦ − 30◦ ) = − tan 30◦ = − √ 150°
3
Slope and intercept form of the equation is y = mx + b. O x
1 −5
That is y = − √ x − 5.
3
√ √
x + 3y + 5 3 = 0
Figure 6.26
3 1
Example 6.9 Show the points 0, − , (1, −1) and 2, − are collinear.
2 2
Solution:
3 1
Let A, B and C be 0, − , (1, −1) and 2, − respectively.
2 2
3
−1 +
The slope of AB is 2 =1
1−0 2
1
− +1 1
The slope of BC is 2 =
2−1 2
Thus, the slope of AB is equal to slope of BC.
Hence, A, B and C are lying on the same line.
If the rate of change of one variable with respect to the other variable is constant, then
this constant rate of change can be taken as slope.(such as speed, constant increase or
constant decrease. . . ). Also equations of straight lines depend on the coordinate axes
how we define it. Thus in real world problems the equations are not necessarily identical
but the path and distance will always be the same.
Example 6.10 The Pamban Sea Bridge is a railway bridge of length about 2065 m constructed
on the PalkStrait, which connects the Island town of Rameswaram to Mandapam, the main land of
India. The Bridge is restricted to a uniform speed of only 12.5 m/s. If a train of length 560 m starts
at the entry point of the bridge from Mandapam, then
(i) find an equation of the motion of the train.
(ii) when does the engine touch island
(iii) when does the last coach cross the entry point of the bridge
(iv) what is the time taken by a train to cross the bridge.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Solution: y
Let the x-axis be the time in seconds the y-axis be the distance
Distance in metres
in metres. Let the engine be at the origin O. Therefore the length
of the train 560 m is the negative y-intercept.
The uniform speed 12.5 m/s is the slope of the motion of the y = 12.5x − 560
distance
train. speed = time
x
Since we are given slope and y-intercept, the equation of the O Time in seconds
line is − 560
y = mx + b (6.13)
Figure 6.27
(ii) When the engine touches the other side of the bridge (island)
y = 2065 and b = 0
2065 = 12.5x
x = 165.2 seconds.
(iii) When y = 0, the last coach cross the entry point of the bridge,
0 = 12.5x − 560
x = 44.8 seconds.
(iv) When y = 2065, the time taken for the train to cross the other end of the bridge is given by
(One may take the tail of the train as the origin and can find the equation of the straight line. It need
not be identical with the above equation, but the path traced out by the train, distance, time, etc.,will
be the same. Try it.)
Example 6.11 Find the equations of the straight lines, making the y- intercept of 7 and angle
between the line and the y-axis is 30◦
Solution:
There are two straight lines making 30◦ with the y-axis.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
y
From the figure, it is clear that the two lines make the angles 30°
60 and 120◦ with the x-axis
◦
B
√
Let m1 be tan 60◦ = 3 and
√ 30°
m2 be tan 120◦ = tan(180◦ − 60◦ ) = − tan 60◦ = − 3
√ √ 7
m1 = 3, m2 = − 3 and b = 7 60° 120°
Equations of lines are y = m1 x + b and y = m2 x + b O A x
√ √ C
y = 3x + 7 and y = − 3x + 7
Figure 6.28
Whenever two points are given, one can apply two points form or point and slope form.
Also when two intercepts are given, one can apply intercepts form or two points form
The following example, is solved in chapter V, using the concepts of sequence and
series. Let us solve this problem here, using the concepts of straight lines.
Example 6.12 The seventh term of an arithmetic progression is 30 and tenth term is 21.
(i) Find the first three terms of an A.P.
(ii) Which term of the A.P. is zero (if exists)
(iii) Find the relation ship between Slope of the straight line and common difference of A.P.
Solution:
Since there is a constant increase or decrease in arithmetic progression, it is a linear function.
Let the x-axis be the number of the term and the y-axis be the value of the term.
Let (x1 , y1 ) and (x2 , y2 ) be (7,30) and (10,21) respectively, using the equation
y − y1 = m(x − x1 ) we get
21 − 30
y − 30 = (x − 7)
10 − 7
y = −3x + 51 (6.14)
(i) Substituting x = 1, 2 and 3 in the equation (??) we get the first three terms of AP as 48, 45,
and 42.
(ii) Substituting y = 0 in equation (??) we get
0 = −3x + 51 ⇒ x = 17.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 6.13 The quantity demanded of a certain type of Compact Disk is 22,000 units when a
unit price is | 8. The customer will not buy the disk, at a unit price of | 30 or higher. On the other
side the manufacturer will not market any disk if the price is | 6 or lower. However, if the price
| 14 the manufacturer can supply 24,000 units. Assume that the quantity demanded and quantity
supplied are linearly proportional to the price. Find (i) the demand equation (ii) supply equation
(iii) the market equilibrium quantity and price. (iv) The quantity of demand and supply when the
price is | 10.
Solution:
Let the x-axis represent the number of units in thousands and the y-axis represent the price in
rupees per unit.
y
yS = 1 x + 6
3
(i) For demand function, let (x1 , y1 ) and (x2 , y2 ) be (22,8)
price in rupees
and (0,30) respectively.
Using two point form, we get the demand function as
yD = −x + 30
y−8 x − 22
=
30 − 8 0 − 22
⇒ yD = −x + 30 (demand function). O number of units x
Figure 6.29
(ii) For supply function, let (x1 , y1 ) and (x2 , y2 ) be (0,6) and (24,14)
respectively.
Using two point form, we get the supply function as
y−6 x−0
=
14 − 6 24 − 0
1
yS = x + 6(supply function).
3
(iii) At the market equilibrium the demand equals to supply,
1
That is, yD = yS ⇒ −x + 30 = x + 6
3
x = 18 and y = 12.
Example 6.14 Find the equation of the straight line passing through (− 1, 1) and cutting off equal
intercepts, but opposite in signs with the two coordinate axes.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Solution:
y
Let the intercepts cut off from the axes be of lengths a and −a.
∴ Equation of the line is of the form 2
x y
− = 1 ⇒ x − y = a.
a a
Since it passes through (−1, 1) −2 O x
⇒ (−1) − (1) = a ⇒ a = −2.
Equation of the line is x − y + 2 = 0.
Figure 6.30
Example 6.15 A straight line L with negative slope passes through the point (9, 4) cuts the positive
coordinate axes at the points P and Q. As L varies, find the minimum value of |OP | + |OQ|, where
O is the origin.
Solution:
Let m be the slope of the line L. Since it passes through the point (9, 4) the equation of the line
L is y − 4 = m(x − 9).
4
The points P and Q are respectively (9 − , 0) and (0, 4 − 9m) .
m
4
(m < 0) |OP | + |OQ| = 9 − + |4 − 9m|
m
4
= 9 + + |4 + 9k| (m < 0, take m = −k, k > 0)
k
4
= (9 + ) + (4 + 9k) (all terms are positive)
k
4
= (4 + 9) + ( + 9K)
r K
4
≥ 13 + 2 × 9K (Arithmetic mean ≥ Geometric mean)
K
|OP | + |OQ| ≥ 25
Example 6.16 The length of the perpendicular drawn from the origin to a line is 12 and makes an
angle 150◦ with positive direction of the x-axis. Find the equation of the line.
Solution:
Here, p = 12 and α = 150◦ , So the equation of the required line is of the form
x cos α + y sin α = p
That is, x cos 150◦ + y sin 150◦ = 12
√
⇒ 3x − y + 24 = 0
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 6.17 Area of the triangle formed by a line with the coordinate axes, is 36 square units.
Find the equation of the line if the perpendicular drawn from the origin to the line makes an angle
of 45◦ with positive the x-axis.
Solution:
Let p be the length of the perpendicular drawn from the origin to the required line.
The perpendicular makes 45◦ with the x-axis.
The equation of the required line is of the form,
x cos α + y sin α = p
⇒ x cos 45◦ + y sin 45◦ = p
√
⇒ x + y = 2p
√ √
This equation cuts the coordinate axes at A ( 2p, 0) and B(0, 2p) .
Area of the ∆OAB is
1 √ √
× 2p × 2p = 36 ⇒ p = 6 (∵ p is positive)
2
Therefore the equation of the required line is
√
x+y =6 2
Example √ 6.18 Find the equation of the lines make an angle 60◦ with positive x-axis and at a
distance 5 2 units measured from the point (4, 7), along the line x − y + 3 = 0.
Solution:
The angle of inclination of the line x − y + 3 = 0 is 45◦ , and a point on the line is (4, 7).
Using parametric form
x − x1 y − y1
= = r,
cos θ sin θ
That is x − 4 = y − 7 = ±5. √
The points on the lines at a distance 5 2 units either side of (4, 7) are
(4 + 5, 7 + 5) and (4 − 5, 7 − 5). √
The points on the lines are (9, 12) and (−1, 2) and the given slope is m = tan 60◦ = 3.
Therefore the required equations, using slope and a point form, we get
√ √
3x − y + (12 − 9 3) = 0 and
√ √
3x − y + (2 + 3) = 0
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(i) Slope and intercept form: (B 6= 0): The given equation can be written as
A C A C
y =− x− ⇒ slope = − and y-intercept = −
B B B B
(ii) Intercepts form: The given equation can be written as
x y
+ = 1 (A, B and C are all non-zero)
C C
− −
A B
Comparing with intercept form, we get
−C −C
x -intercept (a) = and y -intercept (b) =
A B
(iii) Normal form: Here A and B are not equal to zero,
Comparing Ax + By + C = 0, with x cos θ + y sin θ = p
−A −B |C|
We get √ x +√ y =√
A2 + B 2 A2 + B 2 A2 + B 2
−A −B |C|
Here cos α = √ , sin α = √ and p = √
A2 + B 2 A2 + B 2 A2 + B 2
√
Example 6.19 Express the equation 3x − y + 4 = 0 in the following equivalent form:
(i) Slope and Intercept form
(ii) Intercept form
(iii) Normal form
Solution:
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
If we take
√
− 3 1
cos α = and sin α = and p = 2
2 2
5π
⇒ α = 150◦ = and length of the normal (p) = 2
6
5π 5π
The normal form is x cos + y sin =2
6 6
To express the given equation to the required form, some times, it is more convenient
to use property the proportionality of the coefficients of like terms.
√
Example 6.20 Rewrite 3x + y + 4 = 0 in to normal form.
Solution:
√ x cos α + y sin α = p
The required form
Given form − 3x − y = 4 (∵ p is always positive)
Since both represent the same equation, the coefficients are proportional. We get,
cos α sin α p
√ = =
− 3 −1 4
√ 2
In componendo and dividendo,
cos α sin α p 2
cos α + sin α 1
√ = = =q √ = whenever a term is square off,
− 3 −1 4 2 2 2 then it should be square root off it.
− 3 + (−1)
√
− 3 −1 4
cos α = , sin α = and p =
2 2 2
7π
α = 210◦ = and p = 2
6
Normal form of the equation is
7π 7π
x cos + y sin =2
6 6
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Finding the shortest path between two points on a curved surface can often be difficult.
However, the length of a path on the surface of a cylinder is not changed if the curved
surface is flattened. For the following problem, by unrolling the hollow cylinder and
flattening it into a rectangle, a single reflection allows us to determine the ant’s path.
Example 6.21
Consider a hollow cylindrical vessel, with circumference 24 cm and height
10 cm. An ant is located on the outside of vessel 4 cm from the bottom. There
is a drop of honey at the diagrammatically opposite inside of the vessel, 3 cm
from the top. (i) What is the shortest distance the ant would need to crawl to
get the honey drop?. (ii) Equation of the path traced out by the ant. (iii) Where
the ant enter in to the cylinder?. Here is a picture that illustrates the position
of the ant and the honey. Figure 6.31
Solution:
By unrolling the hollow cylinder and flat-
tening it into a rectangle, and with a single
reflection allows us to determine the ant’s H(12, 13)
E = (8, 10)
Taking the orign at different location, different form of equation can be obtained, but
the path and distance are the same as above.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise - 6.2
1. Find the equation of the lines passing through the point (1,1)
(i) with y-intercept (−4)
(ii) with slope 3
(iii) and (-2, 3)
(iv) and the perpendicular from the origin makes an angle 60◦ with x- axis.
x y
2. If P (r, c) is mid point of a line segment between the axes, then show that + = 2.
r c
3. Find the equation of the line passing through the point (1, 5) and also divides the co-ordinate axes
in the ratio 3:10.
4. If p is length of perpendicular from origin to the line whose intercepts on the axes are a and b, then
1 1 1
show that 2 = 2 + 2 .
p a b
5. The normal boiling point of water is 100◦ C or 212◦ F and the freezing point of water is 0◦ C or
32◦ F . (i) Find the linear relationship between C and F
Find (ii) the value of C for 98.6◦ F and (iii) the value of F for 38◦ C
6. An object was launched from a place P in constant speed to hit a target. At the 15th second it was
1400 m away from the target and at the 18th second 800m away. Find (i) the distance between the
place and the target (ii) the distance covered by it in 15 seconds.(iii) time taken to hit the target.
7. Population of a city in the years 2005 and 2010 are 1,35,000 and 1,45,000 respectively.
Find the approximate population in the year 2015. (assuming that the growth of population is
constant)
8. Find the equation of the line, if the perpendicular drawn from the origin makes an angle 30◦ with
x-axis and its length is 12.
9. Find the equation of the straight lines passing through (8, 3) and having intercepts whose sum is 1
1
10. Show that the points (1, 3), (2, 1) and , 4 are collinear, by using (i) concept of slope (ii) using
2
a straight line and (iii) any other method
5
11. A straight line is passing through the point A(1, 2) with slope . Find points on the line which
12
are 13 units away from A.
12. A 150 m long train is moving with constant velocity of 12.5 m/s. Find (i) the equation of the motion
of the train, (ii) time taken to cross a pole. (iii) The time taken to cross the bridge of length 850 m
is?
13. A spring was hung from a hook in the ceiling. A number of different weights were attached to the
spring to make it stretch, and the total length of the spring was measured each time is shown in the
following table.
Weight (kg) 2 4 5 8
Length (cm) 3 4 4.5 6
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
14. A family is using Liquefied petroleum gas (LPG) of weight 14.2 kg for consumption. (Full weight
29.5kg includes the empty cylinders tare weight of 15.3kg.). If it is used with constant rate then it
lasts for 24 days. Then the new cylinder is replaced (i) Find the equation relating the quantity of
gas in the cylinder to the days. (ii) Draw the graph for first 96days.
Figure 6.33
6.4 Angle between two straight lines
Two straight lines in a plane would either be parallel or coincide or intersect. Normally when two
straight lines intersect, they form two angles at the point of intersection. One is an acute angle and
another is an obtuse angle or equal. Both these angles would be supplements(Sum equals 180◦ ) of
each other. By definition, when we say ‘angle between two straight lines’ we mean the acute angle
between the two lines.
Let y = m1 x + c1 and
y = m2 x + c2
be the equations of two straight lines and let these two lines make angles θ1 and θ2 with x- axis.
m2 − m1 θ1 θ2
⇒ tan φ =
1 + m2 m1
O x
m2 − m1
⇒ φ = tan−1
1 + m2 m1 Figure 6.34
m2 − m1
If is positive then φ is the acute angle and if it is negative φ is the obtuse
1 + m2 m1
−1 m2 − m1
angle between the two lines. Therefore, the acute angle φ is tan
1 + m2 m1
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
⇒ tan φ = 0
m2 − m1 O x
⇒ = 0 ⇒ m2 − m1 = 0 ⇒ m2 = m1
1 + m2 m1
That is parallel lines have the same slope. If two non-
Figure 6.35
vertical lines have the same slope, then they are parallel.
All vertical lines are parallel.
If the equation of the two lines are in general form as a1 x + b1 y + c1 = 0 and a2 x + b2 y + c2 = 0,
then the condition for lines to be parallel is
a1 b1
= or a1 b2 = a2 b1 .
a2 b2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Important Note: If m1 m2 = −1, then the two lines are perpendicular. But the converse is not
true, because the lines are parallel to the axes, the result cannot be applied, even when the lines are
perpendicular.
ax + by + c = 0 (6.20)
Figure 6.37
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Since the equations (6.20) and (6.21) represent the same equations the coefficients of like
terms are proportional.
√
cos α sin α p cos α sin α p cos2 α + sin2 α
= = ⇒ = = = √
a b −c a b −c ± a2 + b2
±a ±b ∓c
cos α = √ , sin α = √ and p = √
2
a +b 2 2
a +b 2 a2 + b2
Normal equation of CD is x cos α + y sin α = p0 (6.22)
Since it passes through P (x1 , y1 ), (6.22) ⇒ p0 = x1 cos α + y1 sin α
Required distance = |P M | = |QR| = |OQ − OR| = |p0 − p|
= | (x1 cos α + y1 sin α) − p|
ax 1 by 1 c ax1 + by1 + c
= ± √ ±√ ±√ = ± √
a2 + b2 a2 + b2 a2 + b2 a2 + b2
ax1 + by1 + c
Required distance = √
a2 + b2
(iii) The distance between two parallel lines a1 x + b1 y + c1 = 0 and a1 x + b1 y + c2 = 0 is
|c2 − c1 |
D=√ (It can be proved using above result by taking point (x1 , y1 ) as the origin)
a2 + b 2
Example 6.22 Find the equations of a parallel line and a perpendicular line passing through the
point (1, 2) to the line 3x+ 4y = 7.
Solution:
Parallel line to 3x+ 4y = 7 is of the form 3x+ 4y = 3x1 + 4y1 Let (x1 , y1 ) be (1, 2)
⇒ 3x + 4y = 3(1) + 4(2)
3x + 4y = 11
Perpendicular line to 3x+ 4y = 7 is of the form
4x − 3y = 4x1 − 3y1
Here (x1 , y1 ) = (1, 2)
⇒ 4x − 3y = 4(1) − 3(2)
4x − 3y = −2
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
3x + 4y = 11
4x − 3y = −2
Solution:
(i) Distance between two points (x1 y1 ) = (5, 4) and (x2 , y2 ) = (2, 0) is
q
D = (x2 − x1 )2 + (y2 − y1 )2
√
= 32 + 42
D = 5
−12 − 21
|c1 − c2 | = 25 = 2 .5 units.
D=p 1 = √
a2 + b2 1 3 +4 2×5
2 2
Example 6.24 Find the nearest point on the line 2x + y = 5 from the origin.
Solution:
The required point is the foot of the perpendicular from the origin on the line 2x + y = 5.
The line perpendicular to the given line, through the origin is x − 2y = 0.
Solving the equations 2x + y = 5 and x − 2y = 0, we get x = 2, y = 1
Hence the nearest point on the line from the origin is (2, 1).
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Alternate method:
Example 6.25 Find the equation of the bisector of the acute angle between the lines 3x+4y +2 = 0
and 5x + 12y − 5 = 0.
Solution:
First, let us make the constant term positives in both the equations.
The angle bisectors of the given equations are
3x + 4y + 2 −5x − 12y + 5
√ =± √ (moving point is equidistance from the lines)
32 + 42 52 + 122
Since a1 a2 + b1 b2 = −15 − 48 < 0, the equation of bisector of the acute angle between the lines is
3x + 4y + 2 −5x − 12y + 5
=+ ⇒ 64x + 112y + 1 = 0
5 13
Example 6.26 Find the points on the line x + y = 5, that lie at a distance 2 units from the line
4x + 3y − 12 = 0
Solution:
Any point on the line x + y = 5 is x = t, y = 5 − t
The distance from (t, 5 − t) to the line 4x + 3y − 12 = 0 is given by 2 units.
4(t) + 3(5 − t) − 12
∴ √ = 2
42 + 32
|t + 3|
⇒ = 2
5
⇒ t + 3 = ± 10 ⇒ t = −13, t = 7
Example 6.27 A straight line passes through a fixed point (6, 8). Find the locus of the foot of the
perpendicular drawn to it from the origin O.
Solution:
Let the point (x1 , y1 ) be (6, 8). and P (h, k) be a point on the required locus.
Family of equations of the straight lines passing through the fixed point (x1 , y1 ) is
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
⇒ k (k − 8) = −h(h − 6) ⇒ h2 + k 2 − 6h − 8k = 0
Locus of P (h, k) is x2 + y 2 − 6x − 8y = 0
This result shows from the fact that the angle in a semi circle is a right angle.
y y y
x
O x
O x
y = mx y=k x=h
Figure 6.39
It may seem that the equation of a straight line ax + by + c = 0 contains three arbitrary constants.
In fact, it is not so. On dividing it by b (or a, whichever is non-zero), we get
a c
x + y + = 0, which can be written as
b b
a c
Ax + y + C = 0 where A = and C = .
b b
The above equation can be written as slope and intercept form.
It follows that the equation of a straight line contains two arbitrary constants, and the number
of these arbitrary constants cannot be decreased further. Thus, the equation of every straight line
contains two arbitrary constants; consequently, two conditions are needed to determine the equation
of a straight line uniquely.
One condition yields a linear relation among two arbitrary constants and hence each arbitrary
constant determines the other. Therefore, the lines which satisfy one condition contain a single
arbitrary constant. Such a system of lines is called one parameter family of lines and the unknown
arbitrary constant is called, the parameter.
Let us now discuss the three types of families of straight lines, using y = mx + b. First two types
are one parameter families and third one is two parameters families
(i) when m is arbitrary and b is a fixed constant.
(ii) when b is arbitrary and m is a fixed constant.
(iii) when both m and b are arbitrary
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
y = mx +5
y Let us find the family of equations of straight lines for
m=4 m=1
the line y = m x+b by considering m is arbitrary constant
m= 1 and b is a fixed constant say b = 5. Therefore the equation,
3
for different real values of m, represents a family of lines
5 m = −2 with y-intercept 5 units. A few members of this family are
O x shown in figure. For example, in this diagram the slope
m = −1
1
m takes −1, −2, , 1 and 4
3
Figure 6.40
Example 6.28 Find the equations of the straight lines in the family of the lines y = mx + 2, for
which m and the x-coordinate of the point of intersection of the lines with 2x+3y = 10 are integers.
Solution:
To find the equations of straight lines for the family of line y = mx + 2, we have to determine
the values of the parameter m.
The point of intersection of the lines y = mx + 2 and 2x + 3y = 10 is
4 10m + 4
,
3m + 2 3m + 2
It is given that the slope m and the x-coordinate are integers.
4
∴ is an integer ⇒ 3m + 2 is a divisor of 4 ( ±1, ±2 and ± 4)
3m + 2
∴ 3m + 2 = ± 1, 3m + 2 = ± 2, 3m + 2 = ± 4, where m is an integer
shown in the figure. For example, in this diagram b can take values
2
b = −1
b = −3
Figure 6.41
Two special cases family of parallel lines and family of perpendicular lines are given below
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Family of parallel lines: Family of parallel lines to ax+by +c = 0 is of the form ax+by +λ = 0.
For different values of λ (call it lambda), we get different lines parallel to ax + by + c = 0.
Family of perpendicular lines: Family of perpendicular lines to ax + by + c = 0 is of the form
bx − ay + λ = 0. For different values of λ, we get different lines perpendicular to ax + by + c = 0.
1
can be visualized. Suppose the slope m takes −2, −4, , 1 and 3, O x
3
m = −4 m = −2
lines which pass through the fixed point (x1 , y1 ) except the vertical line
x = x1 as shown in the diagram. Figure 6.42
6.4.8 The family of equation of straight lines through the point of intersection of the two given
lines.
L1 = 0
λ=5 λ=2
y
L2 = 0 2
Let L1 ≡ a1 x + b1 y + c1 = 0 and L2 ≡ a2 x + b2 y + c2 = 0, λ=
5
P(x0, y0)
Example 6.29 Find the equation of the line through the intersection of the lines 3x + 2y + 5 = 0
and 3x − 4y + 6 = 0 and the point (1,1).
Solution:
The family of equations of straight lines through the point of intersection of the lines is of the
form (a1 x + b1 y + c1 ) + λ (a2 x + b2 y + c2 ) = 0
That is, (3x + 2y + 5) + λ (3x − 4y + 6) = 0
Since the required equation passes through the point (1,1), the point satisfies the above equation
Therefore {3 + 2(1) + 5} + λ {3(1) − 4(1) + 6} = 0 ⇒ λ = −2
Substituting λ = −2 in the above equation we get the required equation as 3x − 10y + 7 = 0
(verify the above problem by using two points form)
Example 6.30 Suppose the Government has decided to erect a new Electrical Power Transmission
Substation to provide better power supply to two villages namely A and B. The substation has to
to be on the line l. The distances of villages A and B from
the foot of the perpendiculars P and Q on the line l are B
3 km and 5 km respectively and the distance between P and
A l
Q is 6 km. (i) What is the smallest length of cable required to Q
connect the two villages. (ii) Find the equations of the cable P ?
lines that connect the power station to two villages. (Using the
knowledge in conjunction with the principle of reflection allows Figure 6.44
for approach to solve this problem.)
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Solution:
Take conveniently P Q as x-axis, P A as y-axis and P is the origin (instead of conventional origin
O). Therefore, the coordinates are P (0, 0), A(0, 3) and B(6, 5)
If the image of A about the x-axis is A, then A is (0, −3).
The required R is the point of intersection of the line AB and
x-axis.
AR and BR are the path of the cable (road)
Theq shortest length of the cable is AR + BR = BR + RA = y B
BA = (6 − 0)2 + (5 + 3)2 = 10 km A
5 − (−3) 5 km
Equation of the line AB is y − (−3) = (x − 0) 3 km
6−0
P R Q x
4x − 3y = 9
A
9
When y = 0, R is ,0
4 Figure 6.45
That is the substation should be located at a distance of 2.25 km
from P .
The equation of AR is 4x + 3y = 9
The equations of the cable lines (roads) of RA and RB are
4x − 3y = 9 and 4x + 3y = 9.
Example 6.31 A car rental firm has charges | 25 with 1.8 free kilometers, and | 12 for every
additional kilometer. Find the equation relating the cost y to the number of kilometers x. Also find
the cost to travel 15 kilometers
Solution:
y
Figure 6.46
The corresponding equation is
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 6.32 If a line joining two points (3, 0) and (5, 2) is rotated about the point (3, 0) in counter
clockwise direction through an angle 15◦ , then find the equation of the line in the new position
Solution:
Let P (3, 0) and Q (5, 2) be the given points.
y2 − y1
Slope of P Q = = 1 ⇒ the angle of inclination of
x2 − x 1
π
the line P Q = tan−1 (1) = = 45◦ y
4
∴ The slope of the line in new position is 15°
√ Q(5, 2)
m = tan(45◦ + 15◦ ) ⇒ Slope = tan(60◦ ) = ( 3) P(3, 0) x
∴ Equation
√ of the straight line passing through (3, 0) and with
the slope 3 is Figure 6.47
√
y − 0 = 3(x − 3)
√ √
3x − y − 3 3 = 0
Exercise - 6.3
1. Show that the lines are 3x + 2y + 9 = 0 and 12x + 8y − 15 = 0 are parallel lines.
2. Find the equation of the straight line parallel to 5x − 4y + 3 = 0 and having x-intercept 3.
3. Find the distance between the line 4x + 3y + 4 = 0, and a point (i) (−2, 4) (ii) (7, −3)
4. Write the equation of the lines through the point (1, −1)
(i) parallel to x + 3y − 4 = 0
(ii) perpendicular to 3x + 4y = 6
5. If (−4, 7) is one vertex of a rhombus and if the equation of one diagonal is 5x − y + 7 = 0, then
find the equation of another diagonal.
6. Find the equation of the lines passing through the point of intersection lines 4x − y + 3 = 0 and
5x + 2y + 7 = 0, and (i) through the point (−1, 2) (ii) Parallel to x − y + 5 = 0 (iii) Perpendicular
to x − 2y + 1 = 0
7. Find the equations of two straight lines which are parallel to the line 12x + 5y + 2 = 0 and at a
unit distance from the point (1, − 1).
8. Find the equations of straight lines which are perpendicular to the line 3x + 4y − 6 = 0 and are at
a distance of 4 units from (2, 1).
9. Find the equation of a straight line parallel to 2x + 3y = 10 and which is such that the sum of its
intercepts on the axes is 15.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
10. Find the length of the perpendicular and the co-ordinates of the foot of the perpendicular from
(−10, −2) to the line x + y − 2 = 0
11. If p1 and p2 are the lengths of the perpendiculars from the origin to the straight lines
x sec θ + y cosec θ = 2a and x cos θ − y sin θ = a cos 2θ, then prove that p21 + p22 = a2 .
12. Find the distance between the parallel lines
(i) 12x + 5y = 7 and 12x + 5y + 7 = 0
(ii) 3x − 4y + 5 = 0 and 6x − 8y − 15 = 0.
13. Find the family of straight lines (i) Perpendicular (ii) Parallel to 3x + 4y − 12 = 0.
14. If the line joining two points A(2,0) and B(3,1) is rotated about A in anticlockwise direction
through an angle of 15o , then find the equation of the line in new position.
15. A ray of light coming from the point (1,2) is reflected at a point A on the x-axis and it passes
through the point (5,3). Find the co-ordinates of the point A.
16. A line is drawn perpendicular to 5x = y + 7. Find the equation of the line if the area of the triangle
formed by this line with co-ordinate axes is 10 sq. units.
17. Find the image of the point (−2, 3) about the line x + 2y − 9 = 0.
18. A photocopy store charges | 1.50 per copy for the first 10 copies and | 1.00 per copy after the 10th
copy. Let x be the number of copies, and let y be the total cost of photocopying. (i) Draw graph of
the cost as x goes from 0 to 50 copies. (ii) Find the cost of making 40 copies
19. Find atleast two equations of the straight lines in the family of the lines y = 5x + b, for which b
and the x-coordinate of the point of intersection of the lines with 3x − 4y = 6 are integers.
20. Find all the equations of the straight lines in the family of the lines y = mx − 3, for which m and
the x-coordinate of the point of intersection of the lines with x − y = 6 are integers.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
The above equation suggests that the general equation of a pair of straight lines passing through the
origin with slopes m1 and m2 , ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 = 0 is a homogenous equation of degree two,
implying that the degree of each term is 2.
Nature of the homogenous equations tells us whether the lines pass through the origin.
5x2 + 6xy + y 2 = 0
5x2 + 5xy + xy + y 2 = 0
5x (x + y) + y (x + y) = 0
(5x + y) (x + y) = 0
5x2 + 6xy + y 2 = 0 by x2
y y 2
We get 5 + 6 + = 0
x x
y
Substitute = m (slope of the lines for homogenous equation)
x
The above equation becomes m2 + 6m + 5 = 0
Factorizing, we get (m + 1) (m + 5) = 0
⇒ m = −1, m = −5
y y
⇒ = −1, = −5
x x
That is, the lines are x + y = 0, 5x + y = 0
Example 6.34 If exists, find the straight lines by separating the equations 2x2 + 2xy + y 2 = 0.
Solution:
Since the given equation is a homogeneous equation, divide the given equation 2x2 + 2xy + y 2 = 0
y
by x2 and substituting = m
x
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
We get m2 + 2m + 2 = 0
The values of m (slopes) are not real (complex number), therefore no line will exist with the
joint equation 2x2 + 2xy + y 2 = 0
We sometimes say that this equation represents imaginary lines.
Note that in the entire plane, only (0, 0) satisfies this equation
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 6.35 Find the equation of the pair of lines through the origin and perpendicular to the
pair of lines ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 = 0
Solution:
Let m1 and m2 be the slopes of these two lines.
y − m1 x = 0 and y − m2 x = 0 (6.31)
(y − m1 x) (y − m2 x) = 0
y − (m1 + m2 ) xy + m1 m2 x2 = 0
2
(6.32)
Given that
ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 = 0 (6.33)
−2h a
Thus, m1 + m2 = and m1 m2 = (6.34)
b b
The lines perpendicular to (6.31) are
1 1
y+ x = 0 and y + x=0
m1 m2
The combined equation is
(m1 y + x) (m2 y + x) = 0
m1 m2 y + (m1 + m2 ) xy + x2 = 0
2
a 2 2h
By using (6.34) y − xy + x2 = 0
b b
6.5.3 Equation of the bisectors of the angle between the lines ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 = 0
Let the equations of the two straight lines be y − m1 x = 0 and y − m2 x = 0
2h a
∴ m1 + m2 = − and m1 m2 =
b b
We know that the equation of bisectors is the locus of points from which the perpendicular drawn
to the two straight lines are equal.
Let P (p, q) be any point on the locus of bisectors.
The perpendiculars from P (p, q) to the line y − m1 x = 0 is equal to the perpendicular from
P (p, q) to y − m2 x = 0
q − m1 p q − m2 p
±p 2
= ±p
1 + m1 1 + m22
(q − m1 p)2 1 + m22 = (q − m2 p)2 1 + m21
That is,
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
2 2 1 − m1 m2
Simplifying we get p −q = 2pq
m +m
1 2
a
1−
⇒ p2 − q 2 = 2pq
b
2h
−
b
p2 − q 2 pq
That is =
a−b h
x2 − y 2 xy
∴ The locus of P (p, q) is = (6.36)
a−b h
Example 6.36 Show that the straight lines x2 − 4xy +y 2 = 0 and x + y = 3 form an equilateral
triangle.
Solution:
Let the line x + y = 3 intersects the pair of line x2 -4xy + y 2 = 0 at A and B.
The angle between the lines x2 − 4xy +y 2 = 0 is
√ 2 √
2 h − ab 2 4 − 1 √
tan θ =
= = 3
a+b 2
√
⇒ θ = tan−1 3 = 60◦ y
0
=
B
y
x-
x2 − y 2 xy
=
a−b h x+y = 3
2 2
⇒x −y = 0 A
30O
⇒ x + y = 0 and x − y = 0 O
30
x
O
The angle bisectors x − y = 0 is perpendicular to the given
line through AB,
Figure 6.50
that is x + y = 3 ⇒ ∆OAB is isosceles.
⇒ ∠ABO = ∠BAO = 60◦
x2 − 2cxy − y 2 = 0 (6.37)
x2 − 2dxy − y 2 = 0 (6.38)
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
x2 − y 2 xy
=
2 −c
⇒ cx2 + 2xy − cy 2 = 0 (6.39)
x2 − 2dxy − y 2 = 0
cx2 + 2xy − cy 2 = 0
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Since each of the above equations represents a straight line, they must be of the first degree in x
and y. Therefore the expression under the radical sign should be a perfect square and the condition
for this is
4 (gh − af )2 − 4 h2 − ab g 2 − ac = 0
y
ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 = 0 (6.41)
P
ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 + 2gx + 2f y + c = 0) (6.42)
x2 , xy and y 2 .
Figure 6.51
(i) If the equation ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 + 2gx + 2f y + c = 0 represents a pair of straight lines, then
ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 = 0 represents a pair of straight lines through the origin parallel to the first
pair. The point of intersection (6.41) is (0, 0) and the point of intersection (6.42) is
hf − bg gh − af
P ,
ab − h2 ab − h2
(ii) If θ be the angle between the straight lines represented by the equation
ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 + 2gx + 2f y + c = 0, then it will have the same value as the angle between
the two lines represented by ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 = 0
√ 2
−1 2 h − ab
Thus θ = tan
a+b
(iii) If the two straight lines represented by the equation ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 + 2gx + 2f y + c = 0 are
at right angles, then the two lines represented by ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 = 0 are also at right angles
and the condition is a + b = 0
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 6.38 If the equation λx2 − 10xy + 12y 2 + 5x− 16y− 3 = 0 represents a pair of straight
lines, find (i) the value of λ and the separate equations of the lines (ii) point of intersection of the
lines (iii) angle between the lines
Solution:
(i) general equation is ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 + 2gx + 2f y + c = 0
Comparing the given equation with the general equation of the second degree we have
5
a = λ, b = 12, c = −3, h = −5, g = , f = −8
2
Now applying the condition for pair of straight lines
2c1 + c2 = 5, 3c1 + c2 = 8, c1 c2 = −3
x − 2y + 3 = 0 and 2x − 6y − 1 = 0
(ii) Point of intersection of the lines is given by solving the two equation of the lines, we get
7 hf − bg hg − af
(x, y) = −10, − or use the formula ,
2 ab − h2 ab − h2
(iii) Angle between the lines is given by
√ 2
2 h − ab
tan θ =
a+b
√
2 25 − 24 1
= =
2 + 12
7
1
∴ θ = tan−1
7
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Example 6.39 A student when walks from his house, at an average speed of 6 kmph, reaches his
school ten minutes before the school starts. When his average speed is 4 kmph, he reaches his school
five minutes late. If he starts to school every day at 8.00 A.M, then find (i) the distance between his
house and the school (ii) the minimum average speed to reach the school on time and time taken
to reach the school (iii) the time the school gate closes (iv) the pair of straight lines of his path of
walk.
Solution:
Let x-axis be the time in hours and y-axis be the distance in kilometer.
From the given information, we have
10
y = 6(x − ) ⇒ y = 6x − 1 (6.43)
60
5 1
y = 4(x + ) ⇒ y = 4x + (6.44)
60 3
2
Solving the above two equations, we get (x, y) = ,3
3
2
x= hour = 40 minutes, y = 3 km
3
(i) the distance between house and the school is 3km
(ii) the minimum average speed to reach the school on time is
60
× 3 = 4.5 kmph
40
2
and time taken is hours or 40 minutes
3
(iii) the school gate closes at 8.40 AM
(iv) the pair of straight lines of his path of walk to school is
1
(6x − y − 1) 4x − y + =0
3
72x2 − 30xy + 3y 2 − 6x + 2y − 1 = 0 (6.45)
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
m m1 = −1 or m m2 = −1
⇒ (m m1 + 1 ) = 0 or (m m2 + 1 ) = 0
⇒ (m m1 + 1 )(m m2 + 1 ) = 0
⇒ (m1 m2 )m2 + (m1 + m2 )m + 1 = 0
a p 2
2h
p
⇒ − + − − + 1 = 0
b q b q
⇒ ap2 + 2hpq + bq 2 = 0
The pair of straight lines through the origin is a homogeneous equation of degree two
Example 6.41 Show that the straight lines joining the origin to the points of intersection of
3x − 2y + 2 = 0 and 3x2 + 5xy − 2y 2 + 4x + 5y = 0 are at right angles
Solution:
The straight lines joining the origin and the points of intersection of given equations is a second
degree homogeneous equation.
Following steps show, the way of homogenizing the 3x2 + 5xy − 2y 2 + 4x + 5y = 0 with
3x − 2y + 2 = 0
(3x − 2y)
3x2 + 5xy − 2y 2 + (4x + 5y)(1) = 0 and =1
−2
2 2 3x − 2y
3x + 5xy − 2y + (4x + 5y) = 0
−2
(−2)(3x2 + 5xy − 2y 2 ) + (4x + 5y)(3x − 2y) = 0
On simplification,
We get, 2x2 − xy − 2y 2 = 0. ⇒ a = 2, b = −2 ⇒ a + b = 0
Since sum of the co-efficient of x2 and y 2 is equal to zero, the lines are at right angles
Exercise - 6.4
1. Find the combined equation of the straight lines whose separate equations are x − 2y − 3 = 0 and
x + y + 5 = 0.
2. Show that 4x2 + 4xy + y 2 − 6x − 3y − 4 = 0 represents a pair of parallel lines.
3. Show that 2x2 + 3xy − 2y 2 + 3x + y + 1 = 0 represents a pair of perpendicular lines.
4. Show that the equation 2x2 − xy − 3y 2 − 6x + 19y − 20 = 0 represents a pair of intersecting lines.
Show further that the angle between them is tan−1 (5).
5. Prove that the equation to the straight lines through the origin, each of which makes an angle α
with the straight line y = x is x2 − 2xy sec 2α + y 2 = 0
6. Find the equation of the pair of straight lines passing through the point (1, 3) and perpendicular to
the lines 2x − 3y + 1 = 0 and 5x + y − 3 = 0
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
6x2 + 5xy − py 2 + 7x + qy − 5 = 0
12. Find the value of k, if the following equation represents a pair of straight lines. Further, find
whether these lines are parallel or intersecting, 12x2 + 7xy − 12y 2 − x + 7y + k = 0
13. For what value of k does the equation 12x2 + 2kxy + 2y 2 + 11x − 5y + 2 = 0 represent two straight
lines.
14. Show that the equation 9x2 − 24xy + 16y 2 − 12x + 16y − 12 = 0 represents a pair of parallel lines.
Find the distance between them.
15. Show that the equation 4x2 + 4xy + y 2 − 6x − 3y − 4 = 0 represents a pair of parallel lines. Find
the distance between them.
16. Prove that one of the straight lines given by ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 = 0 will bisect the angle between
the co-ordinate axes if (a + b)2 = 4h2
17. If the pair of straight lines x2 − 2kxy − y 2 = 0 bisect the angle between the pair of straight lines
x2 − 2lxy − y 2 = 0, Show that the later pair also bisects the angle between the former.
18. Prove that the straight lines joining the origin to the points of intersection of
3x2 + 5xy − 3y 2 + 2x + 3y = 0 and 3x − 2y − 1 = 0 are at right angles.
Exercise - 6.5
Choose the correct or more suitable answer
1. The equation of the locus of the point whose distance from y-axis is half the distance from origin is
(1) x2 + 3y 2 = 0 (2) x2 − 3y 2 = 0 (3) 3x2 + y 2 = 0 (4) 3x2 − y 2 = 0
2. Which of the following equation is the locus of (at2 , 2at)
x2 y 2 x2 y 2
(1) − = 1 (2) + 2 =1 (3) x2 + y 2 = a2 (4) y 2 = 4ax
a2 b2 a2 b
3. Which of the following point lie on the locus of 3x2 + 3y 2 − 8x − 12y + 17 = 0
(1) (0, 0) (2) (−2, 3) (3) (1, 2) (4) (0, −1)
2 2
x y
4. If the point (8,−5) lies on the locus − = k, then the value of k is
16 25
(1) 0 (2) 1 (3) 2 (4) 3
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
5. Straight line joining the points (2, 3) and (−1, 4) passes through the point (α, β) if
(1) α + 2β = 7 (2) 3α + β = 9 (3) α + 3β = 11 (4) 3α + β = 11
◦
6. The slope of the line which makes an angle 45 with the line 3x − y = −5 are
1 1
(1) 1, −1 (2) , −2 (3) 1, (4) 2, − 21
2 2
7. Equation of the straight
√ line that forms an isosceles triangle with coordinate axes in the I-quadrant
with perimeter 4 + 2 2 is
√ √
(1) x + y + 2 = 0 (2) x + y − 2 = 0 (3) x + y − 2 = 0 (4) x + y + 2 = 0
8. The coordinates of the four vertices of a quadrilateral are (−2,4), (−1,2), (1,2) and (2,4) taken in
order.The equation of the line passing through the vertex (−1,2) and dividing the quadrilateral in
the equal areas is
(1) x+ 1 = 0 (2) x + y = 1 (3) x + y + 3 = 0 (4) x − y + 3 = 0
9. The intercepts of the perpendicular bisector of the line segment joining (1, 2) and (3,4) with
coordinate axes are
(1) 5, −5 (2) 5, 5 (3) 5, 3 (4) 5, −4
10. √
The equation of the line with slope 2 and the length of the perpendicular from the origin equal to
5 is
√ √
(1) x − 2y = 5 (2) 2x − y = 5 (3) 2x − y = 5 (4) x − 2y − 5 = 0
11. A line perpendicular to the line 5x − y = 0 forms a triangle with the coordinate axes. If the area
of the triangle is 5 sq. units, then its equation is
√ √ √ √
(1) x+ 5y ± 5 2 = 0 (2) x− 5y ± 5 2 = 0 (3) 5x + y ± 5 2 = 0 (4) 5x − y ± 5 2 = 0
12. Equation of the straight line perpendicular to the linex−y+5 = 0, through the point of intersection
the y-axis and the given line
(1) x − y − 5 = 0 (2) x + y − 5 = 0 (3) x + y + 5 = 0 (4) x + y + 10 = 0
13. If the equation of the base opposite to the vertex (2, 3) of an equilateral triangle is x + y = 2, then
the length of a side is
q
3
√ √
(1) 2
(2) 6 (3) 6 (4) 3 2
14. The line (p + 2q)x + (p − 3q)y = p − q for different values of p and q passes through the point
3 5 2 2 3 3 2 3
(1) , (2) , (3) , (4) ,
2 2 5 5 5 5 5 5
15. The point on the line 2x − 3y = 5 is equidistance from (1,2) and (3, 4) is
(1) (7, 3) (2) (4, 1) (3) (1, −1) (4) (−2, 3)
16. The image of the point (2, 3) in the line y = −x is
(1) (−3, −2) (2) ( −3, 2 ) (3) ( −2, −3) (4) ( 3, 2 )
x y
17. The length of ⊥ from the origin to the line − = 1, is
3 4
11 5 12 5
(1) (2) (3) (4) −
5 12 5 12
18. The y-intercept of the straight line passing through (1,3) and perpendicular to 2x − 3y + 1 = 0 is
3 9 2 2
(1) (2) (3) (4)
2 2 3 9
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
19. If the two straight lines x + (2k − 7)y + 3 = 0 and 3kx + 9y − 5 = 0 are perpendicular then the
value of k is
1 2 3
(1) k = 3 (2) k = (3) k = (4) k =
3 3 2
20. If a vertex of a square is at the origin and its one side lies along the line 4x + 3y − 20 = 0, then
the area of the square is
(1) 20 sq. units (2) 16 sq. units (3) 25 sq. units (4) 4 sq.units
21. If the lines represented by the equation 6x2 + 41xy − 7y 2 = 0 make angles α and β with x- axis,
then tan α tan β =
6 6 7 7
(1) − (2) (3) − (4)
7 7 6 6
2 2
22. The area of the triangle formed by the lines x − 4y = 0 and x = a is
√
3 2 1 2
(1) 2a2 (2) a (3) a2 (4) √ a2
2 2 3
2 2
23. If one of the lines given by 6x − xy + 4cy = 0 is 3x + 4y = 0,, then c equals to
(1) −3 (2) −1 (3) 3 (4) 1
2 cos θ + 3 sin θ
24. θ is acute angle between the lines x2 − xy − 6y 2 = 0, then is
4 sin θ + 5 cos θ
1 5 1
(1) 1 (2) − (3) (4)
9 9 9
25. One of the equation of the lines given by x2 + 2xy cot θ − y 2 = 0 is
(1) x − y cot θ = 0 (2) x + y tan θ = 0 (3) x cos θ + y (sin θ + 1) = 0
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Summary
The types of straight lines related to the information.
y − y1 x − x1
3 Two points(x1 , y1 ) and (x2 , y2 ) =
y2 − y 1 x2 − x1
x y
4 x-intercept (a) and y-intercept (b) + =1
a b
x − x1 y − y1
6 Parametric form: parameter-r = =r
cos θ sin θ
A point P (x1 , y1 )is on the origin side or non origin side of the line ax + by + c = 0 (c 6= 0),
according as ax1 + by1 + c and c are of the same sign or opposite sign.
The distance between two points (x1 , y1 ) and (x2 , y 2 ) is given by the formula
q
D = (x2 − x1 )2 + (y2 − y1 )2
ax1 + by1 + c
The distance from a point P (x1 , y1 ) to a line ax + by + c = 0 is √
a2 + b2
|c2 − c1 |
The distance between two parallel lines a1 x + b1 y + c1 = 0 and a1 x + b1 y + c2 = 0 is √
a2 + b2
The line parallel to ax + by + c = 0 through a point (x1 , y1 ), is ax + by = ax1 + by1
and the perpendicular line is bx − ay = bx1 − ay1
285 Summary
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
The coordinates of the image of the point (x1 , y1 ) with respect to the line ax + by + c = 0 can
be obtained by the line
x − x1 y − y1 2(ax1 + by1 + c)
= =−
a b a2 + b2
Pair of straight lines Condition for parallel Condition for perpendicular
ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 = 0 h2 − ab = 0, a+b=0
The equation of the bisectors of the angle between the lines ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 = 0 is
x2 − y 2 xy
=
a−b h
.
The condition that the general second degree equation ax2 + 2hxy + by 2 + 2gx + 2f y + c = 0
should represent a pair of straight lines is abc + 2f gh − af 2 − bg 2 − ch2 = 0
√ 2
-1 2 h − ab
(i) The angle between them is θ = tan
a+b
If a + b = 0, then the lines are perpendicular.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
ICT CORNER-6(a)
Expected Outcome ⇒
Step – 1
Open the Browser and type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code.
Step – 2
GeoGebra work book called “XI STD Analytical Geometry” will open. There are more than 5
worksheets given. Select the one you want. For example, select “Locus: Angular Bisector”
Step – 3
Locus: Angular Bisector work sheet will open. In the page move the point D to see the locus of the
point D
Step – 4
The point D moves such that its perpendicular distance from two fixed lines are equal. Justify the
locus.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
ICT CORNER-6(b)
Expected Outcome ⇒
Step–1
Open the Browser and type the URL Link given below (or) Scan the QR Code.
Step–2
GeoGebra work book called “XI STD Analytical Geometry” will open. There are 7 worksheets given.
Select the one you want. For example, select “Pair of Straight Line in Double End Cone”
Step–3
A plane cuts the Double end Cone at 4 points at its edges and also it passes through the Vertex. Now
If you move by holding the points E or D the plane moves. You can observe at any position you get a
pair of straight line. You can rotate the picture in any direction. Explore.
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Answers
Exercise 1.1
(1) (i) {2, 3, 5, 7} (ii) {1} (iii) {1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, 10} (iv) {−5}
(2) {x ∈ R : x2 = 1}
(3) (i) finite (ii) infinite (iii) infinite (iv) infinite (v) infinite
(5) not true (6) 0 (7) 128 (8) {0, 1, 2, 3}
(9) A = {x, y, z} and B = {1, 2} (10) {(−1, 0), (−1, 1), (0, 2), (1, 2)}
Exercise 1.2
(1) (i) reflexive; not symmetric; transitive (ii) not reflexive; symmetric; not transitive
(iii) reflexive; not symmetric ;not transitive (iv) reflexive; symmetric
(v) R is an empty set; not reflexive; symmetric; transitive
(2) (i) (c, c) and (d, d) (ii) (c, a)
(iii) nothing to include (iv) (c, c), (d, d), (c, a) to be included
(3) (i) (c, c) (ii) (c, a) (iii) nothing (iv) (c, c) and (c, a)
(5) {(3, 8), (6, 6), (9, 4), (12, 2)}; not reflexive; not symmetric; transitive; not an equivalence relation
(7) R = {(1, 1), (1, 2), (1, 3), (1, 4), (1, 5), (2, 1), (2, 2), (2, 3), (2, 4), (3, 1), (3, 2), (3, 3), (4, 1),
(4, 2), (5, 1)}; not reflexive; symmetric; not transitive; not equivalence
(8) smallest set is {(a, a), (b, b), (c, c)}; largest set is A × A
Exercise 1.3
290
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise 2.1
√ 1
(1) 7 ∈ R − Q,
− ∈ Q, 0 ∈ Z, Q,
4
22
3.14 ∈ Q, 4 ∈ N, Z, Q, ∈Q
√ √ 7 √ √ 1
(3) yes, 4 + 3, 2 + 3 (4) yes, 2 + 3, 2 − 3 (5)
21001
Exercise 2.2
11 13
(1)(i) −4 < x < 10 (ii) R (iii) ≤x≤ (iv) −7 < x < 7
3 3
5 7 −7 7 15 11
(2) −∞, ∪ ,∞ (3) −∞, ∪ , ∞ (4) − ≤ x ≤
12 12 3 3 2 2
3 7
(5) − < x < (6) no solution
10 10
Exercise 2.3
Exercise 2.4
√
2 2 2 2 2 1
(1) x − 4x − 21 = 0 (2) − (x − 2x − 4) (3) x + x+ =0
5 3 3
(6) (i) b = 0 (ii) 3b2 = 16ac (iii) c = a
291
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(8) (i) real and distinct (ii) real and distinct (iii) real and distinct
(9) (i) not intersect (ii) intersect at two points (iii) touch at only one point
2 2
5 3
(10) x + −
2 2
Exercise 2.5
5
(1) −3, (2) [1, 2]
2
Exercise 2.6
√ √
5 5 3 + 53 3 − 53 3
(1) − and (2) and (3) x = ±2 (4) x = − or − 1
2 2 2 2 5
Exercise 2.7
√ √
(1)(x2 + 2x + 1)(x2 − 2x + 1) (2) a = 5
Exercise 2.8
3
(1) (0, 1) ∪ (2, ∞) (2) −∞, ∪ (2, 4) (3) (−3, −2] ∪ [2, 5)
2
Exercise 2.9
1 1 7 2
(1) − (2) +
2a(x − a) 2a(x + a) 3(x − 2) 3(x + 1)
1 2 −3x + 1 1 1
(3) + + 2
(4) 2
+
6(x − 1) 15(x + 2) 10(x + 1) (x − 1) (x − 1)3
1 2 1 2
(5) 2
− 2
(6) − 2
2(x − 1) 2(x + 1) x x +1
13 7 9 13
(7) 1 + − (8) x + −
x−3 x−2 x+2 x+3
14 11 14 4 2x − 3
(9) − − 2
+ (10) + 2
9(x + 1) 3(x + 1) 9(x − 2) x+1 x +1
2 1 3 4 − 3x
(11) 2 + − (12) + 2
x+3 x−1 x+1 x +1
Exercise 2.11
1 1 1 1
(1)(i) 25 (ii) (iii) (iv) (v)
8 100 9 3
1 1
(2) 8 (3) √ (4) (5) 2
2 2
292
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
√ √ √ √
21 + 7 2 + 3 6 + 2 3 2+2 6
(6) (7) 5 (8)
7 5
Exercise 2.12
Exercise 3.1
(1)(i) first quadrant (ii) second quadrant (iii) fourth quadrant (iv) fourth quadrant
(v) second quadrant
(2)(i) 35◦ (ii) 165◦ (iii) 70◦ (iv) 90◦ (v) 270◦ (8) k ∈ [−1, 1]
p2 + 1 p2 − 1 p2 − 1 2 2
(9) sec θ = ; tan θ = ; sin θ = 2 (12) c2 + bd = (ad + cb)2 + ac − b2
2p 2p p +1
Exercise 3.2
π 3π 41π 5π 11π
(1)(i) radians (ii) radians (iii) − radians (iv) radians (v) radians
6 4 36 6 6
(2)(i) 60◦ (ii) 20◦ (iii) 72◦ (iv) 420◦ (v) 200◦
20π
(3) r ≈ 31.82 meters (4) s = = 20.92cm (5) θ = 12◦ 360 (6) s = 7.16feet
3
(7) r1 : r2 = 5 : 4
3π
(8) Angle of sector ≈ 65◦ 270 1600 (9) 6000◦ (10) 14◦ (11)
4
Exercise 3.3
√ √
3 1 1 1 1 √ 3
(1)(i) (ii) − (iii) (iv) − √ (v) − √ (vi) 3 (vii)
2 √2 2 3 √ 3 2
2 6 5 2 6
(2) sin θ = ; cos θ = ; tan θ = ;
7 7 5
7 7 5
cosec θ = √ ; sec θ = ; cot θ = √
2 6 5 2 6
293
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
√
3 2 √ 1
(3)(i) sin θ = − ; cosec θ = − √ ; sec θ = −2; tan θ = 3; cot θ = √
√2 3 √ 3
5 3 3 5 2
(ii) sin θ = ; cosec θ = √ ; sec θ = ; tan θ = ; cot θ = √
√3 5 2 2 √5
5 3 3 2 5
(iii) cos θ = ; cosec θ = − ; sec θ = √ ; tan θ = − √ ; cot θ = −
3 2 5 5 √2
√ 1 1 2 5
(iv) sec θ = − 5; cos θ = − √ ; cot θ = − ; sin θ = √ ; cosec θ = ;
5 2 5 2
5 12 13 12 5
(v) cos θ = ; sin θ = − ; cosec θ = − ; tan θ = − ; cot θ = − ;
13 13 12 5 12
(5) θ = 60◦ , 120◦ , 240◦ , 300◦ ,
Exercise 3.4
220 171 220
(1)(i) sin(x + y) = (ii) cos(x − y) = (iii) tan(x + y) =
221 221 21
187 156 4
(2)(i) sin(A + B) = (ii) cos(A − B) = (3) cos(x − y) =
205 205 5
√ √
87 1− 3 3+1
(4) sin(x − y) = − (5) cos 105◦ = √ ; sin 105◦ = √ ;
425 2 2 2 2
√
7π
tan = −(2 + 3)
2
√12 2
(7) 4x − 2 6x + 1 = 0 (16) 0 (22) 1 (24) 11
Exercise 3.5
√
161 7 3713 2 3 1
(1)(i) (ii) − (iii) (2)(i) , √
289 25 4225 5 3 2
Exercise 3.6
1 1 1
(1)(i) [sin 63◦ + sin 7◦ ] (ii) [sin 6x + sin 2x] (iii) [sin 12θ + sin 8θ]
2 2 2
1 1
(iv) [cos 7θ + cos 3θ] (v) [cos θ − cos 9θ] (2)(i) 2 cos 55◦ sin 20◦
2 2
(ii) 2 cos 40◦ cos 25◦ (iii) 2 sin 45◦ cos 5◦ (iv) 2 sin 55◦ sin 20◦
Exercise 3.8
π n
π
(1)(i) θ = − ; θ = nπ + (−1) − . n∈Z
4 4
π π
(ii) θ= ; θ = nπ + , n∈Z
6 6
π −π
(iii) θ = − ; θ = nπ + , n ∈Z
6 6
π 3π 2π 4π
(2)(i) x = 0, , π, (ii) x = , ,π
2 2 3 3
π π 5π
(iii) x= , , (iv) x = 0, π
2 6 6
294
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
π nπ π
(3)(i) x = (2n + 1) or x = + (−1)n , n ∈Z
6 2 12
n π n π
(ii) θ = nπ + (−1) or θ = nπ + (−1) n ∈Z
6 2
π
(iii) θ = (2n + 1) or θ = 2nπ, n ∈ Z
4
nπ π
(iv) θ= or θ = nπ ± , n ∈ Z
3 3
2nπ −π
(v) θ = 2nπ or θ = + , n∈Z
3 6
π
(vi) θ = (8n + 1) , n∈Z
4
π π
(vii) θ = 2nπ + ± , n ∈ Z
6 3
π 2π
(viii) θ = 2nπ − ± , n∈Z
2 3
nπ π
(ix) θ= + , n∈Z
3 18
π
(x) θ = nπ ± , n∈Z
10
π
(xi) x = 2nπ ± n∈Z
3
Exercise 3.9
√
(2) ∠A = 75◦ (9) 40m, 40m, 40m (10) 4m, 4m, 4m and 4 3 sq.meter.
Exercise 3.10 √
5 2 √
(1) no such triangle exist (3) ∠A = 15◦ , ∠B = 105◦ (7) √ km (8) 2 13 km
√ 3−1
(9) 3 + 73 km (10) 7 km
√
(11) Total Cost: 155800 and Perimeter 180 + 20 27feet
p √
(12) x = 100 km (13) 5 − 2 2 km
√ √ √
(14) 2 6 + 2 3 + 6 km (15) AB = 10 3 km
Exercise 3.11
π π π 3π π
(1)(i) θ = (ii) θ = (iii) θ = − (iv) θ = (v) θ =
4 6 2 4 3
Exercise 3.12
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
(4) (1) (1) (1) (4) (4) (1) (2) (4) (2) (3) (2) (3) (3) (2)
16 17 18 19 20
(4) (1) (1) (1) (1)
295
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise 4.1
(1)(i) 17 (ii) 6 (iii) 20 (iv) 720 (v) 120
(2)(i) 151200 (ii) 24 (3)(i) 12 (ii) 24 (4)(i) 64 (ii) 24
(5)(i) 90 (ii) 64 (6)(i) 144 (ii) 80 (7)(i) 48 (ii) 90
(8)(i) 9000 (ii) 4536 (iii) 4464 (9)(i) 36 (ii) 60 (10) 13
(11) 400 (12)(i) 42 (ii) 78 (13)(i) 46 (ii) 310 (iii) 1012
(14)(i) 720 (ii) 144 (iii) 4 (iv) 144 (v) 220 (vi) (n + 3)(n + 2)
n(n − 1)
(15)(i) 15 (ii) 120 (iii) 16.(i) 4 (ii) 100
2
Exercise 4.2
(1) 10 (2) 4 (3)(i) 336 (ii) 172800 (4) 720
(5)(i) 410 (ii) 34 × 56 (iii) 11! (6)(i) 45 (ii) 155
(7) 144 (8)(i) 14! (ii) 9! × 6! (iii) 8! ×9 P6 (9) 34650
(10) 1260 (11) 6912 (12) 60 (13)(i) 28 (ii) 28
(14)(i) 43200 (ii) 151200 (iii) 19807200 (iv) 151200 (15)(i) 180
(ii) 60 (iii) 30 (16)(i) 379 (ii) 135 (17) 120, NIGHT
(18) 7 (19) 399960 (20) 571956
Exercise 4.3
(1) 1 (2) 3 (3) 10, 3 (6) 20
14 15 20 100 5
(9) (i) C7 = 3432 (ii) C2 = 105 (iii) C2 = 190 (iv) C5 (v) C3 ×4 C2 ×2 C1 = 120
(10) (i) 24 = 16 (ii) 25 = 32 (iii) 2n
25 25
(11) (i) C3 (ii) P3
10 8 10 10
(12) P2 × C4 = 6300 (13)(i) C3 = 120 (ii) C5 = 252
5 20 4 20 5
(14) C2 × C3 = 11400 (i) C1 × C3 = 4560 (ii) C2 ×19 C3 = 9690
7
(15) C3 = 35 (16) 4512 (17) 546 (18)(i) 280 (ii) 336 (iii) 736
(19) 485 (20) 64 (21) 2454
15
(22) C3 = 455 (23) 364 (24)(i) 50 (ii) 161 (25) 15
296
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise 4.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
(2) (2) (1) (2) (4) (2) (1) (4) (2) (2) (3) (4) (2) (3) (1)
16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
(4) (2) (3) (4) (3) (2) (2) (2) (1) (2)
Exercise 5.1
27
(1)(i) 8x6 − 36x3 + 54 − (ii) 2[16x8 + 216x4 (1 − x2 ) + 81(1 − x2 )2 ]
x3
(2)(i) 108243216 (ii) 96059601 (iii) 4782969
6
(3) (1.01)10 > 10000 (4) 10 (5) 15, x6 term is not possible.
40 0
(6) 26235 (7) − (8) 010
27
(13) n = 15 (14) n = 55 (15) n = 7 or 14
Exercise 5.2
(1)(i) G.P (ii) None of them. (iii) G.P
(iv) None of them (v) None of them (vi) None of them (vii) A.G.P
(2)(i) 2, 2, 4, 4, 6, 6, . . . (ii) 1, 2, 3, 5, 8, 13, . . . (iii) 1, 2, 3, 6, 11, 20, . . .
n + 1 if n is odd n 2n − 1
(3)(i) an = (ii) an = , ∀n ∈ N (iii) an = , ∀n ∈ N
n if n is even n+1 2n
7 − n if n is odd
(iv) an =
8 + n if n is even
1 1
(4) 12, 18, 27 (5) tn = 2
− (8) 5, 45
n (n + 1)2
Exercise 5.3
133 2 304
(1) a=, d = − , S20 = (2) S17 = 527
25 75 3
8 6
(3)(i) Sn = [10(10n − 1) − 9n] (ii) Sn = [10(10n − 1) − 9n]
81 81
4 n n 3n − 2 3n − (3n − 2) 3n−1 − 1
(4) Sn = (4 − 1) − (5) , +
9 3 3n−1 2 · 3n−1 4 · 3n−3
(6) n = 15 (8) 20 months (9) 2480 metres (10) 120, 480, 30(2)n
10
11
(11) 500 = 1296.87 (12) 15th day
10
297
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise 5.4
x x2 x3
1
(1)(i) 1− + − + ... |x| < 5
5" 5 25 125 #
2 3
2 4x 4x 4x 3
(ii) 1−2 +3 −4 + ... |x| <
9 3 3 3 4
2
3 2 2 1 4 4 6
(iii) 5 1 + (x) − x + x + ... x2 < 5
15 225 81 × 125
2
−
3 x 5 2 5 3
(iv) 2 1 − + x − x + ... |x| < 2
3 36 81
1
(2) (1001) 3 ≈ 10.00333
25x2 125x3 625x4 625x5
(5)(i) 1 + 5x + + + + + ...
2 6 24 24
4x3 2x4 4x5
(ii) 1 − 2x + 2x2 − + − + ...
3 3 15
1 1 1 1 4
(iii) 1 + x + x2 + x3 + x + ...
2 8 48 384
64x3 64x4 1
(6)(i) 4x − 8x2 + − + ... for |x| <
3 3 4
4x2 8x3 16x4 1
(ii) −2x − − − − ... for |x| <
2 3 4 2
3 5 7
27x 243x 2187x 1
(iii) 2[3x + + + + . . . ] for |x| <
3 5 7 3
3 5 7
8x 32x 128x 1
(iv) −2[2x + + + + ...] for |x| <
8 1
3 5 7 2
15 28 1
(8) ' 0.99196 (9) (10) log10e
16 3 2
Exercise 5.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
(4) (4) (4) (4) (2) (3) (1) (3) (4) (1) (1) (4) (4) (2) (3)
16 17 18 19 20
(2) (2) (3) (3) (2)
Exercise 6.1
x2 y 2
(1)(i) x2 + y 2 = 81 (ii) + = 1 (2)(i) y = ±2 (ii) x = ±3
81 36
1
(3) x2/3 + y 2/3 = a2/3 (4) k = −24, b=− (5) x2 + y 2 = 16
4
298
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
(6) x2 + y 2 − 4x − 4y + 8 = 0 (7) x2 + y 2 − 5x + 8y + 16 = 0
Exercise 6.2 √ √
(1)(i) y = 5x − 4 (ii) 3x − y = 2 (iii) 2x + 3y = 5 (iv) x + 3y = (1 + 3)
(3) 10x + 3y = 25
5 9
(5)(i) C = (F − 32) (or) F = C + 32 (ii) C = 37◦ (iii) F = 100.4◦
9 5
(6)(i) 4400metre (ii) D = 3000metre (iii) T = 22seconds (7) P = 1, 55, 000
p
(8) (3)x + y = 24 (9) 3x − 4y = 12, x − 2y = 2 (11) (13, 7), (−11, −3)
(12)(i) y = 12.5x − 150 (ii) 12seconds (iii) 80seconds
(13)(ii) x − 2y + 4 = 0 (iii) 2cm (iv) 14kg (v) 5cm
71
(14)(i) y = − x + 14.2, 0 ≤ x ≤ 24
120
(ii) y = f (x) is a periodic function with period 24, f (x) = f (x + 24)
(15)(i) The minimum length = 3280units
(ii) 180, 360 and 540units
9
(iii) The slope at each turning point is
40
Exercise 6.3
8 23
(2) 5x − 4y − 15 = 0 (3)(i) (ii)
5 5
(4)(i) x + 3y + 2 = 0 (ii) 4x − 3y − 7 = 0 (5) x + 5y − 31 = 0
(6)(i) x + 1 = 0 (ii) x−y =0 (iii) 2x + y + 3 = 0
(7) 12x + 5y + 6 = 0, and 12x + 5y − 20 = 0 (8) 4x − 3y + 15 = 0, and
√
4x − 3y − 25 = 0 (9) 2x + 3y − 18 = 0 (10) 7 2, and (−3, 5)
14 5
(12) (i) , (ii) (13)(i) 4x − 3y + k = 0, k ∈ R (ii) 3x + 4y + k1 = 0, k1 ∈ R
13 2
√ √
13
(14) 3x − y − 2 3 = 0 (15) A ,0 (16) x + 5y = ±10
5
(
1.50x, 0 ≤ x ≤ 10
(17) (0, 7) (18)(i) y = (ii) |45
x + 5, x > 10
(19) y = 5x − 7, y = 5x + 10
(20) y + 3 = 0, 2x + y + 3 = 0, and 2x − y − 3 = 0
299
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Exercise 6.4
(1) x2 − xy − 2y 2 + 2 x − 13y − 15 = 0
(6) 3x2 − 13xy − 10y 2 + 33x + 73y − 126 = 0 (7)(i) x + y = 0, 3x − y = 0
(ii) 3x + 4y − 11 = 0, 2x − y = 0 (iii) x + y − 5 = 0, 2x − 3y + 4 = 0
(10) y = x
67
(11) p = 6, q = 17(or) − (12) k = −1
6
35 8 √
(13) k = −5(or) − (14) (15) 5
4 5
Exercise 6.5
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15
(4) (4) (3) (4) (3) (2) (2) (4) (2) (3) (1) (2) (3) (4) (2)
16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25
(1) (3) (2) (1) (2) (1) (3) (1) (3) (4)
300
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.kalvisolai.com www.books.kalvisolai.com
Glossary Glossary
absolute value function or modulus function மட்டு சார்பு அல்லது எண்ணளவுச் சார்பு
basic relations அடிப்படைத் த�ாைர்புகள்
bijective function இருபுறச் சார்பு
cardinality தசவதவெணடம
closed interval மூடிய இடைதவெளி
co-domain துட்ணச் சார்்பகம்
composition of functions சார்புகளின் சசர்பபு
constant மாறிலி
constant function மாறிலிச் சார்பு
dependent variable சார்ந்� மாறி
dilation விரி�ல
disjoint set தவெட்ைாக் க்ணம்
domain சார்்பகம்
empty relation தவெற்றுத் த�ாைர்பு
empty set or void set தவெற்றுக்ணம்
equivalence relation சமானத் த�ாைர்பு
even function இரட்டைப ்படைச் சார்பு
exponential function அடுக்குக் குறிச் சார்பு
extreme relations உச்சத் த�ாைர்புகள்
finite set முடிவுறு க்ணம்
greatest integer function மீபத்பரு முழுஎண சார்பு
horizontal line test கிடை மட்ைக் சகாட்டுச் சசா�டன
identity function சமனிச் சார்பு
image பிம்்பம்
improper subset �கா உட்க்ணம்
independent variable சாரா மாறி
infinite set முடிவுறா க்ணம்
inverse சேர்மாறு
invertible சேர்மாற்றுத்�ன்டம
301
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com xi www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
xii
conjugate இட்ண
discriminant �ன்டமக் காட்டி
division algorithm வெகுத்�ல சகாட்்பாடு
exponents அடுக்குக் குறி
inequality அசமன்்பாடு
partial fraction ்பகுதிப பின்னம்
polynomial expression ்பலலுறுபபுக் சகாடவெ
quartic ோன்காம் ்படி
quintic ஐந்�ாம் ்படி
radical ்படிமூ்லம்
rational inequality விகி�முறு அசமன்்பாடு
remainder theorem மீதித் ச�ற்றம்
Chapter 3 Trigonometry
cryptography குறியாக்கவியல
factorial காரணியப த்பருக்கம்
heptagon எழுசகா்ணம்
inclusion-exclusion சசர்த்�ல-நீக்கல
inductive step த�ாகுக்கும் நிட்ல
mathematical induction கணி�த் த�ாகுத்�றி�ல முடற
pentagon ஐஙசகா்ணம்
permutation வெரிடசமாற்றம்
polygon ்ப்லசகா்ணம்
product rule த்பருக்கலவிதி
string method கட்டு�ல முடற
sum rule கூட்ைல விதி
304
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
xiv
305
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com xv www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
306
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
xvi
307
Mathematics – Class XI
List of Authors and Reviewers
Academic Coordinator
Content Readers
B. Tamilselvi
Deputy Director, SCERT, Chennai. Dr. M.P. Jeyaraman
Assistant Professor in Maths
L.N. Govt. Arts College, Ponneri.
P. Divya Prabha
Art and Design Team PGT Maths, Govt. HSS,
Arumbakkam, Chennai.
Dr. K. Kavitha
Illustrator Asst. Professor, Department of Mathematics,
G. Achuthan Bharathi Womens College, Chennai.
Art Teacher, JG Hindu Vidyalaya MHSS
West Mambalam, Chennai. S. Vijayalakshmi
B.T. Asst., GHSS., Kuvathur, Kanchipuram Dist.
Wrapper Design
Kathir Arumugam
Layout
WinMac Solutions
In-House
QC
Manohar Radhakrishnan
Gopu Rasuvel, Tamil Kumaran,
Jerald Wilson
Coordination
This book has been printed on 80 G.S.M.
Ramesh Munisamy Elegant Maplitho paper.
Typist Printed by offset at:
P. Jeyanthi
Typist, DIET, Mannargudi.
308
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
NOTES
309
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
NOTES
310
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
NOTES
311
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com
NOTES
312
www.tamilgk.kalvisolai.com www.studymaterial.kalvisolai.com